Home | History | Annotate | Download | only in docs
      1 ==============================
      2 LLVM Language Reference Manual
      3 ==============================
      4 
      5 .. contents::
      6    :local:
      7    :depth: 4
      8 
      9 Abstract
     10 ========
     11 
     12 This document is a reference manual for the LLVM assembly language. LLVM
     13 is a Static Single Assignment (SSA) based representation that provides
     14 type safety, low-level operations, flexibility, and the capability of
     15 representing 'all' high-level languages cleanly. It is the common code
     16 representation used throughout all phases of the LLVM compilation
     17 strategy.
     18 
     19 Introduction
     20 ============
     21 
     22 The LLVM code representation is designed to be used in three different
     23 forms: as an in-memory compiler IR, as an on-disk bitcode representation
     24 (suitable for fast loading by a Just-In-Time compiler), and as a human
     25 readable assembly language representation. This allows LLVM to provide a
     26 powerful intermediate representation for efficient compiler
     27 transformations and analysis, while providing a natural means to debug
     28 and visualize the transformations. The three different forms of LLVM are
     29 all equivalent. This document describes the human readable
     30 representation and notation.
     31 
     32 The LLVM representation aims to be light-weight and low-level while
     33 being expressive, typed, and extensible at the same time. It aims to be
     34 a "universal IR" of sorts, by being at a low enough level that
     35 high-level ideas may be cleanly mapped to it (similar to how
     36 microprocessors are "universal IR's", allowing many source languages to
     37 be mapped to them). By providing type information, LLVM can be used as
     38 the target of optimizations: for example, through pointer analysis, it
     39 can be proven that a C automatic variable is never accessed outside of
     40 the current function, allowing it to be promoted to a simple SSA value
     41 instead of a memory location.
     42 
     43 .. _wellformed:
     44 
     45 Well-Formedness
     46 ---------------
     47 
     48 It is important to note that this document describes 'well formed' LLVM
     49 assembly language. There is a difference between what the parser accepts
     50 and what is considered 'well formed'. For example, the following
     51 instruction is syntactically okay, but not well formed:
     52 
     53 .. code-block:: llvm
     54 
     55     %x = add i32 1, %x
     56 
     57 because the definition of ``%x`` does not dominate all of its uses. The
     58 LLVM infrastructure provides a verification pass that may be used to
     59 verify that an LLVM module is well formed. This pass is automatically
     60 run by the parser after parsing input assembly and by the optimizer
     61 before it outputs bitcode. The violations pointed out by the verifier
     62 pass indicate bugs in transformation passes or input to the parser.
     63 
     64 .. _identifiers:
     65 
     66 Identifiers
     67 ===========
     68 
     69 LLVM identifiers come in two basic types: global and local. Global
     70 identifiers (functions, global variables) begin with the ``'@'``
     71 character. Local identifiers (register names, types) begin with the
     72 ``'%'`` character. Additionally, there are three different formats for
     73 identifiers, for different purposes:
     74 
     75 #. Named values are represented as a string of characters with their
     76    prefix. For example, ``%foo``, ``@DivisionByZero``,
     77    ``%a.really.long.identifier``. The actual regular expression used is
     78    '``[%@][-a-zA-Z$._][-a-zA-Z$._0-9]*``'. Identifiers that require other
     79    characters in their names can be surrounded with quotes. Special
     80    characters may be escaped using ``"\xx"`` where ``xx`` is the ASCII
     81    code for the character in hexadecimal. In this way, any character can
     82    be used in a name value, even quotes themselves. The ``"\01"`` prefix
     83    can be used on global variables to suppress mangling.
     84 #. Unnamed values are represented as an unsigned numeric value with
     85    their prefix. For example, ``%12``, ``@2``, ``%44``.
     86 #. Constants, which are described in the section Constants_ below.
     87 
     88 LLVM requires that values start with a prefix for two reasons: Compilers
     89 don't need to worry about name clashes with reserved words, and the set
     90 of reserved words may be expanded in the future without penalty.
     91 Additionally, unnamed identifiers allow a compiler to quickly come up
     92 with a temporary variable without having to avoid symbol table
     93 conflicts.
     94 
     95 Reserved words in LLVM are very similar to reserved words in other
     96 languages. There are keywords for different opcodes ('``add``',
     97 '``bitcast``', '``ret``', etc...), for primitive type names ('``void``',
     98 '``i32``', etc...), and others. These reserved words cannot conflict
     99 with variable names, because none of them start with a prefix character
    100 (``'%'`` or ``'@'``).
    101 
    102 Here is an example of LLVM code to multiply the integer variable
    103 '``%X``' by 8:
    104 
    105 The easy way:
    106 
    107 .. code-block:: llvm
    108 
    109     %result = mul i32 %X, 8
    110 
    111 After strength reduction:
    112 
    113 .. code-block:: llvm
    114 
    115     %result = shl i32 %X, 3
    116 
    117 And the hard way:
    118 
    119 .. code-block:: llvm
    120 
    121     %0 = add i32 %X, %X           ; yields i32:%0
    122     %1 = add i32 %0, %0           ; yields i32:%1
    123     %result = add i32 %1, %1
    124 
    125 This last way of multiplying ``%X`` by 8 illustrates several important
    126 lexical features of LLVM:
    127 
    128 #. Comments are delimited with a '``;``' and go until the end of line.
    129 #. Unnamed temporaries are created when the result of a computation is
    130    not assigned to a named value.
    131 #. Unnamed temporaries are numbered sequentially (using a per-function
    132    incrementing counter, starting with 0). Note that basic blocks and unnamed
    133    function parameters are included in this numbering. For example, if the
    134    entry basic block is not given a label name and all function parameters are
    135    named, then it will get number 0.
    136 
    137 It also shows a convention that we follow in this document. When
    138 demonstrating instructions, we will follow an instruction with a comment
    139 that defines the type and name of value produced.
    140 
    141 High Level Structure
    142 ====================
    143 
    144 Module Structure
    145 ----------------
    146 
    147 LLVM programs are composed of ``Module``'s, each of which is a
    148 translation unit of the input programs. Each module consists of
    149 functions, global variables, and symbol table entries. Modules may be
    150 combined together with the LLVM linker, which merges function (and
    151 global variable) definitions, resolves forward declarations, and merges
    152 symbol table entries. Here is an example of the "hello world" module:
    153 
    154 .. code-block:: llvm
    155 
    156     ; Declare the string constant as a global constant.
    157     @.str = private unnamed_addr constant [13 x i8] c"hello world\0A\00"
    158 
    159     ; External declaration of the puts function
    160     declare i32 @puts(i8* nocapture) nounwind
    161 
    162     ; Definition of main function
    163     define i32 @main() {   ; i32()*
    164       ; Convert [13 x i8]* to i8  *...
    165       %cast210 = getelementptr [13 x i8], [13 x i8]* @.str, i64 0, i64 0
    166 
    167       ; Call puts function to write out the string to stdout.
    168       call i32 @puts(i8* %cast210)
    169       ret i32 0
    170     }
    171 
    172     ; Named metadata
    173     !0 = !{i32 42, null, !"string"}
    174     !foo = !{!0}
    175 
    176 This example is made up of a :ref:`global variable <globalvars>` named
    177 "``.str``", an external declaration of the "``puts``" function, a
    178 :ref:`function definition <functionstructure>` for "``main``" and
    179 :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` "``foo``".
    180 
    181 In general, a module is made up of a list of global values (where both
    182 functions and global variables are global values). Global values are
    183 represented by a pointer to a memory location (in this case, a pointer
    184 to an array of char, and a pointer to a function), and have one of the
    185 following :ref:`linkage types <linkage>`.
    186 
    187 .. _linkage:
    188 
    189 Linkage Types
    190 -------------
    191 
    192 All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following types of
    193 linkage:
    194 
    195 ``private``
    196     Global values with "``private``" linkage are only directly
    197     accessible by objects in the current module. In particular, linking
    198     code into a module with an private global value may cause the
    199     private to be renamed as necessary to avoid collisions. Because the
    200     symbol is private to the module, all references can be updated. This
    201     doesn't show up in any symbol table in the object file.
    202 ``internal``
    203     Similar to private, but the value shows as a local symbol
    204     (``STB_LOCAL`` in the case of ELF) in the object file. This
    205     corresponds to the notion of the '``static``' keyword in C.
    206 ``available_externally``
    207     Globals with "``available_externally``" linkage are never emitted into
    208     the object file corresponding to the LLVM module. From the linker's
    209     perspective, an ``available_externally`` global is equivalent to
    210     an external declaration. They exist to allow inlining and other
    211     optimizations to take place given knowledge of the definition of the
    212     global, which is known to be somewhere outside the module. Globals
    213     with ``available_externally`` linkage are allowed to be discarded at
    214     will, and allow inlining and other optimizations. This linkage type is
    215     only allowed on definitions, not declarations.
    216 ``linkonce``
    217     Globals with "``linkonce``" linkage are merged with other globals of
    218     the same name when linkage occurs. This can be used to implement
    219     some forms of inline functions, templates, or other code which must
    220     be generated in each translation unit that uses it, but where the
    221     body may be overridden with a more definitive definition later.
    222     Unreferenced ``linkonce`` globals are allowed to be discarded. Note
    223     that ``linkonce`` linkage does not actually allow the optimizer to
    224     inline the body of this function into callers because it doesn't
    225     know if this definition of the function is the definitive definition
    226     within the program or whether it will be overridden by a stronger
    227     definition. To enable inlining and other optimizations, use
    228     "``linkonce_odr``" linkage.
    229 ``weak``
    230     "``weak``" linkage has the same merging semantics as ``linkonce``
    231     linkage, except that unreferenced globals with ``weak`` linkage may
    232     not be discarded. This is used for globals that are declared "weak"
    233     in C source code.
    234 ``common``
    235     "``common``" linkage is most similar to "``weak``" linkage, but they
    236     are used for tentative definitions in C, such as "``int X;``" at
    237     global scope. Symbols with "``common``" linkage are merged in the
    238     same way as ``weak symbols``, and they may not be deleted if
    239     unreferenced. ``common`` symbols may not have an explicit section,
    240     must have a zero initializer, and may not be marked
    241     ':ref:`constant <globalvars>`'. Functions and aliases may not have
    242     common linkage.
    243 
    244 .. _linkage_appending:
    245 
    246 ``appending``
    247     "``appending``" linkage may only be applied to global variables of
    248     pointer to array type. When two global variables with appending
    249     linkage are linked together, the two global arrays are appended
    250     together. This is the LLVM, typesafe, equivalent of having the
    251     system linker append together "sections" with identical names when
    252     .o files are linked.
    253 ``extern_weak``
    254     The semantics of this linkage follow the ELF object file model: the
    255     symbol is weak until linked, if not linked, the symbol becomes null
    256     instead of being an undefined reference.
    257 ``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``
    258     Some languages allow differing globals to be merged, such as two
    259     functions with different semantics. Other languages, such as
    260     ``C++``, ensure that only equivalent globals are ever merged (the
    261     "one definition rule" --- "ODR"). Such languages can use the
    262     ``linkonce_odr`` and ``weak_odr`` linkage types to indicate that the
    263     global will only be merged with equivalent globals. These linkage
    264     types are otherwise the same as their non-``odr`` versions.
    265 ``external``
    266     If none of the above identifiers are used, the global is externally
    267     visible, meaning that it participates in linkage and can be used to
    268     resolve external symbol references.
    269 
    270 It is illegal for a function *declaration* to have any linkage type
    271 other than ``external`` or ``extern_weak``.
    272 
    273 .. _callingconv:
    274 
    275 Calling Conventions
    276 -------------------
    277 
    278 LLVM :ref:`functions <functionstructure>`, :ref:`calls <i_call>` and
    279 :ref:`invokes <i_invoke>` can all have an optional calling convention
    280 specified for the call. The calling convention of any pair of dynamic
    281 caller/callee must match, or the behavior of the program is undefined.
    282 The following calling conventions are supported by LLVM, and more may be
    283 added in the future:
    284 
    285 "``ccc``" - The C calling convention
    286     This calling convention (the default if no other calling convention
    287     is specified) matches the target C calling conventions. This calling
    288     convention supports varargs function calls and tolerates some
    289     mismatch in the declared prototype and implemented declaration of
    290     the function (as does normal C).
    291 "``fastcc``" - The fast calling convention
    292     This calling convention attempts to make calls as fast as possible
    293     (e.g. by passing things in registers). This calling convention
    294     allows the target to use whatever tricks it wants to produce fast
    295     code for the target, without having to conform to an externally
    296     specified ABI (Application Binary Interface). `Tail calls can only
    297     be optimized when this, the GHC or the HiPE convention is
    298     used. <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ This calling convention does not
    299     support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly
    300     match the prototype of the function definition.
    301 "``coldcc``" - The cold calling convention
    302     This calling convention attempts to make code in the caller as
    303     efficient as possible under the assumption that the call is not
    304     commonly executed. As such, these calls often preserve all registers
    305     so that the call does not break any live ranges in the caller side.
    306     This calling convention does not support varargs and requires the
    307     prototype of all callees to exactly match the prototype of the
    308     function definition. Furthermore the inliner doesn't consider such function
    309     calls for inlining.
    310 "``cc 10``" - GHC convention
    311     This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
    312     the `Glasgow Haskell Compiler (GHC) <http://www.haskell.org/ghc>`_.
    313     It passes everything in registers, going to extremes to achieve this
    314     by disabling callee save registers. This calling convention should
    315     not be used lightly but only for specific situations such as an
    316     alternative to the *register pinning* performance technique often
    317     used when implementing functional programming languages. At the
    318     moment only X86 supports this convention and it has the following
    319     limitations:
    320 
    321     -  On *X86-32* only supports up to 4 bit type parameters. No
    322        floating point types are supported.
    323     -  On *X86-64* only supports up to 10 bit type parameters and 6
    324        floating point parameters.
    325 
    326     This calling convention supports `tail call
    327     optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires both the
    328     caller and callee are using it.
    329 "``cc 11``" - The HiPE calling convention
    330     This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
    331     the `High-Performance Erlang
    332     (HiPE) <http://www.it.uu.se/research/group/hipe/>`_ compiler, *the*
    333     native code compiler of the `Ericsson's Open Source Erlang/OTP
    334     system <http://www.erlang.org/download.shtml>`_. It uses more
    335     registers for argument passing than the ordinary C calling
    336     convention and defines no callee-saved registers. The calling
    337     convention properly supports `tail call
    338     optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires that both the
    339     caller and the callee use it. It uses a *register pinning*
    340     mechanism, similar to GHC's convention, for keeping frequently
    341     accessed runtime components pinned to specific hardware registers.
    342     At the moment only X86 supports this convention (both 32 and 64
    343     bit).
    344 "``webkit_jscc``" - WebKit's JavaScript calling convention
    345     This calling convention has been implemented for `WebKit FTL JIT
    346     <https://trac.webkit.org/wiki/FTLJIT>`_. It passes arguments on the
    347     stack right to left (as cdecl does), and returns a value in the
    348     platform's customary return register.
    349 "``anyregcc``" - Dynamic calling convention for code patching
    350     This is a special convention that supports patching an arbitrary code
    351     sequence in place of a call site. This convention forces the call
    352     arguments into registers but allows them to be dynamically
    353     allocated. This can currently only be used with calls to
    354     llvm.experimental.patchpoint because only this intrinsic records
    355     the location of its arguments in a side table. See :doc:`StackMaps`.
    356 "``preserve_mostcc``" - The `PreserveMost` calling convention
    357     This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller as
    358     unintrusive as possible. This convention behaves identically to the `C`
    359     calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it
    360     uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers. This alleviates the
    361     burden of saving and recovering a large register set before and after the
    362     call in the caller. If the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers,
    363     then they will be preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't
    364     apply for values returned in callee-saved registers.
    365 
    366     - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
    367       R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Floating-point registers
    368       (XMMs/YMMs) are not preserved and need to be saved by the caller.
    369 
    370     The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
    371     that have a hot path and a cold path. The hot path is usually a small piece
    372     of code that doesn't use many registers. The cold path might need to call out to
    373     another function and therefore only needs to preserve the caller-saved
    374     registers, which haven't already been saved by the caller. The
    375     `PreserveMost` calling convention is very similar to the `cold` calling
    376     convention in terms of caller/callee-saved registers, but they are used for
    377     different types of function calls. `coldcc` is for function calls that are
    378     rarely executed, whereas `preserve_mostcc` function calls are intended to be
    379     on the hot path and definitely executed a lot. Furthermore `preserve_mostcc`
    380     doesn't prevent the inliner from inlining the function call.
    381 
    382     This calling convention will be used by a future version of the ObjectiveC
    383     runtime and should therefore still be considered experimental at this time.
    384     Although this convention was created to optimize certain runtime calls to
    385     the ObjectiveC runtime, it is not limited to this runtime and might be used
    386     by other runtimes in the future too. The current implementation only
    387     supports X86-64, but the intention is to support more architectures in the
    388     future.
    389 "``preserve_allcc``" - The `PreserveAll` calling convention
    390     This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller even less
    391     intrusive than the `PreserveMost` calling convention. This calling
    392     convention also behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on how
    393     arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
    394     caller/callee-saved registers. This removes the burden of saving and
    395     recovering a large register set before and after the call in the caller. If
    396     the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, then they will be
    397     preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't apply for values
    398     returned in callee-saved registers.
    399 
    400     - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
    401       R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Furthermore it also preserves
    402       all floating-point registers (XMMs/YMMs).
    403 
    404     The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
    405     that don't need to call out to any other functions.
    406 
    407     This calling convention, like the `PreserveMost` calling convention, will be
    408     used by a future version of the ObjectiveC runtime and should be considered
    409     experimental at this time.
    410 "``cxx_fast_tlscc``" - The `CXX_FAST_TLS` calling convention for access functions
    411     Clang generates an access function to access C++-style TLS. The access
    412     function generally has an entry block, an exit block and an initialization
    413     block that is run at the first time. The entry and exit blocks can access
    414     a few TLS IR variables, each access will be lowered to a platform-specific
    415     sequence.
    416 
    417     This calling convention aims to minimize overhead in the caller by
    418     preserving as many registers as possible (all the registers that are
    419     perserved on the fast path, composed of the entry and exit blocks).
    420 
    421     This calling convention behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on
    422     how arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
    423     caller/callee-saved registers.
    424 
    425     Given that each platform has its own lowering sequence, hence its own set
    426     of preserved registers, we can't use the existing `PreserveMost`.
    427 
    428     - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
    429       RDI and RAX.
    430 "``cc <n>``" - Numbered convention
    431     Any calling convention may be specified by number, allowing
    432     target-specific calling conventions to be used. Target specific
    433     calling conventions start at 64.
    434 
    435 More calling conventions can be added/defined on an as-needed basis, to
    436 support Pascal conventions or any other well-known target-independent
    437 convention.
    438 
    439 .. _visibilitystyles:
    440 
    441 Visibility Styles
    442 -----------------
    443 
    444 All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following visibility
    445 styles:
    446 
    447 "``default``" - Default style
    448     On targets that use the ELF object file format, default visibility
    449     means that the declaration is visible to other modules and, in
    450     shared libraries, means that the declared entity may be overridden.
    451     On Darwin, default visibility means that the declaration is visible
    452     to other modules. Default visibility corresponds to "external
    453     linkage" in the language.
    454 "``hidden``" - Hidden style
    455     Two declarations of an object with hidden visibility refer to the
    456     same object if they are in the same shared object. Usually, hidden
    457     visibility indicates that the symbol will not be placed into the
    458     dynamic symbol table, so no other module (executable or shared
    459     library) can reference it directly.
    460 "``protected``" - Protected style
    461     On ELF, protected visibility indicates that the symbol will be
    462     placed in the dynamic symbol table, but that references within the
    463     defining module will bind to the local symbol. That is, the symbol
    464     cannot be overridden by another module.
    465 
    466 A symbol with ``internal`` or ``private`` linkage must have ``default``
    467 visibility.
    468 
    469 .. _dllstorageclass:
    470 
    471 DLL Storage Classes
    472 -------------------
    473 
    474 All Global Variables, Functions and Aliases can have one of the following
    475 DLL storage class:
    476 
    477 ``dllimport``
    478     "``dllimport``" causes the compiler to reference a function or variable via
    479     a global pointer to a pointer that is set up by the DLL exporting the
    480     symbol. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by
    481     combining ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name.
    482 ``dllexport``
    483     "``dllexport``" causes the compiler to provide a global pointer to a pointer
    484     in a DLL, so that it can be referenced with the ``dllimport`` attribute. On
    485     Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by combining
    486     ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name. Since this storage class
    487     exists for defining a dll interface, the compiler, assembler and linker know
    488     it is externally referenced and must refrain from deleting the symbol.
    489 
    490 .. _tls_model:
    491 
    492 Thread Local Storage Models
    493 ---------------------------
    494 
    495 A variable may be defined as ``thread_local``, which means that it will
    496 not be shared by threads (each thread will have a separated copy of the
    497 variable). Not all targets support thread-local variables. Optionally, a
    498 TLS model may be specified:
    499 
    500 ``localdynamic``
    501     For variables that are only used within the current shared library.
    502 ``initialexec``
    503     For variables in modules that will not be loaded dynamically.
    504 ``localexec``
    505     For variables defined in the executable and only used within it.
    506 
    507 If no explicit model is given, the "general dynamic" model is used.
    508 
    509 The models correspond to the ELF TLS models; see `ELF Handling For
    510 Thread-Local Storage <http://people.redhat.com/drepper/tls.pdf>`_ for
    511 more information on under which circumstances the different models may
    512 be used. The target may choose a different TLS model if the specified
    513 model is not supported, or if a better choice of model can be made.
    514 
    515 A model can also be specified in an alias, but then it only governs how
    516 the alias is accessed. It will not have any effect in the aliasee.
    517 
    518 For platforms without linker support of ELF TLS model, the -femulated-tls
    519 flag can be used to generate GCC compatible emulated TLS code.
    520 
    521 .. _namedtypes:
    522 
    523 Structure Types
    524 ---------------
    525 
    526 LLVM IR allows you to specify both "identified" and "literal" :ref:`structure
    527 types <t_struct>`. Literal types are uniqued structurally, but identified types
    528 are never uniqued. An :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>` can also be used
    529 to forward declare a type that is not yet available.
    530 
    531 An example of an identified structure specification is:
    532 
    533 .. code-block:: llvm
    534 
    535     %mytype = type { %mytype*, i32 }
    536 
    537 Prior to the LLVM 3.0 release, identified types were structurally uniqued. Only
    538 literal types are uniqued in recent versions of LLVM.
    539 
    540 .. _globalvars:
    541 
    542 Global Variables
    543 ----------------
    544 
    545 Global variables define regions of memory allocated at compilation time
    546 instead of run-time.
    547 
    548 Global variable definitions must be initialized.
    549 
    550 Global variables in other translation units can also be declared, in which
    551 case they don't have an initializer.
    552 
    553 Either global variable definitions or declarations may have an explicit section
    554 to be placed in and may have an optional explicit alignment specified.
    555 
    556 A variable may be defined as a global ``constant``, which indicates that
    557 the contents of the variable will **never** be modified (enabling better
    558 optimization, allowing the global data to be placed in the read-only
    559 section of an executable, etc). Note that variables that need runtime
    560 initialization cannot be marked ``constant`` as there is a store to the
    561 variable.
    562 
    563 LLVM explicitly allows *declarations* of global variables to be marked
    564 constant, even if the final definition of the global is not. This
    565 capability can be used to enable slightly better optimization of the
    566 program, but requires the language definition to guarantee that
    567 optimizations based on the 'constantness' are valid for the translation
    568 units that do not include the definition.
    569 
    570 As SSA values, global variables define pointer values that are in scope
    571 (i.e. they dominate) all basic blocks in the program. Global variables
    572 always define a pointer to their "content" type because they describe a
    573 region of memory, and all memory objects in LLVM are accessed through
    574 pointers.
    575 
    576 Global variables can be marked with ``unnamed_addr`` which indicates
    577 that the address is not significant, only the content. Constants marked
    578 like this can be merged with other constants if they have the same
    579 initializer. Note that a constant with significant address *can* be
    580 merged with a ``unnamed_addr`` constant, the result being a constant
    581 whose address is significant.
    582 
    583 A global variable may be declared to reside in a target-specific
    584 numbered address space. For targets that support them, address spaces
    585 may affect how optimizations are performed and/or what target
    586 instructions are used to access the variable. The default address space
    587 is zero. The address space qualifier must precede any other attributes.
    588 
    589 LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for globals. If the
    590 target supports it, it will emit globals to the section specified.
    591 Additionally, the global can placed in a comdat if the target has the necessary
    592 support.
    593 
    594 By default, global initializers are optimized by assuming that global
    595 variables defined within the module are not modified from their
    596 initial values before the start of the global initializer. This is
    597 true even for variables potentially accessible from outside the
    598 module, including those with external linkage or appearing in
    599 ``@llvm.used`` or dllexported variables. This assumption may be suppressed
    600 by marking the variable with ``externally_initialized``.
    601 
    602 An explicit alignment may be specified for a global, which must be a
    603 power of 2. If not present, or if the alignment is set to zero, the
    604 alignment of the global is set by the target to whatever it feels
    605 convenient. If an explicit alignment is specified, the global is forced
    606 to have exactly that alignment. Targets and optimizers are not allowed
    607 to over-align the global if the global has an assigned section. In this
    608 case, the extra alignment could be observable: for example, code could
    609 assume that the globals are densely packed in their section and try to
    610 iterate over them as an array, alignment padding would break this
    611 iteration. The maximum alignment is ``1 << 29``.
    612 
    613 Globals can also have a :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`.
    614 
    615 Variables and aliases can have a
    616 :ref:`Thread Local Storage Model <tls_model>`.
    617 
    618 Syntax::
    619 
    620     [@<GlobalVarName> =] [Linkage] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal]
    621                          [unnamed_addr] [AddrSpace] [ExternallyInitialized]
    622                          <global | constant> <Type> [<InitializerConstant>]
    623                          [, section "name"] [, comdat [($name)]]
    624                          [, align <Alignment>]
    625 
    626 For example, the following defines a global in a numbered address space
    627 with an initializer, section, and alignment:
    628 
    629 .. code-block:: llvm
    630 
    631     @G = addrspace(5) constant float 1.0, section "foo", align 4
    632 
    633 The following example just declares a global variable
    634 
    635 .. code-block:: llvm
    636 
    637    @G = external global i32
    638 
    639 The following example defines a thread-local global with the
    640 ``initialexec`` TLS model:
    641 
    642 .. code-block:: llvm
    643 
    644     @G = thread_local(initialexec) global i32 0, align 4
    645 
    646 .. _functionstructure:
    647 
    648 Functions
    649 ---------
    650 
    651 LLVM function definitions consist of the "``define``" keyword, an
    652 optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility
    653 style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
    654 an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`,
    655 an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional
    656 :ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function
    657 name, a (possibly empty) argument list (each with optional :ref:`parameter
    658 attributes <paramattrs>`), optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`,
    659 an optional section, an optional alignment,
    660 an optional :ref:`comdat <langref_comdats>`,
    661 an optional :ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`,
    662 an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`,
    663 an optional :ref:`personality <personalityfn>`,
    664 an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`,
    665 an opening curly brace, a list of basic blocks, and a closing curly brace.
    666 
    667 LLVM function declarations consist of the "``declare``" keyword, an
    668 optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility
    669 style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
    670 an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`,
    671 an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional
    672 :ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function
    673 name, a possibly empty list of arguments, an optional alignment, an optional
    674 :ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`,
    675 and an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`.
    676 
    677 A function definition contains a list of basic blocks, forming the CFG (Control
    678 Flow Graph) for the function. Each basic block may optionally start with a label
    679 (giving the basic block a symbol table entry), contains a list of instructions,
    680 and ends with a :ref:`terminator <terminators>` instruction (such as a branch or
    681 function return). If an explicit label is not provided, a block is assigned an
    682 implicit numbered label, using the next value from the same counter as used for
    683 unnamed temporaries (:ref:`see above<identifiers>`). For example, if a function
    684 entry block does not have an explicit label, it will be assigned label "%0",
    685 then the first unnamed temporary in that block will be "%1", etc.
    686 
    687 The first basic block in a function is special in two ways: it is
    688 immediately executed on entrance to the function, and it is not allowed
    689 to have predecessor basic blocks (i.e. there can not be any branches to
    690 the entry block of a function). Because the block can have no
    691 predecessors, it also cannot have any :ref:`PHI nodes <i_phi>`.
    692 
    693 LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for functions. If the
    694 target supports it, it will emit functions to the section specified.
    695 Additionally, the function can be placed in a COMDAT.
    696 
    697 An explicit alignment may be specified for a function. If not present,
    698 or if the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the function is set
    699 by the target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment
    700 is specified, the function is forced to have at least that much
    701 alignment. All alignments must be a power of 2.
    702 
    703 If the ``unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to not
    704 be significant and two identical functions can be merged.
    705 
    706 Syntax::
    707 
    708     define [linkage] [visibility] [DLLStorageClass]
    709            [cconv] [ret attrs]
    710            <ResultType> @<FunctionName> ([argument list])
    711            [unnamed_addr] [fn Attrs] [section "name"] [comdat [($name)]]
    712            [align N] [gc] [prefix Constant] [prologue Constant]
    713            [personality Constant] (!name !N)* { ... }
    714 
    715 The argument list is a comma separated sequence of arguments where each
    716 argument is of the following form:
    717 
    718 Syntax::
    719 
    720    <type> [parameter Attrs] [name]
    721 
    722 
    723 .. _langref_aliases:
    724 
    725 Aliases
    726 -------
    727 
    728 Aliases, unlike function or variables, don't create any new data. They
    729 are just a new symbol and metadata for an existing position.
    730 
    731 Aliases have a name and an aliasee that is either a global value or a
    732 constant expression.
    733 
    734 Aliases may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional
    735 :ref:`visibility style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class
    736 <dllstorageclass>` and an optional :ref:`tls model <tls_model>`.
    737 
    738 Syntax::
    739 
    740     @<Name> = [Linkage] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal] [unnamed_addr] alias <AliaseeTy>, <AliaseeTy>* @<Aliasee>
    741 
    742 The linkage must be one of ``private``, ``internal``, ``linkonce``, ``weak``,
    743 ``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``, ``external``. Note that some system linkers
    744 might not correctly handle dropping a weak symbol that is aliased.
    745 
    746 Aliases that are not ``unnamed_addr`` are guaranteed to have the same address as
    747 the aliasee expression. ``unnamed_addr`` ones are only guaranteed to point
    748 to the same content.
    749 
    750 Since aliases are only a second name, some restrictions apply, of which
    751 some can only be checked when producing an object file:
    752 
    753 * The expression defining the aliasee must be computable at assembly
    754   time. Since it is just a name, no relocations can be used.
    755 
    756 * No alias in the expression can be weak as the possibility of the
    757   intermediate alias being overridden cannot be represented in an
    758   object file.
    759 
    760 * No global value in the expression can be a declaration, since that
    761   would require a relocation, which is not possible.
    762 
    763 .. _langref_comdats:
    764 
    765 Comdats
    766 -------
    767 
    768 Comdat IR provides access to COFF and ELF object file COMDAT functionality.
    769 
    770 Comdats have a name which represents the COMDAT key. All global objects that
    771 specify this key will only end up in the final object file if the linker chooses
    772 that key over some other key. Aliases are placed in the same COMDAT that their
    773 aliasee computes to, if any.
    774 
    775 Comdats have a selection kind to provide input on how the linker should
    776 choose between keys in two different object files.
    777 
    778 Syntax::
    779 
    780     $<Name> = comdat SelectionKind
    781 
    782 The selection kind must be one of the following:
    783 
    784 ``any``
    785     The linker may choose any COMDAT key, the choice is arbitrary.
    786 ``exactmatch``
    787     The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
    788     same data.
    789 ``largest``
    790     The linker will choose the section containing the largest COMDAT key.
    791 ``noduplicates``
    792     The linker requires that only section with this COMDAT key exist.
    793 ``samesize``
    794     The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
    795     same amount of data.
    796 
    797 Note that the Mach-O platform doesn't support COMDATs and ELF only supports
    798 ``any`` as a selection kind.
    799 
    800 Here is an example of a COMDAT group where a function will only be selected if
    801 the COMDAT key's section is the largest:
    802 
    803 .. code-block:: llvm
    804 
    805    $foo = comdat largest
    806    @foo = global i32 2, comdat($foo)
    807 
    808    define void @bar() comdat($foo) {
    809      ret void
    810    }
    811 
    812 As a syntactic sugar the ``$name`` can be omitted if the name is the same as
    813 the global name:
    814 
    815 .. code-block:: llvm
    816 
    817   $foo = comdat any
    818   @foo = global i32 2, comdat
    819 
    820 
    821 In a COFF object file, this will create a COMDAT section with selection kind
    822 ``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_LARGEST`` containing the contents of the ``@foo`` symbol
    823 and another COMDAT section with selection kind
    824 ``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_ASSOCIATIVE`` which is associated with the first COMDAT
    825 section and contains the contents of the ``@bar`` symbol.
    826 
    827 There are some restrictions on the properties of the global object.
    828 It, or an alias to it, must have the same name as the COMDAT group when
    829 targeting COFF.
    830 The contents and size of this object may be used during link-time to determine
    831 which COMDAT groups get selected depending on the selection kind.
    832 Because the name of the object must match the name of the COMDAT group, the
    833 linkage of the global object must not be local; local symbols can get renamed
    834 if a collision occurs in the symbol table.
    835 
    836 The combined use of COMDATS and section attributes may yield surprising results.
    837 For example:
    838 
    839 .. code-block:: llvm
    840 
    841    $foo = comdat any
    842    $bar = comdat any
    843    @g1 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($foo)
    844    @g2 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($bar)
    845 
    846 From the object file perspective, this requires the creation of two sections
    847 with the same name. This is necessary because both globals belong to different
    848 COMDAT groups and COMDATs, at the object file level, are represented by
    849 sections.
    850 
    851 Note that certain IR constructs like global variables and functions may
    852 create COMDATs in the object file in addition to any which are specified using
    853 COMDAT IR. This arises when the code generator is configured to emit globals
    854 in individual sections (e.g. when `-data-sections` or `-function-sections`
    855 is supplied to `llc`).
    856 
    857 .. _namedmetadatastructure:
    858 
    859 Named Metadata
    860 --------------
    861 
    862 Named metadata is a collection of metadata. :ref:`Metadata
    863 nodes <metadata>` (but not metadata strings) are the only valid
    864 operands for a named metadata.
    865 
    866 #. Named metadata are represented as a string of characters with the
    867    metadata prefix. The rules for metadata names are the same as for
    868    identifiers, but quoted names are not allowed. ``"\xx"`` type escapes
    869    are still valid, which allows any character to be part of a name.
    870 
    871 Syntax::
    872 
    873     ; Some unnamed metadata nodes, which are referenced by the named metadata.
    874     !0 = !{!"zero"}
    875     !1 = !{!"one"}
    876     !2 = !{!"two"}
    877     ; A named metadata.
    878     !name = !{!0, !1, !2}
    879 
    880 .. _paramattrs:
    881 
    882 Parameter Attributes
    883 --------------------
    884 
    885 The return type and each parameter of a function type may have a set of
    886 *parameter attributes* associated with them. Parameter attributes are
    887 used to communicate additional information about the result or
    888 parameters of a function. Parameter attributes are considered to be part
    889 of the function, not of the function type, so functions with different
    890 parameter attributes can have the same function type.
    891 
    892 Parameter attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
    893 If multiple parameter attributes are needed, they are space separated.
    894 For example:
    895 
    896 .. code-block:: llvm
    897 
    898     declare i32 @printf(i8* noalias nocapture, ...)
    899     declare i32 @atoi(i8 zeroext)
    900     declare signext i8 @returns_signed_char()
    901 
    902 Note that any attributes for the function result (``nounwind``,
    903 ``readonly``) come immediately after the argument list.
    904 
    905 Currently, only the following parameter attributes are defined:
    906 
    907 ``zeroext``
    908     This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
    909     value should be zero-extended to the extent required by the target's
    910     ABI (which is usually 32-bits, but is 8-bits for a i1 on x86-64) by
    911     the caller (for a parameter) or the callee (for a return value).
    912 ``signext``
    913     This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
    914     value should be sign-extended to the extent required by the target's
    915     ABI (which is usually 32-bits) by the caller (for a parameter) or
    916     the callee (for a return value).
    917 ``inreg``
    918     This indicates that this parameter or return value should be treated
    919     in a special target-dependent fashion while emitting code for
    920     a function call or return (usually, by putting it in a register as
    921     opposed to memory, though some targets use it to distinguish between
    922     two different kinds of registers). Use of this attribute is
    923     target-specific.
    924 ``byval``
    925     This indicates that the pointer parameter should really be passed by
    926     value to the function. The attribute implies that a hidden copy of
    927     the pointee is made between the caller and the callee, so the callee
    928     is unable to modify the value in the caller. This attribute is only
    929     valid on LLVM pointer arguments. It is generally used to pass
    930     structs and arrays by value, but is also valid on pointers to
    931     scalars. The copy is considered to belong to the caller not the
    932     callee (for example, ``readonly`` functions should not write to
    933     ``byval`` parameters). This is not a valid attribute for return
    934     values.
    935 
    936     The byval attribute also supports specifying an alignment with the
    937     align attribute. It indicates the alignment of the stack slot to
    938     form and the known alignment of the pointer specified to the call
    939     site. If the alignment is not specified, then the code generator
    940     makes a target-specific assumption.
    941 
    942 .. _attr_inalloca:
    943 
    944 ``inalloca``
    945 
    946     The ``inalloca`` argument attribute allows the caller to take the
    947     address of outgoing stack arguments. An ``inalloca`` argument must
    948     be a pointer to stack memory produced by an ``alloca`` instruction.
    949     The alloca, or argument allocation, must also be tagged with the
    950     inalloca keyword. Only the last argument may have the ``inalloca``
    951     attribute, and that argument is guaranteed to be passed in memory.
    952 
    953     An argument allocation may be used by a call at most once because
    954     the call may deallocate it. The ``inalloca`` attribute cannot be
    955     used in conjunction with other attributes that affect argument
    956     storage, like ``inreg``, ``nest``, ``sret``, or ``byval``. The
    957     ``inalloca`` attribute also disables LLVM's implicit lowering of
    958     large aggregate return values, which means that frontend authors
    959     must lower them with ``sret`` pointers.
    960 
    961     When the call site is reached, the argument allocation must have
    962     been the most recent stack allocation that is still live, or the
    963     results are undefined. It is possible to allocate additional stack
    964     space after an argument allocation and before its call site, but it
    965     must be cleared off with :ref:`llvm.stackrestore
    966     <int_stackrestore>`.
    967 
    968     See :doc:`InAlloca` for more information on how to use this
    969     attribute.
    970 
    971 ``sret``
    972     This indicates that the pointer parameter specifies the address of a
    973     structure that is the return value of the function in the source
    974     program. This pointer must be guaranteed by the caller to be valid:
    975     loads and stores to the structure may be assumed by the callee
    976     not to trap and to be properly aligned. This may only be applied to
    977     the first parameter. This is not a valid attribute for return
    978     values.
    979 
    980 ``align <n>``
    981     This indicates that the pointer value may be assumed by the optimizer to
    982     have the specified alignment.
    983 
    984     Note that this attribute has additional semantics when combined with the
    985     ``byval`` attribute.
    986 
    987 .. _noalias:
    988 
    989 ``noalias``
    990     This indicates that objects accessed via pointer values
    991     :ref:`based <pointeraliasing>` on the argument or return value are not also
    992     accessed, during the execution of the function, via pointer values not
    993     *based* on the argument or return value. The attribute on a return value
    994     also has additional semantics described below. The caller shares the
    995     responsibility with the callee for ensuring that these requirements are met.
    996     For further details, please see the discussion of the NoAlias response in
    997     :ref:`alias analysis <Must, May, or No>`.
    998 
    999     Note that this definition of ``noalias`` is intentionally similar
   1000     to the definition of ``restrict`` in C99 for function arguments.
   1001 
   1002     For function return values, C99's ``restrict`` is not meaningful,
   1003     while LLVM's ``noalias`` is. Furthermore, the semantics of the ``noalias``
   1004     attribute on return values are stronger than the semantics of the attribute
   1005     when used on function arguments. On function return values, the ``noalias``
   1006     attribute indicates that the function acts like a system memory allocation
   1007     function, returning a pointer to allocated storage disjoint from the
   1008     storage for any other object accessible to the caller.
   1009 
   1010 ``nocapture``
   1011     This indicates that the callee does not make any copies of the
   1012     pointer that outlive the callee itself. This is not a valid
   1013     attribute for return values.
   1014 
   1015 .. _nest:
   1016 
   1017 ``nest``
   1018     This indicates that the pointer parameter can be excised using the
   1019     :ref:`trampoline intrinsics <int_trampoline>`. This is not a valid
   1020     attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
   1021 
   1022 ``returned``
   1023     This indicates that the function always returns the argument as its return
   1024     value. This is an optimization hint to the code generator when generating
   1025     the caller, allowing tail call optimization and omission of register saves
   1026     and restores in some cases; it is not checked or enforced when generating
   1027     the callee. The parameter and the function return type must be valid
   1028     operands for the :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`. This is not a
   1029     valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
   1030 
   1031 ``nonnull``
   1032     This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is not null. This
   1033     attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. This is not
   1034     checked or enforced by LLVM, the caller must ensure that the pointer
   1035     passed in is non-null, or the callee must ensure that the returned pointer
   1036     is non-null.
   1037 
   1038 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
   1039     This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is dereferenceable. This
   1040     attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. A pointer that
   1041     is dereferenceable can be loaded from speculatively without a risk of
   1042     trapping. The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable must be provided
   1043     in parentheses. It is legal for the number of bytes to be less than the
   1044     size of the pointee type. The ``nonnull`` attribute does not imply
   1045     dereferenceability (consider a pointer to one element past the end of an
   1046     array), however ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` does imply ``nonnull`` in
   1047     ``addrspace(0)`` (which is the default address space).
   1048 
   1049 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
   1050     This indicates that the parameter or return value isn't both
   1051     non-null and non-dereferenceable (up to ``<n>`` bytes) at the same
   1052     time. All non-null pointers tagged with
   1053     ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` are ``dereferenceable(<n>)``.
   1054     For address space 0 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` implies that
   1055     a pointer is exactly one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` or ``null``,
   1056     and in other address spaces ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
   1057     implies that a pointer is at least one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
   1058     or ``null`` (i.e. it may be both ``null`` and
   1059     ``dereferenceable(<n>)``). This attribute may only be applied to
   1060     pointer typed parameters.
   1061 
   1062 .. _gc:
   1063 
   1064 Garbage Collector Strategy Names
   1065 --------------------------------
   1066 
   1067 Each function may specify a garbage collector strategy name, which is simply a
   1068 string:
   1069 
   1070 .. code-block:: llvm
   1071 
   1072     define void @f() gc "name" { ... }
   1073 
   1074 The supported values of *name* includes those :ref:`built in to LLVM
   1075 <builtin-gc-strategies>` and any provided by loaded plugins. Specifying a GC
   1076 strategy will cause the compiler to alter its output in order to support the
   1077 named garbage collection algorithm. Note that LLVM itself does not contain a
   1078 garbage collector, this functionality is restricted to generating machine code
   1079 which can interoperate with a collector provided externally.
   1080 
   1081 .. _prefixdata:
   1082 
   1083 Prefix Data
   1084 -----------
   1085 
   1086 Prefix data is data associated with a function which the code
   1087 generator will emit immediately before the function's entrypoint.
   1088 The purpose of this feature is to allow frontends to associate
   1089 language-specific runtime metadata with specific functions and make it
   1090 available through the function pointer while still allowing the
   1091 function pointer to be called.
   1092 
   1093 To access the data for a given function, a program may bitcast the
   1094 function pointer to a pointer to the constant's type and dereference
   1095 index -1. This implies that the IR symbol points just past the end of
   1096 the prefix data. For instance, take the example of a function annotated
   1097 with a single ``i32``,
   1098 
   1099 .. code-block:: llvm
   1100 
   1101     define void @f() prefix i32 123 { ... }
   1102 
   1103 The prefix data can be referenced as,
   1104 
   1105 .. code-block:: llvm
   1106 
   1107     %0 = bitcast void* () @f to i32*
   1108     %a = getelementptr inbounds i32, i32* %0, i32 -1
   1109     %b = load i32, i32* %a
   1110 
   1111 Prefix data is laid out as if it were an initializer for a global variable
   1112 of the prefix data's type. The function will be placed such that the
   1113 beginning of the prefix data is aligned. This means that if the size
   1114 of the prefix data is not a multiple of the alignment size, the
   1115 function's entrypoint will not be aligned. If alignment of the
   1116 function's entrypoint is desired, padding must be added to the prefix
   1117 data.
   1118 
   1119 A function may have prefix data but no body. This has similar semantics
   1120 to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
   1121 optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
   1122 
   1123 .. _prologuedata:
   1124 
   1125 Prologue Data
   1126 -------------
   1127 
   1128 The ``prologue`` attribute allows arbitrary code (encoded as bytes) to
   1129 be inserted prior to the function body. This can be used for enabling
   1130 function hot-patching and instrumentation.
   1131 
   1132 To maintain the semantics of ordinary function calls, the prologue data must
   1133 have a particular format. Specifically, it must begin with a sequence of
   1134 bytes which decode to a sequence of machine instructions, valid for the
   1135 module's target, which transfer control to the point immediately succeeding
   1136 the prologue data, without performing any other visible action. This allows
   1137 the inliner and other passes to reason about the semantics of the function
   1138 definition without needing to reason about the prologue data. Obviously this
   1139 makes the format of the prologue data highly target dependent.
   1140 
   1141 A trivial example of valid prologue data for the x86 architecture is ``i8 144``,
   1142 which encodes the ``nop`` instruction:
   1143 
   1144 .. code-block:: llvm
   1145 
   1146     define void @f() prologue i8 144 { ... }
   1147 
   1148 Generally prologue data can be formed by encoding a relative branch instruction
   1149 which skips the metadata, as in this example of valid prologue data for the
   1150 x86_64 architecture, where the first two bytes encode ``jmp .+10``:
   1151 
   1152 .. code-block:: llvm
   1153 
   1154     %0 = type <{ i8, i8, i8* }>
   1155 
   1156     define void @f() prologue %0 <{ i8 235, i8 8, i8* @md}> { ... }
   1157 
   1158 A function may have prologue data but no body. This has similar semantics
   1159 to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
   1160 optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
   1161 
   1162 .. _personalityfn:
   1163 
   1164 Personality Function
   1165 --------------------
   1166 
   1167 The ``personality`` attribute permits functions to specify what function
   1168 to use for exception handling.
   1169 
   1170 .. _attrgrp:
   1171 
   1172 Attribute Groups
   1173 ----------------
   1174 
   1175 Attribute groups are groups of attributes that are referenced by objects within
   1176 the IR. They are important for keeping ``.ll`` files readable, because a lot of
   1177 functions will use the same set of attributes. In the degenerative case of a
   1178 ``.ll`` file that corresponds to a single ``.c`` file, the single attribute
   1179 group will capture the important command line flags used to build that file.
   1180 
   1181 An attribute group is a module-level object. To use an attribute group, an
   1182 object references the attribute group's ID (e.g. ``#37``). An object may refer
   1183 to more than one attribute group. In that situation, the attributes from the
   1184 different groups are merged.
   1185 
   1186 Here is an example of attribute groups for a function that should always be
   1187 inlined, has a stack alignment of 4, and which shouldn't use SSE instructions:
   1188 
   1189 .. code-block:: llvm
   1190 
   1191    ; Target-independent attributes:
   1192    attributes #0 = { alwaysinline alignstack=4 }
   1193 
   1194    ; Target-dependent attributes:
   1195    attributes #1 = { "no-sse" }
   1196 
   1197    ; Function @f has attributes: alwaysinline, alignstack=4, and "no-sse".
   1198    define void @f() #0 #1 { ... }
   1199 
   1200 .. _fnattrs:
   1201 
   1202 Function Attributes
   1203 -------------------
   1204 
   1205 Function attributes are set to communicate additional information about
   1206 a function. Function attributes are considered to be part of the
   1207 function, not of the function type, so functions with different function
   1208 attributes can have the same function type.
   1209 
   1210 Function attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
   1211 If multiple attributes are needed, they are space separated. For
   1212 example:
   1213 
   1214 .. code-block:: llvm
   1215 
   1216     define void @f() noinline { ... }
   1217     define void @f() alwaysinline { ... }
   1218     define void @f() alwaysinline optsize { ... }
   1219     define void @f() optsize { ... }
   1220 
   1221 ``alignstack(<n>)``
   1222     This attribute indicates that, when emitting the prologue and
   1223     epilogue, the backend should forcibly align the stack pointer.
   1224     Specify the desired alignment, which must be a power of two, in
   1225     parentheses.
   1226 ``alwaysinline``
   1227     This attribute indicates that the inliner should attempt to inline
   1228     this function into callers whenever possible, ignoring any active
   1229     inlining size threshold for this caller.
   1230 ``builtin``
   1231     This indicates that the callee function at a call site should be
   1232     recognized as a built-in function, even though the function's declaration
   1233     uses the ``nobuiltin`` attribute. This is only valid at call sites for
   1234     direct calls to functions that are declared with the ``nobuiltin``
   1235     attribute.
   1236 ``cold``
   1237     This attribute indicates that this function is rarely called. When
   1238     computing edge weights, basic blocks post-dominated by a cold
   1239     function call are also considered to be cold; and, thus, given low
   1240     weight.
   1241 ``convergent``
   1242     This attribute indicates that the callee is dependent on a convergent
   1243     thread execution pattern under certain parallel execution models.
   1244     Transformations that are execution model agnostic may not make the execution
   1245     of a convergent operation control dependent on any additional values.
   1246 ``inaccessiblememonly``
   1247     This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that
   1248     is not accessible by the module being compiled. This is a weaker form
   1249     of ``readnone``.
   1250 ``inaccessiblemem_or_argmemonly``
   1251     This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that is
   1252     either not accessible by the module being compiled, or is pointed to
   1253     by its pointer arguments. This is a weaker form of  ``argmemonly``
   1254 ``inlinehint``
   1255     This attribute indicates that the source code contained a hint that
   1256     inlining this function is desirable (such as the "inline" keyword in
   1257     C/C++). It is just a hint; it imposes no requirements on the
   1258     inliner.
   1259 ``jumptable``
   1260     This attribute indicates that the function should be added to a
   1261     jump-instruction table at code-generation time, and that all address-taken
   1262     references to this function should be replaced with a reference to the
   1263     appropriate jump-instruction-table function pointer. Note that this creates
   1264     a new pointer for the original function, which means that code that depends
   1265     on function-pointer identity can break. So, any function annotated with
   1266     ``jumptable`` must also be ``unnamed_addr``.
   1267 ``minsize``
   1268     This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
   1269     passes make choices that keep the code size of this function as small
   1270     as possible and perform optimizations that may sacrifice runtime
   1271     performance in order to minimize the size of the generated code.
   1272 ``naked``
   1273     This attribute disables prologue / epilogue emission for the
   1274     function. This can have very system-specific consequences.
   1275 ``nobuiltin``
   1276     This indicates that the callee function at a call site is not recognized as
   1277     a built-in function. LLVM will retain the original call and not replace it
   1278     with equivalent code based on the semantics of the built-in function, unless
   1279     the call site uses the ``builtin`` attribute. This is valid at call sites
   1280     and on function declarations and definitions.
   1281 ``noduplicate``
   1282     This attribute indicates that calls to the function cannot be
   1283     duplicated. A call to a ``noduplicate`` function may be moved
   1284     within its parent function, but may not be duplicated within
   1285     its parent function.
   1286 
   1287     A function containing a ``noduplicate`` call may still
   1288     be an inlining candidate, provided that the call is not
   1289     duplicated by inlining. That implies that the function has
   1290     internal linkage and only has one call site, so the original
   1291     call is dead after inlining.
   1292 ``noimplicitfloat``
   1293     This attributes disables implicit floating point instructions.
   1294 ``noinline``
   1295     This attribute indicates that the inliner should never inline this
   1296     function in any situation. This attribute may not be used together
   1297     with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute.
   1298 ``nonlazybind``
   1299     This attribute suppresses lazy symbol binding for the function. This
   1300     may make calls to the function faster, at the cost of extra program
   1301     startup time if the function is not called during program startup.
   1302 ``noredzone``
   1303     This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use a
   1304     red zone, even if the target-specific ABI normally permits it.
   1305 ``noreturn``
   1306     This function attribute indicates that the function never returns
   1307     normally. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the
   1308     function ever does dynamically return.
   1309 ``norecurse``
   1310     This function attribute indicates that the function does not call itself
   1311     either directly or indirectly down any possible call path. This produces
   1312     undefined behavior at runtime if the function ever does recurse.
   1313 ``nounwind``
   1314     This function attribute indicates that the function never raises an
   1315     exception. If the function does raise an exception, its runtime
   1316     behavior is undefined. However, functions marked nounwind may still
   1317     trap or generate asynchronous exceptions. Exception handling schemes
   1318     that are recognized by LLVM to handle asynchronous exceptions, such
   1319     as SEH, will still provide their implementation defined semantics.
   1320 ``optnone``
   1321     This function attribute indicates that most optimization passes will skip
   1322     this function, with the exception of interprocedural optimization passes.
   1323     Code generation defaults to the "fast" instruction selector.
   1324     This attribute cannot be used together with the ``alwaysinline``
   1325     attribute; this attribute is also incompatible
   1326     with the ``minsize`` attribute and the ``optsize`` attribute.
   1327 
   1328     This attribute requires the ``noinline`` attribute to be specified on
   1329     the function as well, so the function is never inlined into any caller.
   1330     Only functions with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute are valid
   1331     candidates for inlining into the body of this function.
   1332 ``optsize``
   1333     This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
   1334     passes make choices that keep the code size of this function low,
   1335     and otherwise do optimizations specifically to reduce code size as
   1336     long as they do not significantly impact runtime performance.
   1337 ``readnone``
   1338     On a function, this attribute indicates that the function computes its
   1339     result (or decides to unwind an exception) based strictly on its arguments,
   1340     without dereferencing any pointer arguments or otherwise accessing
   1341     any mutable state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
   1342     caller functions. It does not write through any pointer arguments
   1343     (including ``byval`` arguments) and never changes any state visible
   1344     to callers. This means that it cannot unwind exceptions by calling
   1345     the ``C++`` exception throwing methods.
   1346 
   1347     On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not
   1348     dereference that pointer argument, even though it may read or write the
   1349     memory that the pointer points to if accessed through other pointers.
   1350 ``readonly``
   1351     On a function, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
   1352     through any pointer arguments (including ``byval`` arguments) or otherwise
   1353     modify any state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
   1354     caller functions. It may dereference pointer arguments and read
   1355     state that may be set in the caller. A readonly function always
   1356     returns the same value (or unwinds an exception identically) when
   1357     called with the same set of arguments and global state. It cannot
   1358     unwind an exception by calling the ``C++`` exception throwing
   1359     methods.
   1360 
   1361     On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
   1362     through this pointer argument, even though it may write to the memory that
   1363     the pointer points to.
   1364 ``argmemonly``
   1365     This attribute indicates that the only memory accesses inside function are
   1366     loads and stores from objects pointed to by its pointer-typed arguments,
   1367     with arbitrary offsets. Or in other words, all memory operations in the
   1368     function can refer to memory only using pointers based on its function
   1369     arguments.
   1370     Note that ``argmemonly`` can be used together with ``readonly`` attribute
   1371     in order to specify that function reads only from its arguments.
   1372 ``returns_twice``
   1373     This attribute indicates that this function can return twice. The C
   1374     ``setjmp`` is an example of such a function. The compiler disables
   1375     some optimizations (like tail calls) in the caller of these
   1376     functions.
   1377 ``safestack``
   1378     This attribute indicates that
   1379     `SafeStack <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/SafeStack.html>`_
   1380     protection is enabled for this function.
   1381 
   1382     If a function that has a ``safestack`` attribute is inlined into a
   1383     function that doesn't have a ``safestack`` attribute or which has an
   1384     ``ssp``, ``sspstrong`` or ``sspreq`` attribute, then the resulting
   1385     function will have a ``safestack`` attribute.
   1386 ``sanitize_address``
   1387     This attribute indicates that AddressSanitizer checks
   1388     (dynamic address safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
   1389 ``sanitize_memory``
   1390     This attribute indicates that MemorySanitizer checks (dynamic detection
   1391     of accesses to uninitialized memory) are enabled for this function.
   1392 ``sanitize_thread``
   1393     This attribute indicates that ThreadSanitizer checks
   1394     (dynamic thread safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
   1395 ``ssp``
   1396     This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack
   1397     smashing protector. It is in the form of a "canary" --- a random value
   1398     placed on the stack before the local variables that's checked upon
   1399     return from the function to see if it has been overwritten. A
   1400     heuristic is used to determine if a function needs stack protectors
   1401     or not. The heuristic used will enable protectors for functions with:
   1402 
   1403     - Character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size`` (default 8).
   1404     - Aggregates containing character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size``.
   1405     - Calls to alloca() with variable sizes or constant sizes greater than
   1406       ``ssp-buffer-size``.
   1407 
   1408     Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
   1409     on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
   1410 
   1411     If a function that has an ``ssp`` attribute is inlined into a
   1412     function that doesn't have an ``ssp`` attribute, then the resulting
   1413     function will have an ``ssp`` attribute.
   1414 ``sspreq``
   1415     This attribute indicates that the function should *always* emit a
   1416     stack smashing protector. This overrides the ``ssp`` function
   1417     attribute.
   1418 
   1419     Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
   1420     on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
   1421     The specific layout rules are:
   1422 
   1423     #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
   1424        (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
   1425     #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
   1426        (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
   1427     #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
   1428        protector.
   1429 
   1430     If a function that has an ``sspreq`` attribute is inlined into a
   1431     function that doesn't have an ``sspreq`` attribute or which has an
   1432     ``ssp`` or ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the resulting function will have
   1433     an ``sspreq`` attribute.
   1434 ``sspstrong``
   1435     This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing
   1436     protector. This attribute causes a strong heuristic to be used when
   1437     determining if a function needs stack protectors. The strong heuristic
   1438     will enable protectors for functions with:
   1439 
   1440     - Arrays of any size and type
   1441     - Aggregates containing an array of any size and type.
   1442     - Calls to alloca().
   1443     - Local variables that have had their address taken.
   1444 
   1445     Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
   1446     on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
   1447     The specific layout rules are:
   1448 
   1449     #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
   1450        (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
   1451     #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
   1452        (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
   1453     #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
   1454        protector.
   1455 
   1456     This overrides the ``ssp`` function attribute.
   1457 
   1458     If a function that has an ``sspstrong`` attribute is inlined into a
   1459     function that doesn't have an ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the
   1460     resulting function will have an ``sspstrong`` attribute.
   1461 ``"thunk"``
   1462     This attribute indicates that the function will delegate to some other
   1463     function with a tail call. The prototype of a thunk should not be used for
   1464     optimization purposes. The caller is expected to cast the thunk prototype to
   1465     match the thunk target prototype.
   1466 ``uwtable``
   1467     This attribute indicates that the ABI being targeted requires that
   1468     an unwind table entry be produced for this function even if we can
   1469     show that no exceptions passes by it. This is normally the case for
   1470     the ELF x86-64 abi, but it can be disabled for some compilation
   1471     units.
   1472 
   1473 
   1474 .. _opbundles:
   1475 
   1476 Operand Bundles
   1477 ---------------
   1478 
   1479 Note: operand bundles are a work in progress, and they should be
   1480 considered experimental at this time.
   1481 
   1482 Operand bundles are tagged sets of SSA values that can be associated
   1483 with certain LLVM instructions (currently only ``call`` s and
   1484 ``invoke`` s).  In a way they are like metadata, but dropping them is
   1485 incorrect and will change program semantics.
   1486 
   1487 Syntax::
   1488 
   1489     operand bundle set ::= '[' operand bundle (, operand bundle )* ']'
   1490     operand bundle ::= tag '(' [ bundle operand ] (, bundle operand )* ')'
   1491     bundle operand ::= SSA value
   1492     tag ::= string constant
   1493 
   1494 Operand bundles are **not** part of a function's signature, and a
   1495 given function may be called from multiple places with different kinds
   1496 of operand bundles.  This reflects the fact that the operand bundles
   1497 are conceptually a part of the ``call`` (or ``invoke``), not the
   1498 callee being dispatched to.
   1499 
   1500 Operand bundles are a generic mechanism intended to support
   1501 runtime-introspection-like functionality for managed languages.  While
   1502 the exact semantics of an operand bundle depend on the bundle tag,
   1503 there are certain limitations to how much the presence of an operand
   1504 bundle can influence the semantics of a program.  These restrictions
   1505 are described as the semantics of an "unknown" operand bundle.  As
   1506 long as the behavior of an operand bundle is describable within these
   1507 restrictions, LLVM does not need to have special knowledge of the
   1508 operand bundle to not miscompile programs containing it.
   1509 
   1510 - The bundle operands for an unknown operand bundle escape in unknown
   1511   ways before control is transferred to the callee or invokee.
   1512 - Calls and invokes with operand bundles have unknown read / write
   1513   effect on the heap on entry and exit (even if the call target is
   1514   ``readnone`` or ``readonly``), unless they're overriden with
   1515   callsite specific attributes.
   1516 - An operand bundle at a call site cannot change the implementation
   1517   of the called function.  Inter-procedural optimizations work as
   1518   usual as long as they take into account the first two properties.
   1519 
   1520 More specific types of operand bundles are described below.
   1521 
   1522 Deoptimization Operand Bundles
   1523 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   1524 
   1525 Deoptimization operand bundles are characterized by the ``"deopt"``
   1526 operand bundle tag.  These operand bundles represent an alternate
   1527 "safe" continuation for the call site they're attached to, and can be
   1528 used by a suitable runtime to deoptimize the compiled frame at the
   1529 specified call site.  There can be at most one ``"deopt"`` operand
   1530 bundle attached to a call site.  Exact details of deoptimization is
   1531 out of scope for the language reference, but it usually involves
   1532 rewriting a compiled frame into a set of interpreted frames.
   1533 
   1534 From the compiler's perspective, deoptimization operand bundles make
   1535 the call sites they're attached to at least ``readonly``.  They read
   1536 through all of their pointer typed operands (even if they're not
   1537 otherwise escaped) and the entire visible heap.  Deoptimization
   1538 operand bundles do not capture their operands except during
   1539 deoptimization, in which case control will not be returned to the
   1540 compiled frame.
   1541 
   1542 The inliner knows how to inline through calls that have deoptimization
   1543 operand bundles.  Just like inlining through a normal call site
   1544 involves composing the normal and exceptional continuations, inlining
   1545 through a call site with a deoptimization operand bundle needs to
   1546 appropriately compose the "safe" deoptimization continuation.  The
   1547 inliner does this by prepending the parent's deoptimization
   1548 continuation to every deoptimization continuation in the inlined body.
   1549 E.g. inlining ``@f`` into ``@g`` in the following example
   1550 
   1551 .. code-block:: llvm
   1552 
   1553     define void @f() {
   1554       call void @x()  ;; no deopt state
   1555       call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10) ]
   1556       call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
   1557       ret void
   1558     }
   1559 
   1560     define void @g() {
   1561       call void @f() [ "deopt"(i32 20) ]
   1562       ret void
   1563     }
   1564 
   1565 will result in
   1566 
   1567 .. code-block:: llvm
   1568 
   1569     define void @g() {
   1570       call void @x()  ;; still no deopt state
   1571       call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10) ]
   1572       call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
   1573       ret void
   1574     }
   1575 
   1576 It is the frontend's responsibility to structure or encode the
   1577 deoptimization state in a way that syntactically prepending the
   1578 caller's deoptimization state to the callee's deoptimization state is
   1579 semantically equivalent to composing the caller's deoptimization
   1580 continuation after the callee's deoptimization continuation.
   1581 
   1582 Funclet Operand Bundles
   1583 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   1584 
   1585 Funclet operand bundles are characterized by the ``"funclet"``
   1586 operand bundle tag.  These operand bundles indicate that a call site
   1587 is within a particular funclet.  There can be at most one
   1588 ``"funclet"`` operand bundle attached to a call site and it must have
   1589 exactly one bundle operand.
   1590 
   1591 .. _moduleasm:
   1592 
   1593 Module-Level Inline Assembly
   1594 ----------------------------
   1595 
   1596 Modules may contain "module-level inline asm" blocks, which corresponds
   1597 to the GCC "file scope inline asm" blocks. These blocks are internally
   1598 concatenated by LLVM and treated as a single unit, but may be separated
   1599 in the ``.ll`` file if desired. The syntax is very simple:
   1600 
   1601 .. code-block:: llvm
   1602 
   1603     module asm "inline asm code goes here"
   1604     module asm "more can go here"
   1605 
   1606 The strings can contain any character by escaping non-printable
   1607 characters. The escape sequence used is simply "\\xx" where "xx" is the
   1608 two digit hex code for the number.
   1609 
   1610 Note that the assembly string *must* be parseable by LLVM's integrated assembler
   1611 (unless it is disabled), even when emitting a ``.s`` file.
   1612 
   1613 .. _langref_datalayout:
   1614 
   1615 Data Layout
   1616 -----------
   1617 
   1618 A module may specify a target specific data layout string that specifies
   1619 how data is to be laid out in memory. The syntax for the data layout is
   1620 simply:
   1621 
   1622 .. code-block:: llvm
   1623 
   1624     target datalayout = "layout specification"
   1625 
   1626 The *layout specification* consists of a list of specifications
   1627 separated by the minus sign character ('-'). Each specification starts
   1628 with a letter and may include other information after the letter to
   1629 define some aspect of the data layout. The specifications accepted are
   1630 as follows:
   1631 
   1632 ``E``
   1633     Specifies that the target lays out data in big-endian form. That is,
   1634     the bits with the most significance have the lowest address
   1635     location.
   1636 ``e``
   1637     Specifies that the target lays out data in little-endian form. That
   1638     is, the bits with the least significance have the lowest address
   1639     location.
   1640 ``S<size>``
   1641     Specifies the natural alignment of the stack in bits. Alignment
   1642     promotion of stack variables is limited to the natural stack
   1643     alignment to avoid dynamic stack realignment. The stack alignment
   1644     must be a multiple of 8-bits. If omitted, the natural stack
   1645     alignment defaults to "unspecified", which does not prevent any
   1646     alignment promotions.
   1647 ``p[n]:<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
   1648     This specifies the *size* of a pointer and its ``<abi>`` and
   1649     ``<pref>``\erred alignments for address space ``n``. All sizes are in
   1650     bits. The address space, ``n``, is optional, and if not specified,
   1651     denotes the default address space 0. The value of ``n`` must be
   1652     in the range [1,2^23).
   1653 ``i<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
   1654     This specifies the alignment for an integer type of a given bit
   1655     ``<size>``. The value of ``<size>`` must be in the range [1,2^23).
   1656 ``v<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
   1657     This specifies the alignment for a vector type of a given bit
   1658     ``<size>``.
   1659 ``f<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
   1660     This specifies the alignment for a floating point type of a given bit
   1661     ``<size>``. Only values of ``<size>`` that are supported by the target
   1662     will work. 32 (float) and 64 (double) are supported on all targets; 80
   1663     or 128 (different flavors of long double) are also supported on some
   1664     targets.
   1665 ``a:<abi>:<pref>``
   1666     This specifies the alignment for an object of aggregate type.
   1667 ``m:<mangling>``
   1668     If present, specifies that llvm names are mangled in the output. The
   1669     options are
   1670 
   1671     * ``e``: ELF mangling: Private symbols get a ``.L`` prefix.
   1672     * ``m``: Mips mangling: Private symbols get a ``$`` prefix.
   1673     * ``o``: Mach-O mangling: Private symbols get ``L`` prefix. Other
   1674       symbols get a ``_`` prefix.
   1675     * ``w``: Windows COFF prefix:  Similar to Mach-O, but stdcall and fastcall
   1676       functions also get a suffix based on the frame size.
   1677     * ``x``: Windows x86 COFF prefix:  Similar to Windows COFF, but use a ``_``
   1678       prefix for ``__cdecl`` functions.
   1679 ``n<size1>:<size2>:<size3>...``
   1680     This specifies a set of native integer widths for the target CPU in
   1681     bits. For example, it might contain ``n32`` for 32-bit PowerPC,
   1682     ``n32:64`` for PowerPC 64, or ``n8:16:32:64`` for X86-64. Elements of
   1683     this set are considered to support most general arithmetic operations
   1684     efficiently.
   1685 
   1686 On every specification that takes a ``<abi>:<pref>``, specifying the
   1687 ``<pref>`` alignment is optional. If omitted, the preceding ``:``
   1688 should be omitted too and ``<pref>`` will be equal to ``<abi>``.
   1689 
   1690 When constructing the data layout for a given target, LLVM starts with a
   1691 default set of specifications which are then (possibly) overridden by
   1692 the specifications in the ``datalayout`` keyword. The default
   1693 specifications are given in this list:
   1694 
   1695 -  ``E`` - big endian
   1696 -  ``p:64:64:64`` - 64-bit pointers with 64-bit alignment.
   1697 -  ``p[n]:64:64:64`` - Other address spaces are assumed to be the
   1698    same as the default address space.
   1699 -  ``S0`` - natural stack alignment is unspecified
   1700 -  ``i1:8:8`` - i1 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
   1701 -  ``i8:8:8`` - i8 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
   1702 -  ``i16:16:16`` - i16 is 16-bit aligned
   1703 -  ``i32:32:32`` - i32 is 32-bit aligned
   1704 -  ``i64:32:64`` - i64 has ABI alignment of 32-bits but preferred
   1705    alignment of 64-bits
   1706 -  ``f16:16:16`` - half is 16-bit aligned
   1707 -  ``f32:32:32`` - float is 32-bit aligned
   1708 -  ``f64:64:64`` - double is 64-bit aligned
   1709 -  ``f128:128:128`` - quad is 128-bit aligned
   1710 -  ``v64:64:64`` - 64-bit vector is 64-bit aligned
   1711 -  ``v128:128:128`` - 128-bit vector is 128-bit aligned
   1712 -  ``a:0:64`` - aggregates are 64-bit aligned
   1713 
   1714 When LLVM is determining the alignment for a given type, it uses the
   1715 following rules:
   1716 
   1717 #. If the type sought is an exact match for one of the specifications,
   1718    that specification is used.
   1719 #. If no match is found, and the type sought is an integer type, then
   1720    the smallest integer type that is larger than the bitwidth of the
   1721    sought type is used. If none of the specifications are larger than
   1722    the bitwidth then the largest integer type is used. For example,
   1723    given the default specifications above, the i7 type will use the
   1724    alignment of i8 (next largest) while both i65 and i256 will use the
   1725    alignment of i64 (largest specified).
   1726 #. If no match is found, and the type sought is a vector type, then the
   1727    largest vector type that is smaller than the sought vector type will
   1728    be used as a fall back. This happens because <128 x double> can be
   1729    implemented in terms of 64 <2 x double>, for example.
   1730 
   1731 The function of the data layout string may not be what you expect.
   1732 Notably, this is not a specification from the frontend of what alignment
   1733 the code generator should use.
   1734 
   1735 Instead, if specified, the target data layout is required to match what
   1736 the ultimate *code generator* expects. This string is used by the
   1737 mid-level optimizers to improve code, and this only works if it matches
   1738 what the ultimate code generator uses. There is no way to generate IR
   1739 that does not embed this target-specific detail into the IR. If you
   1740 don't specify the string, the default specifications will be used to
   1741 generate a Data Layout and the optimization phases will operate
   1742 accordingly and introduce target specificity into the IR with respect to
   1743 these default specifications.
   1744 
   1745 .. _langref_triple:
   1746 
   1747 Target Triple
   1748 -------------
   1749 
   1750 A module may specify a target triple string that describes the target
   1751 host. The syntax for the target triple is simply:
   1752 
   1753 .. code-block:: llvm
   1754 
   1755     target triple = "x86_64-apple-macosx10.7.0"
   1756 
   1757 The *target triple* string consists of a series of identifiers delimited
   1758 by the minus sign character ('-'). The canonical forms are:
   1759 
   1760 ::
   1761 
   1762     ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM
   1763     ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM-ENVIRONMENT
   1764 
   1765 This information is passed along to the backend so that it generates
   1766 code for the proper architecture. It's possible to override this on the
   1767 command line with the ``-mtriple`` command line option.
   1768 
   1769 .. _pointeraliasing:
   1770 
   1771 Pointer Aliasing Rules
   1772 ----------------------
   1773 
   1774 Any memory access must be done through a pointer value associated with
   1775 an address range of the memory access, otherwise the behavior is
   1776 undefined. Pointer values are associated with address ranges according
   1777 to the following rules:
   1778 
   1779 -  A pointer value is associated with the addresses associated with any
   1780    value it is *based* on.
   1781 -  An address of a global variable is associated with the address range
   1782    of the variable's storage.
   1783 -  The result value of an allocation instruction is associated with the
   1784    address range of the allocated storage.
   1785 -  A null pointer in the default address-space is associated with no
   1786    address.
   1787 -  An integer constant other than zero or a pointer value returned from
   1788    a function not defined within LLVM may be associated with address
   1789    ranges allocated through mechanisms other than those provided by
   1790    LLVM. Such ranges shall not overlap with any ranges of addresses
   1791    allocated by mechanisms provided by LLVM.
   1792 
   1793 A pointer value is *based* on another pointer value according to the
   1794 following rules:
   1795 
   1796 -  A pointer value formed from a ``getelementptr`` operation is *based*
   1797    on the first value operand of the ``getelementptr``.
   1798 -  The result value of a ``bitcast`` is *based* on the operand of the
   1799    ``bitcast``.
   1800 -  A pointer value formed by an ``inttoptr`` is *based* on all pointer
   1801    values that contribute (directly or indirectly) to the computation of
   1802    the pointer's value.
   1803 -  The "*based* on" relationship is transitive.
   1804 
   1805 Note that this definition of *"based"* is intentionally similar to the
   1806 definition of *"based"* in C99, though it is slightly weaker.
   1807 
   1808 LLVM IR does not associate types with memory. The result type of a
   1809 ``load`` merely indicates the size and alignment of the memory from
   1810 which to load, as well as the interpretation of the value. The first
   1811 operand type of a ``store`` similarly only indicates the size and
   1812 alignment of the store.
   1813 
   1814 Consequently, type-based alias analysis, aka TBAA, aka
   1815 ``-fstrict-aliasing``, is not applicable to general unadorned LLVM IR.
   1816 :ref:`Metadata <metadata>` may be used to encode additional information
   1817 which specialized optimization passes may use to implement type-based
   1818 alias analysis.
   1819 
   1820 .. _volatile:
   1821 
   1822 Volatile Memory Accesses
   1823 ------------------------
   1824 
   1825 Certain memory accesses, such as :ref:`load <i_load>`'s,
   1826 :ref:`store <i_store>`'s, and :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`'s may be
   1827 marked ``volatile``. The optimizers must not change the number of
   1828 volatile operations or change their order of execution relative to other
   1829 volatile operations. The optimizers *may* change the order of volatile
   1830 operations relative to non-volatile operations. This is not Java's
   1831 "volatile" and has no cross-thread synchronization behavior.
   1832 
   1833 IR-level volatile loads and stores cannot safely be optimized into
   1834 llvm.memcpy or llvm.memmove intrinsics even when those intrinsics are
   1835 flagged volatile. Likewise, the backend should never split or merge
   1836 target-legal volatile load/store instructions.
   1837 
   1838 .. admonition:: Rationale
   1839 
   1840  Platforms may rely on volatile loads and stores of natively supported
   1841  data width to be executed as single instruction. For example, in C
   1842  this holds for an l-value of volatile primitive type with native
   1843  hardware support, but not necessarily for aggregate types. The
   1844  frontend upholds these expectations, which are intentionally
   1845  unspecified in the IR. The rules above ensure that IR transformations
   1846  do not violate the frontend's contract with the language.
   1847 
   1848 .. _memmodel:
   1849 
   1850 Memory Model for Concurrent Operations
   1851 --------------------------------------
   1852 
   1853 The LLVM IR does not define any way to start parallel threads of
   1854 execution or to register signal handlers. Nonetheless, there are
   1855 platform-specific ways to create them, and we define LLVM IR's behavior
   1856 in their presence. This model is inspired by the C++0x memory model.
   1857 
   1858 For a more informal introduction to this model, see the :doc:`Atomics`.
   1859 
   1860 We define a *happens-before* partial order as the least partial order
   1861 that
   1862 
   1863 -  Is a superset of single-thread program order, and
   1864 -  When a *synchronizes-with* ``b``, includes an edge from ``a`` to
   1865    ``b``. *Synchronizes-with* pairs are introduced by platform-specific
   1866    techniques, like pthread locks, thread creation, thread joining,
   1867    etc., and by atomic instructions. (See also :ref:`Atomic Memory Ordering
   1868    Constraints <ordering>`).
   1869 
   1870 Note that program order does not introduce *happens-before* edges
   1871 between a thread and signals executing inside that thread.
   1872 
   1873 Every (defined) read operation (load instructions, memcpy, atomic
   1874 loads/read-modify-writes, etc.) R reads a series of bytes written by
   1875 (defined) write operations (store instructions, atomic
   1876 stores/read-modify-writes, memcpy, etc.). For the purposes of this
   1877 section, initialized globals are considered to have a write of the
   1878 initializer which is atomic and happens before any other read or write
   1879 of the memory in question. For each byte of a read R, R\ :sub:`byte`
   1880 may see any write to the same byte, except:
   1881 
   1882 -  If write\ :sub:`1`  happens before write\ :sub:`2`, and
   1883    write\ :sub:`2` happens before R\ :sub:`byte`, then
   1884    R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`1`.
   1885 -  If R\ :sub:`byte` happens before write\ :sub:`3`, then
   1886    R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`3`.
   1887 
   1888 Given that definition, R\ :sub:`byte` is defined as follows:
   1889 
   1890 -  If R is volatile, the result is target-dependent. (Volatile is
   1891    supposed to give guarantees which can support ``sig_atomic_t`` in
   1892    C/C++, and may be used for accesses to addresses that do not behave
   1893    like normal memory. It does not generally provide cross-thread
   1894    synchronization.)
   1895 -  Otherwise, if there is no write to the same byte that happens before
   1896    R\ :sub:`byte`, R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef`` for that byte.
   1897 -  Otherwise, if R\ :sub:`byte` may see exactly one write,
   1898    R\ :sub:`byte` returns the value written by that write.
   1899 -  Otherwise, if R is atomic, and all the writes R\ :sub:`byte` may
   1900    see are atomic, it chooses one of the values written. See the :ref:`Atomic
   1901    Memory Ordering Constraints <ordering>` section for additional
   1902    constraints on how the choice is made.
   1903 -  Otherwise R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef``.
   1904 
   1905 R returns the value composed of the series of bytes it read. This
   1906 implies that some bytes within the value may be ``undef`` **without**
   1907 the entire value being ``undef``. Note that this only defines the
   1908 semantics of the operation; it doesn't mean that targets will emit more
   1909 than one instruction to read the series of bytes.
   1910 
   1911 Note that in cases where none of the atomic intrinsics are used, this
   1912 model places only one restriction on IR transformations on top of what
   1913 is required for single-threaded execution: introducing a store to a byte
   1914 which might not otherwise be stored is not allowed in general.
   1915 (Specifically, in the case where another thread might write to and read
   1916 from an address, introducing a store can change a load that may see
   1917 exactly one write into a load that may see multiple writes.)
   1918 
   1919 .. _ordering:
   1920 
   1921 Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints
   1922 ----------------------------------
   1923 
   1924 Atomic instructions (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>`,
   1925 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`, :ref:`fence <i_fence>`,
   1926 :ref:`atomic load <i_load>`, and :ref:`atomic store <i_store>`) take
   1927 ordering parameters that determine which other atomic instructions on
   1928 the same address they *synchronize with*. These semantics are borrowed
   1929 from Java and C++0x, but are somewhat more colloquial. If these
   1930 descriptions aren't precise enough, check those specs (see spec
   1931 references in the :doc:`atomics guide <Atomics>`).
   1932 :ref:`fence <i_fence>` instructions treat these orderings somewhat
   1933 differently since they don't take an address. See that instruction's
   1934 documentation for details.
   1935 
   1936 For a simpler introduction to the ordering constraints, see the
   1937 :doc:`Atomics`.
   1938 
   1939 ``unordered``
   1940     The set of values that can be read is governed by the happens-before
   1941     partial order. A value cannot be read unless some operation wrote
   1942     it. This is intended to provide a guarantee strong enough to model
   1943     Java's non-volatile shared variables. This ordering cannot be
   1944     specified for read-modify-write operations; it is not strong enough
   1945     to make them atomic in any interesting way.
   1946 ``monotonic``
   1947     In addition to the guarantees of ``unordered``, there is a single
   1948     total order for modifications by ``monotonic`` operations on each
   1949     address. All modification orders must be compatible with the
   1950     happens-before order. There is no guarantee that the modification
   1951     orders can be combined to a global total order for the whole program
   1952     (and this often will not be possible). The read in an atomic
   1953     read-modify-write operation (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>` and
   1954     :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`) reads the value in the modification
   1955     order immediately before the value it writes. If one atomic read
   1956     happens before another atomic read of the same address, the later
   1957     read must see the same value or a later value in the address's
   1958     modification order. This disallows reordering of ``monotonic`` (or
   1959     stronger) operations on the same address. If an address is written
   1960     ``monotonic``-ally by one thread, and other threads ``monotonic``-ally
   1961     read that address repeatedly, the other threads must eventually see
   1962     the write. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
   1963     ``memory_order_relaxed``.
   1964 ``acquire``
   1965     In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, a
   1966     *synchronizes-with* edge may be formed with a ``release`` operation.
   1967     This is intended to model C++'s ``memory_order_acquire``.
   1968 ``release``
   1969     In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, if this operation
   1970     writes a value which is subsequently read by an ``acquire``
   1971     operation, it *synchronizes-with* that operation. (This isn't a
   1972     complete description; see the C++0x definition of a release
   1973     sequence.) This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
   1974     ``memory_order_release``.
   1975 ``acq_rel`` (acquire+release)
   1976     Acts as both an ``acquire`` and ``release`` operation on its
   1977     address. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x ``memory_order_acq_rel``.
   1978 ``seq_cst`` (sequentially consistent)
   1979     In addition to the guarantees of ``acq_rel`` (``acquire`` for an
   1980     operation that only reads, ``release`` for an operation that only
   1981     writes), there is a global total order on all
   1982     sequentially-consistent operations on all addresses, which is
   1983     consistent with the *happens-before* partial order and with the
   1984     modification orders of all the affected addresses. Each
   1985     sequentially-consistent read sees the last preceding write to the
   1986     same address in this global order. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
   1987     ``memory_order_seq_cst`` and Java volatile.
   1988 
   1989 .. _singlethread:
   1990 
   1991 If an atomic operation is marked ``singlethread``, it only *synchronizes
   1992 with* or participates in modification and seq\_cst total orderings with
   1993 other operations running in the same thread (for example, in signal
   1994 handlers).
   1995 
   1996 .. _fastmath:
   1997 
   1998 Fast-Math Flags
   1999 ---------------
   2000 
   2001 LLVM IR floating-point binary ops (:ref:`fadd <i_fadd>`,
   2002 :ref:`fsub <i_fsub>`, :ref:`fmul <i_fmul>`, :ref:`fdiv <i_fdiv>`,
   2003 :ref:`frem <i_frem>`, :ref:`fcmp <i_fcmp>`) have the following flags that can
   2004 be set to enable otherwise unsafe floating point operations
   2005 
   2006 ``nnan``
   2007    No NaNs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
   2008    NaN. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over
   2009    NaNs, but the value of the result is undefined.
   2010 
   2011 ``ninf``
   2012    No Infs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
   2013    +/-Inf. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over
   2014    +/-Inf, but the value of the result is undefined.
   2015 
   2016 ``nsz``
   2017    No Signed Zeros - Allow optimizations to treat the sign of a zero
   2018    argument or result as insignificant.
   2019 
   2020 ``arcp``
   2021    Allow Reciprocal - Allow optimizations to use the reciprocal of an
   2022    argument rather than perform division.
   2023 
   2024 ``fast``
   2025    Fast - Allow algebraically equivalent transformations that may
   2026    dramatically change results in floating point (e.g. reassociate). This
   2027    flag implies all the others.
   2028 
   2029 .. _uselistorder:
   2030 
   2031 Use-list Order Directives
   2032 -------------------------
   2033 
   2034 Use-list directives encode the in-memory order of each use-list, allowing the
   2035 order to be recreated. ``<order-indexes>`` is a comma-separated list of
   2036 indexes that are assigned to the referenced value's uses. The referenced
   2037 value's use-list is immediately sorted by these indexes.
   2038 
   2039 Use-list directives may appear at function scope or global scope. They are not
   2040 instructions, and have no effect on the semantics of the IR. When they're at
   2041 function scope, they must appear after the terminator of the final basic block.
   2042 
   2043 If basic blocks have their address taken via ``blockaddress()`` expressions,
   2044 ``uselistorder_bb`` can be used to reorder their use-lists from outside their
   2045 function's scope.
   2046 
   2047 :Syntax:
   2048 
   2049 ::
   2050 
   2051     uselistorder <ty> <value>, { <order-indexes> }
   2052     uselistorder_bb @function, %block { <order-indexes> }
   2053 
   2054 :Examples:
   2055 
   2056 ::
   2057 
   2058     define void @foo(i32 %arg1, i32 %arg2) {
   2059     entry:
   2060       ; ... instructions ...
   2061     bb:
   2062       ; ... instructions ...
   2063 
   2064       ; At function scope.
   2065       uselistorder i32 %arg1, { 1, 0, 2 }
   2066       uselistorder label %bb, { 1, 0 }
   2067     }
   2068 
   2069     ; At global scope.
   2070     uselistorder i32* @global, { 1, 2, 0 }
   2071     uselistorder i32 7, { 1, 0 }
   2072     uselistorder i32 (i32) @bar, { 1, 0 }
   2073     uselistorder_bb @foo, %bb, { 5, 1, 3, 2, 0, 4 }
   2074 
   2075 .. _typesystem:
   2076 
   2077 Type System
   2078 ===========
   2079 
   2080 The LLVM type system is one of the most important features of the
   2081 intermediate representation. Being typed enables a number of
   2082 optimizations to be performed on the intermediate representation
   2083 directly, without having to do extra analyses on the side before the
   2084 transformation. A strong type system makes it easier to read the
   2085 generated code and enables novel analyses and transformations that are
   2086 not feasible to perform on normal three address code representations.
   2087 
   2088 .. _t_void:
   2089 
   2090 Void Type
   2091 ---------
   2092 
   2093 :Overview:
   2094 
   2095 
   2096 The void type does not represent any value and has no size.
   2097 
   2098 :Syntax:
   2099 
   2100 
   2101 ::
   2102 
   2103       void
   2104 
   2105 
   2106 .. _t_function:
   2107 
   2108 Function Type
   2109 -------------
   2110 
   2111 :Overview:
   2112 
   2113 
   2114 The function type can be thought of as a function signature. It consists of a
   2115 return type and a list of formal parameter types. The return type of a function
   2116 type is a void type or first class type --- except for :ref:`label <t_label>`
   2117 and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>` types.
   2118 
   2119 :Syntax:
   2120 
   2121 ::
   2122 
   2123       <returntype> (<parameter list>)
   2124 
   2125 ...where '``<parameter list>``' is a comma-separated list of type
   2126 specifiers. Optionally, the parameter list may include a type ``...``, which
   2127 indicates that the function takes a variable number of arguments. Variable
   2128 argument functions can access their arguments with the :ref:`variable argument
   2129 handling intrinsic <int_varargs>` functions. '``<returntype>``' is any type
   2130 except :ref:`label <t_label>` and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>`.
   2131 
   2132 :Examples:
   2133 
   2134 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2135 | ``i32 (i32)``                   | function taking an ``i32``, returning an ``i32``                                                                                                                    |
   2136 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2137 | ``float (i16, i32 *) *``        | :ref:`Pointer <t_pointer>` to a function that takes an ``i16`` and a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i32``, returning ``float``.                                    |
   2138 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2139 | ``i32 (i8*, ...)``              | A vararg function that takes at least one :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i8`` (char in C), which returns an integer. This is the signature for ``printf`` in LLVM. |
   2140 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2141 | ``{i32, i32} (i32)``            | A function taking an ``i32``, returning a :ref:`structure <t_struct>` containing two ``i32`` values                                                                 |
   2142 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2143 
   2144 .. _t_firstclass:
   2145 
   2146 First Class Types
   2147 -----------------
   2148 
   2149 The :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` types are perhaps the most important.
   2150 Values of these types are the only ones which can be produced by
   2151 instructions.
   2152 
   2153 .. _t_single_value:
   2154 
   2155 Single Value Types
   2156 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   2157 
   2158 These are the types that are valid in registers from CodeGen's perspective.
   2159 
   2160 .. _t_integer:
   2161 
   2162 Integer Type
   2163 """"""""""""
   2164 
   2165 :Overview:
   2166 
   2167 The integer type is a very simple type that simply specifies an
   2168 arbitrary bit width for the integer type desired. Any bit width from 1
   2169 bit to 2\ :sup:`23`\ -1 (about 8 million) can be specified.
   2170 
   2171 :Syntax:
   2172 
   2173 ::
   2174 
   2175       iN
   2176 
   2177 The number of bits the integer will occupy is specified by the ``N``
   2178 value.
   2179 
   2180 Examples:
   2181 *********
   2182 
   2183 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
   2184 | ``i1``         | a single-bit integer.                          |
   2185 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
   2186 | ``i32``        | a 32-bit integer.                              |
   2187 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
   2188 | ``i1942652``   | a really big integer of over 1 million bits.   |
   2189 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
   2190 
   2191 .. _t_floating:
   2192 
   2193 Floating Point Types
   2194 """"""""""""""""""""
   2195 
   2196 .. list-table::
   2197    :header-rows: 1
   2198 
   2199    * - Type
   2200      - Description
   2201 
   2202    * - ``half``
   2203      - 16-bit floating point value
   2204 
   2205    * - ``float``
   2206      - 32-bit floating point value
   2207 
   2208    * - ``double``
   2209      - 64-bit floating point value
   2210 
   2211    * - ``fp128``
   2212      - 128-bit floating point value (112-bit mantissa)
   2213 
   2214    * - ``x86_fp80``
   2215      -  80-bit floating point value (X87)
   2216 
   2217    * - ``ppc_fp128``
   2218      - 128-bit floating point value (two 64-bits)
   2219 
   2220 X86_mmx Type
   2221 """"""""""""
   2222 
   2223 :Overview:
   2224 
   2225 The x86_mmx type represents a value held in an MMX register on an x86
   2226 machine. The operations allowed on it are quite limited: parameters and
   2227 return values, load and store, and bitcast. User-specified MMX
   2228 instructions are represented as intrinsic or asm calls with arguments
   2229 and/or results of this type. There are no arrays, vectors or constants
   2230 of this type.
   2231 
   2232 :Syntax:
   2233 
   2234 ::
   2235 
   2236       x86_mmx
   2237 
   2238 
   2239 .. _t_pointer:
   2240 
   2241 Pointer Type
   2242 """"""""""""
   2243 
   2244 :Overview:
   2245 
   2246 The pointer type is used to specify memory locations. Pointers are
   2247 commonly used to reference objects in memory.
   2248 
   2249 Pointer types may have an optional address space attribute defining the
   2250 numbered address space where the pointed-to object resides. The default
   2251 address space is number zero. The semantics of non-zero address spaces
   2252 are target-specific.
   2253 
   2254 Note that LLVM does not permit pointers to void (``void*``) nor does it
   2255 permit pointers to labels (``label*``). Use ``i8*`` instead.
   2256 
   2257 :Syntax:
   2258 
   2259 ::
   2260 
   2261       <type> *
   2262 
   2263 :Examples:
   2264 
   2265 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2266 | ``[4 x i32]*``          | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to :ref:`array <t_array>` of four ``i32`` values.                               |
   2267 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2268 | ``i32 (i32*) *``        | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32*``, returning an ``i32``. |
   2269 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2270 | ``i32 addrspace(5)*``   | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to an ``i32`` value that resides in address space #5.                           |
   2271 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2272 
   2273 .. _t_vector:
   2274 
   2275 Vector Type
   2276 """""""""""
   2277 
   2278 :Overview:
   2279 
   2280 A vector type is a simple derived type that represents a vector of
   2281 elements. Vector types are used when multiple primitive data are
   2282 operated in parallel using a single instruction (SIMD). A vector type
   2283 requires a size (number of elements) and an underlying primitive data
   2284 type. Vector types are considered :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>`.
   2285 
   2286 :Syntax:
   2287 
   2288 ::
   2289 
   2290       < <# elements> x <elementtype> >
   2291 
   2292 The number of elements is a constant integer value larger than 0;
   2293 elementtype may be any integer, floating point or pointer type. Vectors
   2294 of size zero are not allowed.
   2295 
   2296 :Examples:
   2297 
   2298 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
   2299 | ``<4 x i32>``     | Vector of 4 32-bit integer values.               |
   2300 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
   2301 | ``<8 x float>``   | Vector of 8 32-bit floating-point values.        |
   2302 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
   2303 | ``<2 x i64>``     | Vector of 2 64-bit integer values.               |
   2304 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
   2305 | ``<4 x i64*>``    | Vector of 4 pointers to 64-bit integer values.   |
   2306 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
   2307 
   2308 .. _t_label:
   2309 
   2310 Label Type
   2311 ^^^^^^^^^^
   2312 
   2313 :Overview:
   2314 
   2315 The label type represents code labels.
   2316 
   2317 :Syntax:
   2318 
   2319 ::
   2320 
   2321       label
   2322 
   2323 .. _t_token:
   2324 
   2325 Token Type
   2326 ^^^^^^^^^^
   2327 
   2328 :Overview:
   2329 
   2330 The token type is used when a value is associated with an instruction
   2331 but all uses of the value must not attempt to introspect or obscure it.
   2332 As such, it is not appropriate to have a :ref:`phi <i_phi>` or
   2333 :ref:`select <i_select>` of type token.
   2334 
   2335 :Syntax:
   2336 
   2337 ::
   2338 
   2339       token
   2340 
   2341 
   2342 
   2343 .. _t_metadata:
   2344 
   2345 Metadata Type
   2346 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   2347 
   2348 :Overview:
   2349 
   2350 The metadata type represents embedded metadata. No derived types may be
   2351 created from metadata except for :ref:`function <t_function>` arguments.
   2352 
   2353 :Syntax:
   2354 
   2355 ::
   2356 
   2357       metadata
   2358 
   2359 .. _t_aggregate:
   2360 
   2361 Aggregate Types
   2362 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   2363 
   2364 Aggregate Types are a subset of derived types that can contain multiple
   2365 member types. :ref:`Arrays <t_array>` and :ref:`structs <t_struct>` are
   2366 aggregate types. :ref:`Vectors <t_vector>` are not considered to be
   2367 aggregate types.
   2368 
   2369 .. _t_array:
   2370 
   2371 Array Type
   2372 """"""""""
   2373 
   2374 :Overview:
   2375 
   2376 The array type is a very simple derived type that arranges elements
   2377 sequentially in memory. The array type requires a size (number of
   2378 elements) and an underlying data type.
   2379 
   2380 :Syntax:
   2381 
   2382 ::
   2383 
   2384       [<# elements> x <elementtype>]
   2385 
   2386 The number of elements is a constant integer value; ``elementtype`` may
   2387 be any type with a size.
   2388 
   2389 :Examples:
   2390 
   2391 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
   2392 | ``[40 x i32]``   | Array of 40 32-bit integer values.   |
   2393 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
   2394 | ``[41 x i32]``   | Array of 41 32-bit integer values.   |
   2395 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
   2396 | ``[4 x i8]``     | Array of 4 8-bit integer values.     |
   2397 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
   2398 
   2399 Here are some examples of multidimensional arrays:
   2400 
   2401 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
   2402 | ``[3 x [4 x i32]]``         | 3x4 array of 32-bit integer values.                      |
   2403 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
   2404 | ``[12 x [10 x float]]``     | 12x10 array of single precision floating point values.   |
   2405 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
   2406 | ``[2 x [3 x [4 x i16]]]``   | 2x3x4 array of 16-bit integer values.                    |
   2407 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
   2408 
   2409 There is no restriction on indexing beyond the end of the array implied
   2410 by a static type (though there are restrictions on indexing beyond the
   2411 bounds of an allocated object in some cases). This means that
   2412 single-dimension 'variable sized array' addressing can be implemented in
   2413 LLVM with a zero length array type. An implementation of 'pascal style
   2414 arrays' in LLVM could use the type "``{ i32, [0 x float]}``", for
   2415 example.
   2416 
   2417 .. _t_struct:
   2418 
   2419 Structure Type
   2420 """"""""""""""
   2421 
   2422 :Overview:
   2423 
   2424 The structure type is used to represent a collection of data members
   2425 together in memory. The elements of a structure may be any type that has
   2426 a size.
   2427 
   2428 Structures in memory are accessed using '``load``' and '``store``' by
   2429 getting a pointer to a field with the '``getelementptr``' instruction.
   2430 Structures in registers are accessed using the '``extractvalue``' and
   2431 '``insertvalue``' instructions.
   2432 
   2433 Structures may optionally be "packed" structures, which indicate that
   2434 the alignment of the struct is one byte, and that there is no padding
   2435 between the elements. In non-packed structs, padding between field types
   2436 is inserted as defined by the DataLayout string in the module, which is
   2437 required to match what the underlying code generator expects.
   2438 
   2439 Structures can either be "literal" or "identified". A literal structure
   2440 is defined inline with other types (e.g. ``{i32, i32}*``) whereas
   2441 identified types are always defined at the top level with a name.
   2442 Literal types are uniqued by their contents and can never be recursive
   2443 or opaque since there is no way to write one. Identified types can be
   2444 recursive, can be opaqued, and are never uniqued.
   2445 
   2446 :Syntax:
   2447 
   2448 ::
   2449 
   2450       %T1 = type { <type list> }     ; Identified normal struct type
   2451       %T2 = type <{ <type list> }>   ; Identified packed struct type
   2452 
   2453 :Examples:
   2454 
   2455 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2456 | ``{ i32, i32, i32 }``        | A triple of three ``i32`` values                                                                                                                                                      |
   2457 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2458 | ``{ float, i32 (i32) * }``   | A pair, where the first element is a ``float`` and the second element is a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32``, returning an ``i32``.  |
   2459 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2460 | ``<{ i8, i32 }>``            | A packed struct known to be 5 bytes in size.                                                                                                                                          |
   2461 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
   2462 
   2463 .. _t_opaque:
   2464 
   2465 Opaque Structure Types
   2466 """"""""""""""""""""""
   2467 
   2468 :Overview:
   2469 
   2470 Opaque structure types are used to represent named structure types that
   2471 do not have a body specified. This corresponds (for example) to the C
   2472 notion of a forward declared structure.
   2473 
   2474 :Syntax:
   2475 
   2476 ::
   2477 
   2478       %X = type opaque
   2479       %52 = type opaque
   2480 
   2481 :Examples:
   2482 
   2483 +--------------+-------------------+
   2484 | ``opaque``   | An opaque type.   |
   2485 +--------------+-------------------+
   2486 
   2487 .. _constants:
   2488 
   2489 Constants
   2490 =========
   2491 
   2492 LLVM has several different basic types of constants. This section
   2493 describes them all and their syntax.
   2494 
   2495 Simple Constants
   2496 ----------------
   2497 
   2498 **Boolean constants**
   2499     The two strings '``true``' and '``false``' are both valid constants
   2500     of the ``i1`` type.
   2501 **Integer constants**
   2502     Standard integers (such as '4') are constants of the
   2503     :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. Negative numbers may be used with
   2504     integer types.
   2505 **Floating point constants**
   2506     Floating point constants use standard decimal notation (e.g.
   2507     123.421), exponential notation (e.g. 1.23421e+2), or a more precise
   2508     hexadecimal notation (see below). The assembler requires the exact
   2509     decimal value of a floating-point constant. For example, the
   2510     assembler accepts 1.25 but rejects 1.3 because 1.3 is a repeating
   2511     decimal in binary. Floating point constants must have a :ref:`floating
   2512     point <t_floating>` type.
   2513 **Null pointer constants**
   2514     The identifier '``null``' is recognized as a null pointer constant
   2515     and must be of :ref:`pointer type <t_pointer>`.
   2516 **Token constants**
   2517     The identifier '``none``' is recognized as an empty token constant
   2518     and must be of :ref:`token type <t_token>`.
   2519 
   2520 The one non-intuitive notation for constants is the hexadecimal form of
   2521 floating point constants. For example, the form
   2522 '``double    0x432ff973cafa8000``' is equivalent to (but harder to read
   2523 than) '``double 4.5e+15``'. The only time hexadecimal floating point
   2524 constants are required (and the only time that they are generated by the
   2525 disassembler) is when a floating point constant must be emitted but it
   2526 cannot be represented as a decimal floating point number in a reasonable
   2527 number of digits. For example, NaN's, infinities, and other special
   2528 values are represented in their IEEE hexadecimal format so that assembly
   2529 and disassembly do not cause any bits to change in the constants.
   2530 
   2531 When using the hexadecimal form, constants of types half, float, and
   2532 double are represented using the 16-digit form shown above (which
   2533 matches the IEEE754 representation for double); half and float values
   2534 must, however, be exactly representable as IEEE 754 half and single
   2535 precision, respectively. Hexadecimal format is always used for long
   2536 double, and there are three forms of long double. The 80-bit format used
   2537 by x86 is represented as ``0xK`` followed by 20 hexadecimal digits. The
   2538 128-bit format used by PowerPC (two adjacent doubles) is represented by
   2539 ``0xM`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. The IEEE 128-bit format is
   2540 represented by ``0xL`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. Long doubles
   2541 will only work if they match the long double format on your target.
   2542 The IEEE 16-bit format (half precision) is represented by ``0xH``
   2543 followed by 4 hexadecimal digits. All hexadecimal formats are big-endian
   2544 (sign bit at the left).
   2545 
   2546 There are no constants of type x86_mmx.
   2547 
   2548 .. _complexconstants:
   2549 
   2550 Complex Constants
   2551 -----------------
   2552 
   2553 Complex constants are a (potentially recursive) combination of simple
   2554 constants and smaller complex constants.
   2555 
   2556 **Structure constants**
   2557     Structure constants are represented with notation similar to
   2558     structure type definitions (a comma separated list of elements,
   2559     surrounded by braces (``{}``)). For example:
   2560     "``{ i32 4, float 17.0, i32* @G }``", where "``@G``" is declared as
   2561     "``@G = external global i32``". Structure constants must have
   2562     :ref:`structure type <t_struct>`, and the number and types of elements
   2563     must match those specified by the type.
   2564 **Array constants**
   2565     Array constants are represented with notation similar to array type
   2566     definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
   2567     square brackets (``[]``)). For example:
   2568     "``[ i32 42, i32 11, i32 74 ]``". Array constants must have
   2569     :ref:`array type <t_array>`, and the number and types of elements must
   2570     match those specified by the type. As a special case, character array
   2571     constants may also be represented as a double-quoted string using the ``c``
   2572     prefix. For example: "``c"Hello World\0A\00"``".
   2573 **Vector constants**
   2574     Vector constants are represented with notation similar to vector
   2575     type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
   2576     less-than/greater-than's (``<>``)). For example:
   2577     "``< i32 42, i32 11, i32 74, i32 100 >``". Vector constants
   2578     must have :ref:`vector type <t_vector>`, and the number and types of
   2579     elements must match those specified by the type.
   2580 **Zero initialization**
   2581     The string '``zeroinitializer``' can be used to zero initialize a
   2582     value to zero of *any* type, including scalar and
   2583     :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` types. This is often used to avoid
   2584     having to print large zero initializers (e.g. for large arrays) and
   2585     is always exactly equivalent to using explicit zero initializers.
   2586 **Metadata node**
   2587     A metadata node is a constant tuple without types. For example:
   2588     "``!{!0, !{!2, !0}, !"test"}``". Metadata can reference constant values,
   2589     for example: "``!{!0, i32 0, i8* @global, i64 (i64)* @function, !"str"}``".
   2590     Unlike other typed constants that are meant to be interpreted as part of
   2591     the instruction stream, metadata is a place to attach additional
   2592     information such as debug info.
   2593 
   2594 Global Variable and Function Addresses
   2595 --------------------------------------
   2596 
   2597 The addresses of :ref:`global variables <globalvars>` and
   2598 :ref:`functions <functionstructure>` are always implicitly valid
   2599 (link-time) constants. These constants are explicitly referenced when
   2600 the :ref:`identifier for the global <identifiers>` is used and always have
   2601 :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` type. For example, the following is a legal LLVM
   2602 file:
   2603 
   2604 .. code-block:: llvm
   2605 
   2606     @X = global i32 17
   2607     @Y = global i32 42
   2608     @Z = global [2 x i32*] [ i32* @X, i32* @Y ]
   2609 
   2610 .. _undefvalues:
   2611 
   2612 Undefined Values
   2613 ----------------
   2614 
   2615 The string '``undef``' can be used anywhere a constant is expected, and
   2616 indicates that the user of the value may receive an unspecified
   2617 bit-pattern. Undefined values may be of any type (other than '``label``'
   2618 or '``void``') and be used anywhere a constant is permitted.
   2619 
   2620 Undefined values are useful because they indicate to the compiler that
   2621 the program is well defined no matter what value is used. This gives the
   2622 compiler more freedom to optimize. Here are some examples of
   2623 (potentially surprising) transformations that are valid (in pseudo IR):
   2624 
   2625 .. code-block:: llvm
   2626 
   2627       %A = add %X, undef
   2628       %B = sub %X, undef
   2629       %C = xor %X, undef
   2630     Safe:
   2631       %A = undef
   2632       %B = undef
   2633       %C = undef
   2634 
   2635 This is safe because all of the output bits are affected by the undef
   2636 bits. Any output bit can have a zero or one depending on the input bits.
   2637 
   2638 .. code-block:: llvm
   2639 
   2640       %A = or %X, undef
   2641       %B = and %X, undef
   2642     Safe:
   2643       %A = -1
   2644       %B = 0
   2645     Unsafe:
   2646       %A = undef
   2647       %B = undef
   2648 
   2649 These logical operations have bits that are not always affected by the
   2650 input. For example, if ``%X`` has a zero bit, then the output of the
   2651 '``and``' operation will always be a zero for that bit, no matter what
   2652 the corresponding bit from the '``undef``' is. As such, it is unsafe to
   2653 optimize or assume that the result of the '``and``' is '``undef``'.
   2654 However, it is safe to assume that all bits of the '``undef``' could be
   2655 0, and optimize the '``and``' to 0. Likewise, it is safe to assume that
   2656 all the bits of the '``undef``' operand to the '``or``' could be set,
   2657 allowing the '``or``' to be folded to -1.
   2658 
   2659 .. code-block:: llvm
   2660 
   2661       %A = select undef, %X, %Y
   2662       %B = select undef, 42, %Y
   2663       %C = select %X, %Y, undef
   2664     Safe:
   2665       %A = %X     (or %Y)
   2666       %B = 42     (or %Y)
   2667       %C = %Y
   2668     Unsafe:
   2669       %A = undef
   2670       %B = undef
   2671       %C = undef
   2672 
   2673 This set of examples shows that undefined '``select``' (and conditional
   2674 branch) conditions can go *either way*, but they have to come from one
   2675 of the two operands. In the ``%A`` example, if ``%X`` and ``%Y`` were
   2676 both known to have a clear low bit, then ``%A`` would have to have a
   2677 cleared low bit. However, in the ``%C`` example, the optimizer is
   2678 allowed to assume that the '``undef``' operand could be the same as
   2679 ``%Y``, allowing the whole '``select``' to be eliminated.
   2680 
   2681 .. code-block:: llvm
   2682 
   2683       %A = xor undef, undef
   2684 
   2685       %B = undef
   2686       %C = xor %B, %B
   2687 
   2688       %D = undef
   2689       %E = icmp slt %D, 4
   2690       %F = icmp gte %D, 4
   2691 
   2692     Safe:
   2693       %A = undef
   2694       %B = undef
   2695       %C = undef
   2696       %D = undef
   2697       %E = undef
   2698       %F = undef
   2699 
   2700 This example points out that two '``undef``' operands are not
   2701 necessarily the same. This can be surprising to people (and also matches
   2702 C semantics) where they assume that "``X^X``" is always zero, even if
   2703 ``X`` is undefined. This isn't true for a number of reasons, but the
   2704 short answer is that an '``undef``' "variable" can arbitrarily change
   2705 its value over its "live range". This is true because the variable
   2706 doesn't actually *have a live range*. Instead, the value is logically
   2707 read from arbitrary registers that happen to be around when needed, so
   2708 the value is not necessarily consistent over time. In fact, ``%A`` and
   2709 ``%C`` need to have the same semantics or the core LLVM "replace all
   2710 uses with" concept would not hold.
   2711 
   2712 .. code-block:: llvm
   2713 
   2714       %A = fdiv undef, %X
   2715       %B = fdiv %X, undef
   2716     Safe:
   2717       %A = undef
   2718     b: unreachable
   2719 
   2720 These examples show the crucial difference between an *undefined value*
   2721 and *undefined behavior*. An undefined value (like '``undef``') is
   2722 allowed to have an arbitrary bit-pattern. This means that the ``%A``
   2723 operation can be constant folded to '``undef``', because the '``undef``'
   2724 could be an SNaN, and ``fdiv`` is not (currently) defined on SNaN's.
   2725 However, in the second example, we can make a more aggressive
   2726 assumption: because the ``undef`` is allowed to be an arbitrary value,
   2727 we are allowed to assume that it could be zero. Since a divide by zero
   2728 has *undefined behavior*, we are allowed to assume that the operation
   2729 does not execute at all. This allows us to delete the divide and all
   2730 code after it. Because the undefined operation "can't happen", the
   2731 optimizer can assume that it occurs in dead code.
   2732 
   2733 .. code-block:: llvm
   2734 
   2735     a:  store undef -> %X
   2736     b:  store %X -> undef
   2737     Safe:
   2738     a: <deleted>
   2739     b: unreachable
   2740 
   2741 These examples reiterate the ``fdiv`` example: a store *of* an undefined
   2742 value can be assumed to not have any effect; we can assume that the
   2743 value is overwritten with bits that happen to match what was already
   2744 there. However, a store *to* an undefined location could clobber
   2745 arbitrary memory, therefore, it has undefined behavior.
   2746 
   2747 .. _poisonvalues:
   2748 
   2749 Poison Values
   2750 -------------
   2751 
   2752 Poison values are similar to :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`, however
   2753 they also represent the fact that an instruction or constant expression
   2754 that cannot evoke side effects has nevertheless detected a condition
   2755 that results in undefined behavior.
   2756 
   2757 There is currently no way of representing a poison value in the IR; they
   2758 only exist when produced by operations such as :ref:`add <i_add>` with
   2759 the ``nsw`` flag.
   2760 
   2761 Poison value behavior is defined in terms of value *dependence*:
   2762 
   2763 -  Values other than :ref:`phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on their operands.
   2764 -  :ref:`Phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on the operand corresponding to
   2765    their dynamic predecessor basic block.
   2766 -  Function arguments depend on the corresponding actual argument values
   2767    in the dynamic callers of their functions.
   2768 -  :ref:`Call <i_call>` instructions depend on the :ref:`ret <i_ret>`
   2769    instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
   2770 -  :ref:`Invoke <i_invoke>` instructions depend on the
   2771    :ref:`ret <i_ret>`, :ref:`resume <i_resume>`, or exception-throwing
   2772    call instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
   2773 -  Non-volatile loads and stores depend on the most recent stores to all
   2774    of the referenced memory addresses, following the order in the IR
   2775    (including loads and stores implied by intrinsics such as
   2776    :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`.)
   2777 -  An instruction with externally visible side effects depends on the
   2778    most recent preceding instruction with externally visible side
   2779    effects, following the order in the IR. (This includes :ref:`volatile
   2780    operations <volatile>`.)
   2781 -  An instruction *control-depends* on a :ref:`terminator
   2782    instruction <terminators>` if the terminator instruction has
   2783    multiple successors and the instruction is always executed when
   2784    control transfers to one of the successors, and may not be executed
   2785    when control is transferred to another.
   2786 -  Additionally, an instruction also *control-depends* on a terminator
   2787    instruction if the set of instructions it otherwise depends on would
   2788    be different if the terminator had transferred control to a different
   2789    successor.
   2790 -  Dependence is transitive.
   2791 
   2792 Poison values have the same behavior as :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`,
   2793 with the additional effect that any instruction that has a *dependence*
   2794 on a poison value has undefined behavior.
   2795 
   2796 Here are some examples:
   2797 
   2798 .. code-block:: llvm
   2799 
   2800     entry:
   2801       %poison = sub nuw i32 0, 1           ; Results in a poison value.
   2802       %still_poison = and i32 %poison, 0   ; 0, but also poison.
   2803       %poison_yet_again = getelementptr i32, i32* @h, i32 %still_poison
   2804       store i32 0, i32* %poison_yet_again  ; memory at @h[0] is poisoned
   2805 
   2806       store i32 %poison, i32* @g           ; Poison value stored to memory.
   2807       %poison2 = load i32, i32* @g         ; Poison value loaded back from memory.
   2808 
   2809       store volatile i32 %poison, i32* @g  ; External observation; undefined behavior.
   2810 
   2811       %narrowaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i16*
   2812       %wideaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i64*
   2813       %poison3 = load i16, i16* %narrowaddr ; Returns a poison value.
   2814       %poison4 = load i64, i64* %wideaddr  ; Returns a poison value.
   2815 
   2816       %cmp = icmp slt i32 %poison, 0       ; Returns a poison value.
   2817       br i1 %cmp, label %true, label %end  ; Branch to either destination.
   2818 
   2819     true:
   2820       store volatile i32 0, i32* @g        ; This is control-dependent on %cmp, so
   2821                                            ; it has undefined behavior.
   2822       br label %end
   2823 
   2824     end:
   2825       %p = phi i32 [ 0, %entry ], [ 1, %true ]
   2826                                            ; Both edges into this PHI are
   2827                                            ; control-dependent on %cmp, so this
   2828                                            ; always results in a poison value.
   2829 
   2830       store volatile i32 0, i32* @g        ; This would depend on the store in %true
   2831                                            ; if %cmp is true, or the store in %entry
   2832                                            ; otherwise, so this is undefined behavior.
   2833 
   2834       br i1 %cmp, label %second_true, label %second_end
   2835                                            ; The same branch again, but this time the
   2836                                            ; true block doesn't have side effects.
   2837 
   2838     second_true:
   2839       ; No side effects!
   2840       ret void
   2841 
   2842     second_end:
   2843       store volatile i32 0, i32* @g        ; This time, the instruction always depends
   2844                                            ; on the store in %end. Also, it is
   2845                                            ; control-equivalent to %end, so this is
   2846                                            ; well-defined (ignoring earlier undefined
   2847                                            ; behavior in this example).
   2848 
   2849 .. _blockaddress:
   2850 
   2851 Addresses of Basic Blocks
   2852 -------------------------
   2853 
   2854 ``blockaddress(@function, %block)``
   2855 
   2856 The '``blockaddress``' constant computes the address of the specified
   2857 basic block in the specified function, and always has an ``i8*`` type.
   2858 Taking the address of the entry block is illegal.
   2859 
   2860 This value only has defined behavior when used as an operand to the
   2861 ':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`' instruction, or for comparisons
   2862 against null. Pointer equality tests between labels addresses results in
   2863 undefined behavior --- though, again, comparison against null is ok, and
   2864 no label is equal to the null pointer. This may be passed around as an
   2865 opaque pointer sized value as long as the bits are not inspected. This
   2866 allows ``ptrtoint`` and arithmetic to be performed on these values so
   2867 long as the original value is reconstituted before the ``indirectbr``
   2868 instruction.
   2869 
   2870 Finally, some targets may provide defined semantics when using the value
   2871 as the operand to an inline assembly, but that is target specific.
   2872 
   2873 .. _constantexprs:
   2874 
   2875 Constant Expressions
   2876 --------------------
   2877 
   2878 Constant expressions are used to allow expressions involving other
   2879 constants to be used as constants. Constant expressions may be of any
   2880 :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type and may involve any LLVM operation
   2881 that does not have side effects (e.g. load and call are not supported).
   2882 The following is the syntax for constant expressions:
   2883 
   2884 ``trunc (CST to TYPE)``
   2885     Truncate a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
   2886     larger than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
   2887 ``zext (CST to TYPE)``
   2888     Zero extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
   2889     smaller than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
   2890 ``sext (CST to TYPE)``
   2891     Sign extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
   2892     smaller than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
   2893 ``fptrunc (CST to TYPE)``
   2894     Truncate a floating point constant to another floating point type.
   2895     The size of CST must be larger than the size of TYPE. Both types
   2896     must be floating point.
   2897 ``fpext (CST to TYPE)``
   2898     Floating point extend a constant to another type. The size of CST
   2899     must be smaller or equal to the size of TYPE. Both types must be
   2900     floating point.
   2901 ``fptoui (CST to TYPE)``
   2902     Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding unsigned
   2903     integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
   2904     must be of scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE
   2905     must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
   2906     value won't fit in the integer type, the results are undefined.
   2907 ``fptosi (CST to TYPE)``
   2908     Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding signed
   2909     integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
   2910     must be of scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE
   2911     must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
   2912     value won't fit in the integer type, the results are undefined.
   2913 ``uitofp (CST to TYPE)``
   2914     Convert an unsigned integer constant to the corresponding floating
   2915     point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type.
   2916     CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
   2917     be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value
   2918     won't fit in the floating point type, the results are undefined.
   2919 ``sitofp (CST to TYPE)``
   2920     Convert a signed integer constant to the corresponding floating
   2921     point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type.
   2922     CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
   2923     be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value
   2924     won't fit in the floating point type, the results are undefined.
   2925 ``ptrtoint (CST to TYPE)``
   2926     Convert a pointer typed constant to the corresponding integer
   2927     constant. ``TYPE`` must be an integer type. ``CST`` must be of
   2928     pointer type. The ``CST`` value is zero extended, truncated, or
   2929     unchanged to make it fit in ``TYPE``.
   2930 ``inttoptr (CST to TYPE)``
   2931     Convert an integer constant to a pointer constant. TYPE must be a
   2932     pointer type. CST must be of integer type. The CST value is zero
   2933     extended, truncated, or unchanged to make it fit in a pointer size.
   2934     This one is *really* dangerous!
   2935 ``bitcast (CST to TYPE)``
   2936     Convert a constant, CST, to another TYPE. The constraints of the
   2937     operands are the same as those for the :ref:`bitcast
   2938     instruction <i_bitcast>`.
   2939 ``addrspacecast (CST to TYPE)``
   2940     Convert a constant pointer or constant vector of pointer, CST, to another
   2941     TYPE in a different address space. The constraints of the operands are the
   2942     same as those for the :ref:`addrspacecast instruction <i_addrspacecast>`.
   2943 ``getelementptr (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``, ``getelementptr inbounds (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
   2944     Perform the :ref:`getelementptr operation <i_getelementptr>` on
   2945     constants. As with the :ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`
   2946     instruction, the index list may have zero or more indexes, which are
   2947     required to make sense for the type of "pointer to TY".
   2948 ``select (COND, VAL1, VAL2)``
   2949     Perform the :ref:`select operation <i_select>` on constants.
   2950 ``icmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
   2951     Performs the :ref:`icmp operation <i_icmp>` on constants.
   2952 ``fcmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
   2953     Performs the :ref:`fcmp operation <i_fcmp>` on constants.
   2954 ``extractelement (VAL, IDX)``
   2955     Perform the :ref:`extractelement operation <i_extractelement>` on
   2956     constants.
   2957 ``insertelement (VAL, ELT, IDX)``
   2958     Perform the :ref:`insertelement operation <i_insertelement>` on
   2959     constants.
   2960 ``shufflevector (VEC1, VEC2, IDXMASK)``
   2961     Perform the :ref:`shufflevector operation <i_shufflevector>` on
   2962     constants.
   2963 ``extractvalue (VAL, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
   2964     Perform the :ref:`extractvalue operation <i_extractvalue>` on
   2965     constants. The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as
   2966     indices in a ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At
   2967     least one index value must be specified.
   2968 ``insertvalue (VAL, ELT, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
   2969     Perform the :ref:`insertvalue operation <i_insertvalue>` on constants.
   2970     The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as indices in a
   2971     ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At least one index
   2972     value must be specified.
   2973 ``OPCODE (LHS, RHS)``
   2974     Perform the specified operation of the LHS and RHS constants. OPCODE
   2975     may be any of the :ref:`binary <binaryops>` or :ref:`bitwise
   2976     binary <bitwiseops>` operations. The constraints on operands are
   2977     the same as those for the corresponding instruction (e.g. no bitwise
   2978     operations on floating point values are allowed).
   2979 
   2980 Other Values
   2981 ============
   2982 
   2983 .. _inlineasmexprs:
   2984 
   2985 Inline Assembler Expressions
   2986 ----------------------------
   2987 
   2988 LLVM supports inline assembler expressions (as opposed to :ref:`Module-Level
   2989 Inline Assembly <moduleasm>`) through the use of a special value. This value
   2990 represents the inline assembler as a template string (containing the
   2991 instructions to emit), a list of operand constraints (stored as a string), a
   2992 flag that indicates whether or not the inline asm expression has side effects,
   2993 and a flag indicating whether the function containing the asm needs to align its
   2994 stack conservatively.
   2995 
   2996 The template string supports argument substitution of the operands using "``$``"
   2997 followed by a number, to indicate substitution of the given register/memory
   2998 location, as specified by the constraint string. "``${NUM:MODIFIER}``" may also
   2999 be used, where ``MODIFIER`` is a target-specific annotation for how to print the
   3000 operand (See :ref:`inline-asm-modifiers`).
   3001 
   3002 A literal "``$``" may be included by using "``$$``" in the template. To include
   3003 other special characters into the output, the usual "``\XX``" escapes may be
   3004 used, just as in other strings. Note that after template substitution, the
   3005 resulting assembly string is parsed by LLVM's integrated assembler unless it is
   3006 disabled -- even when emitting a ``.s`` file -- and thus must contain assembly
   3007 syntax known to LLVM.
   3008 
   3009 LLVM's support for inline asm is modeled closely on the requirements of Clang's
   3010 GCC-compatible inline-asm support. Thus, the feature-set and the constraint and
   3011 modifier codes listed here are similar or identical to those in GCC's inline asm
   3012 support. However, to be clear, the syntax of the template and constraint strings
   3013 described here is *not* the same as the syntax accepted by GCC and Clang, and,
   3014 while most constraint letters are passed through as-is by Clang, some get
   3015 translated to other codes when converting from the C source to the LLVM
   3016 assembly.
   3017 
   3018 An example inline assembler expression is:
   3019 
   3020 .. code-block:: llvm
   3021 
   3022     i32 (i32) asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"
   3023 
   3024 Inline assembler expressions may **only** be used as the callee operand
   3025 of a :ref:`call <i_call>` or an :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>` instruction.
   3026 Thus, typically we have:
   3027 
   3028 .. code-block:: llvm
   3029 
   3030     %X = call i32 asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"(i32 %Y)
   3031 
   3032 Inline asms with side effects not visible in the constraint list must be
   3033 marked as having side effects. This is done through the use of the
   3034 '``sideeffect``' keyword, like so:
   3035 
   3036 .. code-block:: llvm
   3037 
   3038     call void asm sideeffect "eieio", ""()
   3039 
   3040 In some cases inline asms will contain code that will not work unless
   3041 the stack is aligned in some way, such as calls or SSE instructions on
   3042 x86, yet will not contain code that does that alignment within the asm.
   3043 The compiler should make conservative assumptions about what the asm
   3044 might contain and should generate its usual stack alignment code in the
   3045 prologue if the '``alignstack``' keyword is present:
   3046 
   3047 .. code-block:: llvm
   3048 
   3049     call void asm alignstack "eieio", ""()
   3050 
   3051 Inline asms also support using non-standard assembly dialects. The
   3052 assumed dialect is ATT. When the '``inteldialect``' keyword is present,
   3053 the inline asm is using the Intel dialect. Currently, ATT and Intel are
   3054 the only supported dialects. An example is:
   3055 
   3056 .. code-block:: llvm
   3057 
   3058     call void asm inteldialect "eieio", ""()
   3059 
   3060 If multiple keywords appear the '``sideeffect``' keyword must come
   3061 first, the '``alignstack``' keyword second and the '``inteldialect``'
   3062 keyword last.
   3063 
   3064 Inline Asm Constraint String
   3065 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   3066 
   3067 The constraint list is a comma-separated string, each element containing one or
   3068 more constraint codes.
   3069 
   3070 For each element in the constraint list an appropriate register or memory
   3071 operand will be chosen, and it will be made available to assembly template
   3072 string expansion as ``$0`` for the first constraint in the list, ``$1`` for the
   3073 second, etc.
   3074 
   3075 There are three different types of constraints, which are distinguished by a
   3076 prefix symbol in front of the constraint code: Output, Input, and Clobber. The
   3077 constraints must always be given in that order: outputs first, then inputs, then
   3078 clobbers. They cannot be intermingled.
   3079 
   3080 There are also three different categories of constraint codes:
   3081 
   3082 - Register constraint. This is either a register class, or a fixed physical
   3083   register. This kind of constraint will allocate a register, and if necessary,
   3084   bitcast the argument or result to the appropriate type.
   3085 - Memory constraint. This kind of constraint is for use with an instruction
   3086   taking a memory operand. Different constraints allow for different addressing
   3087   modes used by the target.
   3088 - Immediate value constraint. This kind of constraint is for an integer or other
   3089   immediate value which can be rendered directly into an instruction. The
   3090   various target-specific constraints allow the selection of a value in the
   3091   proper range for the instruction you wish to use it with.
   3092 
   3093 Output constraints
   3094 """"""""""""""""""
   3095 
   3096 Output constraints are specified by an "``=``" prefix (e.g. "``=r``"). This
   3097 indicates that the assembly will write to this operand, and the operand will
   3098 then be made available as a return value of the ``asm`` expression. Output
   3099 constraints do not consume an argument from the call instruction. (Except, see
   3100 below about indirect outputs).
   3101 
   3102 Normally, it is expected that no output locations are written to by the assembly
   3103 expression until *all* of the inputs have been read. As such, LLVM may assign
   3104 the same register to an output and an input. If this is not safe (e.g. if the
   3105 assembly contains two instructions, where the first writes to one output, and
   3106 the second reads an input and writes to a second output), then the "``&``"
   3107 modifier must be used (e.g. "``=&r``") to specify that the output is an
   3108 "early-clobber" output. Marking an ouput as "early-clobber" ensures that LLVM
   3109 will not use the same register for any inputs (other than an input tied to this
   3110 output).
   3111 
   3112 Input constraints
   3113 """""""""""""""""
   3114 
   3115 Input constraints do not have a prefix -- just the constraint codes. Each input
   3116 constraint will consume one argument from the call instruction. It is not
   3117 permitted for the asm to write to any input register or memory location (unless
   3118 that input is tied to an output). Note also that multiple inputs may all be
   3119 assigned to the same register, if LLVM can determine that they necessarily all
   3120 contain the same value.
   3121 
   3122 Instead of providing a Constraint Code, input constraints may also "tie"
   3123 themselves to an output constraint, by providing an integer as the constraint
   3124 string. Tied inputs still consume an argument from the call instruction, and
   3125 take up a position in the asm template numbering as is usual -- they will simply
   3126 be constrained to always use the same register as the output they've been tied
   3127 to. For example, a constraint string of "``=r,0``" says to assign a register for
   3128 output, and use that register as an input as well (it being the 0'th
   3129 constraint).
   3130 
   3131 It is permitted to tie an input to an "early-clobber" output. In that case, no
   3132 *other* input may share the same register as the input tied to the early-clobber
   3133 (even when the other input has the same value).
   3134 
   3135 You may only tie an input to an output which has a register constraint, not a
   3136 memory constraint. Only a single input may be tied to an output.
   3137 
   3138 There is also an "interesting" feature which deserves a bit of explanation: if a
   3139 register class constraint allocates a register which is too small for the value
   3140 type operand provided as input, the input value will be split into multiple
   3141 registers, and all of them passed to the inline asm.
   3142 
   3143 However, this feature is often not as useful as you might think.
   3144 
   3145 Firstly, the registers are *not* guaranteed to be consecutive. So, on those
   3146 architectures that have instructions which operate on multiple consecutive
   3147 instructions, this is not an appropriate way to support them. (e.g. the 32-bit
   3148 SparcV8 has a 64-bit load, which instruction takes a single 32-bit register. The
   3149 hardware then loads into both the named register, and the next register. This
   3150 feature of inline asm would not be useful to support that.)
   3151 
   3152 A few of the targets provide a template string modifier allowing explicit access
   3153 to the second register of a two-register operand (e.g. MIPS ``L``, ``M``, and
   3154 ``D``). On such an architecture, you can actually access the second allocated
   3155 register (yet, still, not any subsequent ones). But, in that case, you're still
   3156 probably better off simply splitting the value into two separate operands, for
   3157 clarity. (e.g. see the description of the ``A`` constraint on X86, which,
   3158 despite existing only for use with this feature, is not really a good idea to
   3159 use)
   3160 
   3161 Indirect inputs and outputs
   3162 """""""""""""""""""""""""""
   3163 
   3164 Indirect output or input constraints can be specified by the "``*``" modifier
   3165 (which goes after the "``=``" in case of an output). This indicates that the asm
   3166 will write to or read from the contents of an *address* provided as an input
   3167 argument. (Note that in this way, indirect outputs act more like an *input* than
   3168 an output: just like an input, they consume an argument of the call expression,
   3169 rather than producing a return value. An indirect output constraint is an
   3170 "output" only in that the asm is expected to write to the contents of the input
   3171 memory location, instead of just read from it).
   3172 
   3173 This is most typically used for memory constraint, e.g. "``=*m``", to pass the
   3174 address of a variable as a value.
   3175 
   3176 It is also possible to use an indirect *register* constraint, but only on output
   3177 (e.g. "``=*r``"). This will cause LLVM to allocate a register for an output
   3178 value normally, and then, separately emit a store to the address provided as
   3179 input, after the provided inline asm. (It's not clear what value this
   3180 functionality provides, compared to writing the store explicitly after the asm
   3181 statement, and it can only produce worse code, since it bypasses many
   3182 optimization passes. I would recommend not using it.)
   3183 
   3184 
   3185 Clobber constraints
   3186 """""""""""""""""""
   3187 
   3188 A clobber constraint is indicated by a "``~``" prefix. A clobber does not
   3189 consume an input operand, nor generate an output. Clobbers cannot use any of the
   3190 general constraint code letters -- they may use only explicit register
   3191 constraints, e.g. "``~{eax}``". The one exception is that a clobber string of
   3192 "``~{memory}``" indicates that the assembly writes to arbitrary undeclared
   3193 memory locations -- not only the memory pointed to by a declared indirect
   3194 output.
   3195 
   3196 
   3197 Constraint Codes
   3198 """"""""""""""""
   3199 After a potential prefix comes constraint code, or codes.
   3200 
   3201 A Constraint Code is either a single letter (e.g. "``r``"), a "``^``" character
   3202 followed by two letters (e.g. "``^wc``"), or "``{``" register-name "``}``"
   3203 (e.g. "``{eax}``").
   3204 
   3205 The one and two letter constraint codes are typically chosen to be the same as
   3206 GCC's constraint codes.
   3207 
   3208 A single constraint may include one or more than constraint code in it, leaving
   3209 it up to LLVM to choose which one to use. This is included mainly for
   3210 compatibility with the translation of GCC inline asm coming from clang.
   3211 
   3212 There are two ways to specify alternatives, and either or both may be used in an
   3213 inline asm constraint list:
   3214 
   3215 1) Append the codes to each other, making a constraint code set. E.g. "``im``"
   3216    or "``{eax}m``". This means "choose any of the options in the set". The
   3217    choice of constraint is made independently for each constraint in the
   3218    constraint list.
   3219 
   3220 2) Use "``|``" between constraint code sets, creating alternatives. Every
   3221    constraint in the constraint list must have the same number of alternative
   3222    sets. With this syntax, the same alternative in *all* of the items in the
   3223    constraint list will be chosen together.
   3224 
   3225 Putting those together, you might have a two operand constraint string like
   3226 ``"rm|r,ri|rm"``. This indicates that if operand 0 is ``r`` or ``m``, then
   3227 operand 1 may be one of ``r`` or ``i``. If operand 0 is ``r``, then operand 1
   3228 may be one of ``r`` or ``m``. But, operand 0 and 1 cannot both be of type m.
   3229 
   3230 However, the use of either of the alternatives features is *NOT* recommended, as
   3231 LLVM is not able to make an intelligent choice about which one to use. (At the
   3232 point it currently needs to choose, not enough information is available to do so
   3233 in a smart way.) Thus, it simply tries to make a choice that's most likely to
   3234 compile, not one that will be optimal performance. (e.g., given "``rm``", it'll
   3235 always choose to use memory, not registers). And, if given multiple registers,
   3236 or multiple register classes, it will simply choose the first one. (In fact, it
   3237 doesn't currently even ensure explicitly specified physical registers are
   3238 unique, so specifying multiple physical registers as alternatives, like
   3239 ``{r11}{r12},{r11}{r12}``, will assign r11 to both operands, not at all what was
   3240 intended.)
   3241 
   3242 Supported Constraint Code List
   3243 """"""""""""""""""""""""""""""
   3244 
   3245 The constraint codes are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
   3246 GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
   3247 inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
   3248 and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
   3249 
   3250 Some constraint codes are typically supported by all targets:
   3251 
   3252 - ``r``: A register in the target's general purpose register class.
   3253 - ``m``: A memory address operand. It is target-specific what addressing modes
   3254   are supported, typical examples are register, or register + register offset,
   3255   or register + immediate offset (of some target-specific size).
   3256 - ``i``: An integer constant (of target-specific width). Allows either a simple
   3257   immediate, or a relocatable value.
   3258 - ``n``: An integer constant -- *not* including relocatable values.
   3259 - ``s``: An integer constant, but allowing *only* relocatable values.
   3260 - ``X``: Allows an operand of any kind, no constraint whatsoever. Typically
   3261   useful to pass a label for an asm branch or call.
   3262 
   3263   .. FIXME: but that surely isn't actually okay to jump out of an asm
   3264      block without telling llvm about the control transfer???)
   3265 
   3266 - ``{register-name}``: Requires exactly the named physical register.
   3267 
   3268 Other constraints are target-specific:
   3269 
   3270 AArch64:
   3271 
   3272 - ``z``: An immediate integer 0. Outputs ``WZR`` or ``XZR``, as appropriate.
   3273 - ``I``: An immediate integer valid for an ``ADD`` or ``SUB`` instruction,
   3274   i.e. 0 to 4095 with optional shift by 12.
   3275 - ``J``: An immediate integer that, when negated, is valid for an ``ADD`` or
   3276   ``SUB`` instruction, i.e. -1 to -4095 with optional left shift by 12.
   3277 - ``K``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 32' of a
   3278   logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 32-bit register.
   3279 - ``L``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 64' of a
   3280   logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 64-bit register.
   3281 - ``M``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
   3282   32-bit register. This is a superset of ``K``: in addition to the bitmask
   3283   immediate, also allows immediate integers which can be loaded with a single
   3284   ``MOVZ`` or ``MOVL`` instruction.
   3285 - ``N``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
   3286   64-bit register. This is a superset of ``L``.
   3287 - ``Q``: Memory address operand must be in a single register (no
   3288   offsets). (However, LLVM currently does this for the ``m`` constraint as
   3289   well.)
   3290 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register (W* or X*).
   3291 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register.
   3292 - ``x``: A lower 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register (``V0`` to ``V15``).
   3293 
   3294 AMDGPU:
   3295 
   3296 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
   3297 - ``[0-9]v``: The 32-bit VGPR register, number 0-9.
   3298 - ``[0-9]s``: The 32-bit SGPR register, number 0-9.
   3299 
   3300 
   3301 All ARM modes:
   3302 
   3303 - ``Q``, ``Um``, ``Un``, ``Uq``, ``Us``, ``Ut``, ``Uv``, ``Uy``: Memory address
   3304   operand. Treated the same as operand ``m``, at the moment.
   3305 
   3306 ARM and ARM's Thumb2 mode:
   3307 
   3308 - ``j``: An immediate integer between 0 and 65535 (valid for ``MOVW``)
   3309 - ``I``: An immediate integer valid for a data-processing instruction.
   3310 - ``J``: An immediate integer between -4095 and 4095.
   3311 - ``K``: An immediate integer whose bitwise inverse is valid for a
   3312   data-processing instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``B``" to
   3313   print the inverted value).
   3314 - ``L``: An immediate integer whose negation is valid for a data-processing
   3315   instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``n``" to print the negated
   3316   value).
   3317 - ``M``: A power of two or a integer between 0 and 32.
   3318 - ``N``: Invalid immediate constraint.
   3319 - ``O``: Invalid immediate constraint.
   3320 - ``r``: A general-purpose 32-bit integer register (``r0-r15``).
   3321 - ``l``: In Thumb2 mode, low 32-bit GPR registers (``r0-r7``). In ARM mode, same
   3322   as ``r``.
   3323 - ``h``: In Thumb2 mode, a high 32-bit GPR register (``r8-r15``). In ARM mode,
   3324   invalid.
   3325 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
   3326   ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
   3327 - ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
   3328   ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
   3329 - ``t``: A floating-point/SIMD register, only supports 32-bit values:
   3330   ``s0-s31``.
   3331 
   3332 ARM's Thumb1 mode:
   3333 
   3334 - ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255.
   3335 - ``J``: An immediate integer between -255 and -1.
   3336 - ``K``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255, with optional left-shift by
   3337   some amount.
   3338 - ``L``: An immediate integer between -7 and 7.
   3339 - ``M``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between 0 and 1020.
   3340 - ``N``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
   3341 - ``O``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between -508 and 508.
   3342 - ``r``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
   3343 - ``l``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
   3344 - ``h``: A high GPR register (``r0-r7``).
   3345 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
   3346   ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
   3347 - ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
   3348   ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
   3349 - ``t``: A floating-point/SIMD register, only supports 32-bit values:
   3350   ``s0-s31``.
   3351 
   3352 
   3353 Hexagon:
   3354 
   3355 - ``o``, ``v``: A memory address operand, treated the same as constraint ``m``,
   3356   at the moment.
   3357 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit register.
   3358 
   3359 MSP430:
   3360 
   3361 - ``r``: An 8 or 16-bit register.
   3362 
   3363 MIPS:
   3364 
   3365 - ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
   3366 - ``J``: An immediate integer zero.
   3367 - ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
   3368 - ``L``: An immediate 32-bit integer, where the lower 16 bits are 0.
   3369 - ``N``: An immediate integer between -65535 and -1.
   3370 - ``O``: An immediate signed 15-bit integer.
   3371 - ``P``: An immediate integer between 1 and 65535.
   3372 - ``m``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
   3373   register plus 16-bit immediate offset. In MIPS mode, just a base register.
   3374 - ``R``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
   3375   register plus a 9-bit signed offset. In MIPS mode, the same as constraint
   3376   ``m``.
   3377 - ``ZC``: A memory address operand, suitable for use in a ``pref``, ``ll``, or
   3378   ``sc`` instruction on the given subtarget (details vary).
   3379 - ``r``, ``d``,  ``y``: A 32 or 64-bit GPR register.
   3380 - ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit FPU register (``F0-F31``), or a 128-bit MSA register
   3381   (``W0-W31``). In the case of MSA registers, it is recommended to use the ``w``
   3382   argument modifier for compatibility with GCC.
   3383 - ``c``: A 32-bit or 64-bit GPR register suitable for indirect jump (always
   3384   ``25``).
   3385 - ``l``: The ``lo`` register, 32 or 64-bit.
   3386 - ``x``: Invalid.
   3387 
   3388 NVPTX:
   3389 
   3390 - ``b``: A 1-bit integer register.
   3391 - ``c`` or ``h``: A 16-bit integer register.
   3392 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
   3393 - ``l`` or ``N``: A 64-bit integer register.
   3394 - ``f``: A 32-bit float register.
   3395 - ``d``: A 64-bit float register.
   3396 
   3397 
   3398 PowerPC:
   3399 
   3400 - ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
   3401 - ``J``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
   3402 - ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
   3403 - ``L``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
   3404 - ``M``: An immediate integer greater than 31.
   3405 - ``N``: An immediate integer that is an exact power of 2.
   3406 - ``O``: The immediate integer constant 0.
   3407 - ``P``: An immediate integer constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit
   3408   constant.
   3409 - ``es``, ``o``, ``Q``, ``Z``, ``Zy``: A memory address operand, currently
   3410   treated the same as ``m``.
   3411 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
   3412 - ``b``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register, excluding ``R0`` (that is:
   3413   ``R1-R31``).
   3414 - ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit float register (``F0-F31``), or when QPX is enabled, a
   3415   128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``; aliases the ``F`` registers).
   3416 - ``v``: For ``4 x f32`` or ``4 x f64`` types, when QPX is enabled, a
   3417   128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``), otherwise a 128-bit
   3418   altivec vector register (``V0-V31``).
   3419 
   3420   .. FIXME: is this a bug that v accepts QPX registers? I think this
   3421      is supposed to only use the altivec vector registers?
   3422 
   3423 - ``y``: Condition register (``CR0-CR7``).
   3424 - ``wc``: An individual CR bit in a CR register.
   3425 - ``wa``, ``wd``, ``wf``: Any 128-bit VSX vector register, from the full VSX
   3426   register set (overlapping both the floating-point and vector register files).
   3427 - ``ws``: A 32 or 64-bit floating point register, from the full VSX register
   3428   set.
   3429 
   3430 Sparc:
   3431 
   3432 - ``I``: An immediate 13-bit signed integer.
   3433 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
   3434 
   3435 SystemZ:
   3436 
   3437 - ``I``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
   3438 - ``J``: An immediate unsigned 12-bit integer.
   3439 - ``K``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
   3440 - ``L``: An immediate signed 20-bit integer.
   3441 - ``M``: An immediate integer 0x7fffffff.
   3442 - ``Q``, ``R``, ``S``, ``T``: A memory address operand, treated the same as
   3443   ``m``, at the moment.
   3444 - ``r`` or ``d``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer register.
   3445 - ``a``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer address register (excludes R0, which in an
   3446   address context evaluates as zero).
   3447 - ``h``: A 32-bit value in the high part of a 64bit data register
   3448   (LLVM-specific)
   3449 - ``f``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating point register.
   3450 
   3451 X86:
   3452 
   3453 - ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
   3454 - ``J``: An immediate integer between 0 and 64.
   3455 - ``K``: An immediate signed 8-bit integer.
   3456 - ``L``: An immediate integer, 0xff or 0xffff or (in 64-bit mode only)
   3457   0xffffffff.
   3458 - ``M``: An immediate integer between 0 and 3.
   3459 - ``N``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
   3460 - ``O``: An immediate integer between 0 and 127.
   3461 - ``e``: An immediate 32-bit signed integer.
   3462 - ``Z``: An immediate 32-bit unsigned integer.
   3463 - ``o``, ``v``: Treated the same as ``m``, at the moment.
   3464 - ``q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
   3465   ``l`` integer register. On X86-32, this is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d``
   3466   registers, and on X86-64, it is all of the integer registers.
   3467 - ``Q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
   3468   ``h`` integer register. This is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d`` registers.
   3469 - ``r`` or ``l``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit integer register.
   3470 - ``R``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit "legacy" integer register -- one which has
   3471   existed since i386, and can be accessed without the REX prefix.
   3472 - ``f``: A 32, 64, or 80-bit '387 FPU stack pseudo-register.
   3473 - ``y``: A 64-bit MMX register, if MMX is enabled.
   3474 - ``x``: If SSE is enabled: a 32 or 64-bit scalar operand, or 128-bit vector
   3475   operand in a SSE register. If AVX is also enabled, can also be a 256-bit
   3476   vector operand in an AVX register. If AVX-512 is also enabled, can also be a
   3477   512-bit vector operand in an AVX512 register, Otherwise, an error.
   3478 - ``Y``: The same as ``x``, if *SSE2* is enabled, otherwise an error.
   3479 - ``A``: Special case: allocates EAX first, then EDX, for a single operand (in
   3480   32-bit mode, a 64-bit integer operand will get split into two registers). It
   3481   is not recommended to use this constraint, as in 64-bit mode, the 64-bit
   3482   operand will get allocated only to RAX -- if two 32-bit operands are needed,
   3483   you're better off splitting it yourself, before passing it to the asm
   3484   statement.
   3485 
   3486 XCore:
   3487 
   3488 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
   3489 
   3490 
   3491 .. _inline-asm-modifiers:
   3492 
   3493 Asm template argument modifiers
   3494 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   3495 
   3496 In the asm template string, modifiers can be used on the operand reference, like
   3497 "``${0:n}``".
   3498 
   3499 The modifiers are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
   3500 GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
   3501 inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
   3502 and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
   3503 
   3504 Target-independent:
   3505 
   3506 - ``c``: Print an immediate integer constant unadorned, without
   3507   the target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
   3508 - ``n``: Negate and print immediate integer constant unadorned, without the
   3509   target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
   3510 - ``l``: Print as an unadorned label, without the target-specific label
   3511   punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
   3512 
   3513 AArch64:
   3514 
   3515 - ``w``: Print a GPR register with a ``w*`` name instead of ``x*`` name. E.g.,
   3516   instead of ``x30``, print ``w30``.
   3517 - ``x``: Print a GPR register with a ``x*`` name. (this is the default, anyhow).
   3518 - ``b``, ``h``, ``s``, ``d``, ``q``: Print a floating-point/SIMD register with a
   3519   ``b*``, ``h*``, ``s*``, ``d*``, or ``q*`` name, rather than the default of
   3520   ``v*``.
   3521 
   3522 AMDGPU:
   3523 
   3524 - ``r``: No effect.
   3525 
   3526 ARM:
   3527 
   3528 - ``a``: Print an operand as an address (with ``[`` and ``]`` surrounding a
   3529   register).
   3530 - ``P``: No effect.
   3531 - ``q``: No effect.
   3532 - ``y``: Print a VFP single-precision register as an indexed double (e.g. print
   3533   as ``d4[1]`` instead of ``s9``)
   3534 - ``B``: Bitwise invert and print an immediate integer constant without ``#``
   3535   prefix.
   3536 - ``L``: Print the low 16-bits of an immediate integer constant.
   3537 - ``M``: Print as a register set suitable for ldm/stm. Also prints *all*
   3538   register operands subsequent to the specified one (!), so use carefully.
   3539 - ``Q``: Print the low-order register of a register-pair, or the low-order
   3540   register of a two-register operand.
   3541 - ``R``: Print the high-order register of a register-pair, or the high-order
   3542   register of a two-register operand.
   3543 - ``H``: Print the second register of a register-pair. (On a big-endian system,
   3544   ``H`` is equivalent to ``Q``, and on little-endian system, ``H`` is equivalent
   3545   to ``R``.)
   3546 
   3547   .. FIXME: H doesn't currently support printing the second register
   3548      of a two-register operand.
   3549 
   3550 - ``e``: Print the low doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
   3551 - ``f``: Print the high doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
   3552 - ``m``: Print the base register of a memory operand without the ``[`` and ``]``
   3553   adornment.
   3554 
   3555 Hexagon:
   3556 
   3557 - ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
   3558   has been allocated consecutively to the first.
   3559 
   3560   .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
   3561      nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
   3562 
   3563 - ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
   3564   nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
   3565 
   3566 MSP430:
   3567 
   3568 No additional modifiers.
   3569 
   3570 MIPS:
   3571 
   3572 - ``X``: Print an immediate integer as hexadecimal
   3573 - ``x``: Print the low 16 bits of an immediate integer as hexadecimal.
   3574 - ``d``: Print an immediate integer as decimal.
   3575 - ``m``: Subtract one and print an immediate integer as decimal.
   3576 - ``z``: Print $0 if an immediate zero, otherwise print normally.
   3577 - ``L``: Print the low-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
   3578   address of the low-order word of a double-word memory operand.
   3579 
   3580   .. FIXME: L seems to be missing memory operand support.
   3581 
   3582 - ``M``: Print the high-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
   3583   address of the high-order word of a double-word memory operand.
   3584 
   3585   .. FIXME: M seems to be missing memory operand support.
   3586 
   3587 - ``D``: Print the second register of a two-register operand, or prints the
   3588   second word of a double-word memory operand. (On a big-endian system, ``D`` is
   3589   equivalent to ``L``, and on little-endian system, ``D`` is equivalent to
   3590   ``M``.)
   3591 - ``w``: No effect. Provided for compatibility with GCC which requires this
   3592   modifier in order to print MSA registers (``W0-W31``) with the ``f``
   3593   constraint.
   3594 
   3595 NVPTX:
   3596 
   3597 - ``r``: No effect.
   3598 
   3599 PowerPC:
   3600 
   3601 - ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
   3602   has been allocated consecutively to the first.
   3603 
   3604   .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
   3605      nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
   3606 
   3607 - ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
   3608   nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
   3609 - ``y``: For a memory operand, prints formatter for a two-register X-form
   3610   instruction. (Currently always prints ``r0,OPERAND``).
   3611 - ``U``: Prints 'u' if the memory operand is an update form, and nothing
   3612   otherwise. (NOTE: LLVM does not support update form, so this will currently
   3613   always print nothing)
   3614 - ``X``: Prints 'x' if the memory operand is an indexed form. (NOTE: LLVM does
   3615   not support indexed form, so this will currently always print nothing)
   3616 
   3617 Sparc:
   3618 
   3619 - ``r``: No effect.
   3620 
   3621 SystemZ:
   3622 
   3623 SystemZ implements only ``n``, and does *not* support any of the other
   3624 target-independent modifiers.
   3625 
   3626 X86:
   3627 
   3628 - ``c``: Print an unadorned integer or symbol name. (The latter is
   3629   target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier).
   3630 - ``A``: Print a register name with a '``*``' before it.
   3631 - ``b``: Print an 8-bit register name (e.g. ``al``); do nothing on a memory
   3632   operand.
   3633 - ``h``: Print the upper 8-bit register name (e.g. ``ah``); do nothing on a
   3634   memory operand.
   3635 - ``w``: Print the 16-bit register name (e.g. ``ax``); do nothing on a memory
   3636   operand.
   3637 - ``k``: Print the 32-bit register name (e.g. ``eax``); do nothing on a memory
   3638   operand.
   3639 - ``q``: Print the 64-bit register name (e.g. ``rax``), if 64-bit registers are
   3640   available, otherwise the 32-bit register name; do nothing on a memory operand.
   3641 - ``n``: Negate and print an unadorned integer, or, for operands other than an
   3642   immediate integer (e.g. a relocatable symbol expression), print a '-' before
   3643   the operand. (The behavior for relocatable symbol expressions is a
   3644   target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier)
   3645 - ``H``: Print a memory reference with additional offset +8.
   3646 - ``P``: Print a memory reference or operand for use as the argument of a call
   3647   instruction. (E.g. omit ``(rip)``, even though it's PC-relative.)
   3648 
   3649 XCore:
   3650 
   3651 No additional modifiers.
   3652 
   3653 
   3654 Inline Asm Metadata
   3655 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   3656 
   3657 The call instructions that wrap inline asm nodes may have a
   3658 "``!srcloc``" MDNode attached to it that contains a list of constant
   3659 integers. If present, the code generator will use the integer as the
   3660 location cookie value when report errors through the ``LLVMContext``
   3661 error reporting mechanisms. This allows a front-end to correlate backend
   3662 errors that occur with inline asm back to the source code that produced
   3663 it. For example:
   3664 
   3665 .. code-block:: llvm
   3666 
   3667     call void asm sideeffect "something bad", ""(), !srcloc !42
   3668     ...
   3669     !42 = !{ i32 1234567 }
   3670 
   3671 It is up to the front-end to make sense of the magic numbers it places
   3672 in the IR. If the MDNode contains multiple constants, the code generator
   3673 will use the one that corresponds to the line of the asm that the error
   3674 occurs on.
   3675 
   3676 .. _metadata:
   3677 
   3678 Metadata
   3679 ========
   3680 
   3681 LLVM IR allows metadata to be attached to instructions in the program
   3682 that can convey extra information about the code to the optimizers and
   3683 code generator. One example application of metadata is source-level
   3684 debug information. There are two metadata primitives: strings and nodes.
   3685 
   3686 Metadata does not have a type, and is not a value. If referenced from a
   3687 ``call`` instruction, it uses the ``metadata`` type.
   3688 
   3689 All metadata are identified in syntax by a exclamation point ('``!``').
   3690 
   3691 .. _metadata-string:
   3692 
   3693 Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings
   3694 -----------------------------------
   3695 
   3696 A metadata string is a string surrounded by double quotes. It can
   3697 contain any character by escaping non-printable characters with
   3698 "``\xx``" where "``xx``" is the two digit hex code. For example:
   3699 "``!"test\00"``".
   3700 
   3701 Metadata nodes are represented with notation similar to structure
   3702 constants (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces and
   3703 preceded by an exclamation point). Metadata nodes can have any values as
   3704 their operand. For example:
   3705 
   3706 .. code-block:: llvm
   3707 
   3708     !{ !"test\00", i32 10}
   3709 
   3710 Metadata nodes that aren't uniqued use the ``distinct`` keyword. For example:
   3711 
   3712 .. code-block:: llvm
   3713 
   3714     !0 = distinct !{!"test\00", i32 10}
   3715 
   3716 ``distinct`` nodes are useful when nodes shouldn't be merged based on their
   3717 content. They can also occur when transformations cause uniquing collisions
   3718 when metadata operands change.
   3719 
   3720 A :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` is a collection of
   3721 metadata nodes, which can be looked up in the module symbol table. For
   3722 example:
   3723 
   3724 .. code-block:: llvm
   3725 
   3726     !foo = !{!4, !3}
   3727 
   3728 Metadata can be used as function arguments. Here ``llvm.dbg.value``
   3729 function is using two metadata arguments:
   3730 
   3731 .. code-block:: llvm
   3732 
   3733     call void @llvm.dbg.value(metadata !24, i64 0, metadata !25)
   3734 
   3735 Metadata can be attached to an instruction. Here metadata ``!21`` is attached
   3736 to the ``add`` instruction using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
   3737 
   3738 .. code-block:: llvm
   3739 
   3740     %indvar.next = add i64 %indvar, 1, !dbg !21
   3741 
   3742 Metadata can also be attached to a function definition. Here metadata ``!22``
   3743 is attached to the ``foo`` function using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
   3744 
   3745 .. code-block:: llvm
   3746 
   3747     define void @foo() !dbg !22 {
   3748       ret void
   3749     }
   3750 
   3751 More information about specific metadata nodes recognized by the
   3752 optimizers and code generator is found below.
   3753 
   3754 .. _specialized-metadata:
   3755 
   3756 Specialized Metadata Nodes
   3757 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   3758 
   3759 Specialized metadata nodes are custom data structures in metadata (as opposed
   3760 to generic tuples). Their fields are labelled, and can be specified in any
   3761 order.
   3762 
   3763 These aren't inherently debug info centric, but currently all the specialized
   3764 metadata nodes are related to debug info.
   3765 
   3766 .. _DICompileUnit:
   3767 
   3768 DICompileUnit
   3769 """""""""""""
   3770 
   3771 ``DICompileUnit`` nodes represent a compile unit. The ``enums:``,
   3772 ``retainedTypes:``, ``subprograms:``, ``globals:``, ``imports:`` and ``macros:``
   3773 fields are tuples containing the debug info to be emitted along with the compile
   3774 unit, regardless of code optimizations (some nodes are only emitted if there are
   3775 references to them from instructions).
   3776 
   3777 .. code-block:: llvm
   3778 
   3779     !0 = !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !1, producer: "clang",
   3780                         isOptimized: true, flags: "-O2", runtimeVersion: 2,
   3781                         splitDebugFilename: "abc.debug", emissionKind: 1,
   3782                         enums: !2, retainedTypes: !3, subprograms: !4,
   3783                         globals: !5, imports: !6, macros: !7, dwoId: 0x0abcd)
   3784 
   3785 Compile unit descriptors provide the root scope for objects declared in a
   3786 specific compilation unit. File descriptors are defined using this scope.
   3787 These descriptors are collected by a named metadata ``!llvm.dbg.cu``. They
   3788 keep track of subprograms, global variables, type information, and imported
   3789 entities (declarations and namespaces).
   3790 
   3791 .. _DIFile:
   3792 
   3793 DIFile
   3794 """"""
   3795 
   3796 ``DIFile`` nodes represent files. The ``filename:`` can include slashes.
   3797 
   3798 .. code-block:: llvm
   3799 
   3800     !0 = !DIFile(filename: "path/to/file", directory: "/path/to/dir")
   3801 
   3802 Files are sometimes used in ``scope:`` fields, and are the only valid target
   3803 for ``file:`` fields.
   3804 
   3805 .. _DIBasicType:
   3806 
   3807 DIBasicType
   3808 """""""""""
   3809 
   3810 ``DIBasicType`` nodes represent primitive types, such as ``int``, ``bool`` and
   3811 ``float``. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_base_type``.
   3812 
   3813 .. code-block:: llvm
   3814 
   3815     !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
   3816                       encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
   3817     !1 = !DIBasicType(tag: DW_TAG_unspecified_type, name: "decltype(nullptr)")
   3818 
   3819 The ``encoding:`` describes the details of the type. Usually it's one of the
   3820 following:
   3821 
   3822 .. code-block:: llvm
   3823 
   3824   DW_ATE_address       = 1
   3825   DW_ATE_boolean       = 2
   3826   DW_ATE_float         = 4
   3827   DW_ATE_signed        = 5
   3828   DW_ATE_signed_char   = 6
   3829   DW_ATE_unsigned      = 7
   3830   DW_ATE_unsigned_char = 8
   3831 
   3832 .. _DISubroutineType:
   3833 
   3834 DISubroutineType
   3835 """"""""""""""""
   3836 
   3837 ``DISubroutineType`` nodes represent subroutine types. Their ``types:`` field
   3838 refers to a tuple; the first operand is the return type, while the rest are the
   3839 types of the formal arguments in order. If the first operand is ``null``, that
   3840 represents a function with no return value (such as ``void foo() {}`` in C++).
   3841 
   3842 .. code-block:: llvm
   3843 
   3844     !0 = !BasicType(name: "int", size: 32, align: 32, DW_ATE_signed)
   3845     !1 = !BasicType(name: "char", size: 8, align: 8, DW_ATE_signed_char)
   3846     !2 = !DISubroutineType(types: !{null, !0, !1}) ; void (int, char)
   3847 
   3848 .. _DIDerivedType:
   3849 
   3850 DIDerivedType
   3851 """""""""""""
   3852 
   3853 ``DIDerivedType`` nodes represent types derived from other types, such as
   3854 qualified types.
   3855 
   3856 .. code-block:: llvm
   3857 
   3858     !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
   3859                       encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
   3860     !1 = !DIDerivedType(tag: DW_TAG_pointer_type, baseType: !0, size: 32,
   3861                         align: 32)
   3862 
   3863 The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
   3864 
   3865 .. code-block:: llvm
   3866 
   3867   DW_TAG_formal_parameter   = 5
   3868   DW_TAG_member             = 13
   3869   DW_TAG_pointer_type       = 15
   3870   DW_TAG_reference_type     = 16
   3871   DW_TAG_typedef            = 22
   3872   DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type = 31
   3873   DW_TAG_const_type         = 38
   3874   DW_TAG_volatile_type      = 53
   3875   DW_TAG_restrict_type      = 55
   3876 
   3877 ``DW_TAG_member`` is used to define a member of a :ref:`composite type
   3878 <DICompositeType>` or :ref:`subprogram <DISubprogram>`. The type of the member
   3879 is the ``baseType:``. The ``offset:`` is the member's bit offset.
   3880 ``DW_TAG_formal_parameter`` is used to define a member which is a formal
   3881 argument of a subprogram.
   3882 
   3883 ``DW_TAG_typedef`` is used to provide a name for the ``baseType:``.
   3884 
   3885 ``DW_TAG_pointer_type``, ``DW_TAG_reference_type``, ``DW_TAG_const_type``,
   3886 ``DW_TAG_volatile_type`` and ``DW_TAG_restrict_type`` are used to qualify the
   3887 ``baseType:``.
   3888 
   3889 Note that the ``void *`` type is expressed as a type derived from NULL.
   3890 
   3891 .. _DICompositeType:
   3892 
   3893 DICompositeType
   3894 """""""""""""""
   3895 
   3896 ``DICompositeType`` nodes represent types composed of other types, like
   3897 structures and unions. ``elements:`` points to a tuple of the composed types.
   3898 
   3899 If the source language supports ODR, the ``identifier:`` field gives the unique
   3900 identifier used for type merging between modules. When specified, other types
   3901 can refer to composite types indirectly via a :ref:`metadata string
   3902 <metadata-string>` that matches their identifier.
   3903 
   3904 .. code-block:: llvm
   3905 
   3906     !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
   3907     !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
   3908     !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
   3909     !3 = !DICompositeType(tag: DW_TAG_enumeration_type, name: "Enum", file: !12,
   3910                           line: 2, size: 32, align: 32, identifier: "_M4Enum",
   3911                           elements: !{!0, !1, !2})
   3912 
   3913 The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
   3914 
   3915 .. code-block:: llvm
   3916 
   3917   DW_TAG_array_type       = 1
   3918   DW_TAG_class_type       = 2
   3919   DW_TAG_enumeration_type = 4
   3920   DW_TAG_structure_type   = 19
   3921   DW_TAG_union_type       = 23
   3922   DW_TAG_subroutine_type  = 21
   3923   DW_TAG_inheritance      = 28
   3924 
   3925 
   3926 For ``DW_TAG_array_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`subrange
   3927 descriptors <DISubrange>`, each representing the range of subscripts at that
   3928 level of indexing. The ``DIFlagVector`` flag to ``flags:`` indicates that an
   3929 array type is a native packed vector.
   3930 
   3931 For ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`enumerator
   3932 descriptors <DIEnumerator>`, each representing the definition of an enumeration
   3933 value for the set. All enumeration type descriptors are collected in the
   3934 ``enums:`` field of the :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
   3935 
   3936 For ``DW_TAG_structure_type``, ``DW_TAG_class_type``, and
   3937 ``DW_TAG_union_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`derived types
   3938 <DIDerivedType>` with ``tag: DW_TAG_member`` or ``tag: DW_TAG_inheritance``.
   3939 
   3940 .. _DISubrange:
   3941 
   3942 DISubrange
   3943 """"""""""
   3944 
   3945 ``DISubrange`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_array_type`` variants of
   3946 :ref:`DICompositeType`. ``count: -1`` indicates an empty array.
   3947 
   3948 .. code-block:: llvm
   3949 
   3950     !0 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 0) ; array counting from 0
   3951     !1 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 1) ; array counting from 1
   3952     !2 = !DISubrange(count: -1) ; empty array.
   3953 
   3954 .. _DIEnumerator:
   3955 
   3956 DIEnumerator
   3957 """"""""""""
   3958 
   3959 ``DIEnumerator`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``
   3960 variants of :ref:`DICompositeType`.
   3961 
   3962 .. code-block:: llvm
   3963 
   3964     !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
   3965     !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
   3966     !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
   3967 
   3968 DITemplateTypeParameter
   3969 """""""""""""""""""""""
   3970 
   3971 ``DITemplateTypeParameter`` nodes represent type parameters to generic source
   3972 language constructs. They are used (optionally) in :ref:`DICompositeType` and
   3973 :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
   3974 
   3975 .. code-block:: llvm
   3976 
   3977     !0 = !DITemplateTypeParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1)
   3978 
   3979 DITemplateValueParameter
   3980 """"""""""""""""""""""""
   3981 
   3982 ``DITemplateValueParameter`` nodes represent value parameters to generic source
   3983 language constructs. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_template_value_parameter``,
   3984 but if specified can also be set to ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param`` or
   3985 ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_param_pack``. They are used (optionally) in
   3986 :ref:`DICompositeType` and :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
   3987 
   3988 .. code-block:: llvm
   3989 
   3990     !0 = !DITemplateValueParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1, value: i32 7)
   3991 
   3992 DINamespace
   3993 """""""""""
   3994 
   3995 ``DINamespace`` nodes represent namespaces in the source language.
   3996 
   3997 .. code-block:: llvm
   3998 
   3999     !0 = !DINamespace(name: "myawesomeproject", scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7)
   4000 
   4001 DIGlobalVariable
   4002 """"""""""""""""
   4003 
   4004 ``DIGlobalVariable`` nodes represent global variables in the source language.
   4005 
   4006 .. code-block:: llvm
   4007 
   4008     !0 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "foo", linkageName: "foo", scope: !1,
   4009                            file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
   4010                            isDefinition: false, variable: i32* @foo,
   4011                            declaration: !4)
   4012 
   4013 All global variables should be referenced by the `globals:` field of a
   4014 :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
   4015 
   4016 .. _DISubprogram:
   4017 
   4018 DISubprogram
   4019 """"""""""""
   4020 
   4021 ``DISubprogram`` nodes represent functions from the source language. A
   4022 ``DISubprogram`` may be attached to a function definition using ``!dbg``
   4023 metadata. The ``variables:`` field points at :ref:`variables <DILocalVariable>`
   4024 that must be retained, even if their IR counterparts are optimized out of
   4025 the IR. The ``type:`` field must point at an :ref:`DISubroutineType`.
   4026 
   4027 .. code-block:: llvm
   4028 
   4029     define void @_Z3foov() !dbg !0 {
   4030       ...
   4031     }
   4032 
   4033     !0 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", linkageName: "_Zfoov", scope: !1,
   4034                                 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
   4035                                 isDefinition: false, scopeLine: 8,
   4036                                 containingType: !4,
   4037                                 virtuality: DW_VIRTUALITY_pure_virtual,
   4038                                 virtualIndex: 10, flags: DIFlagPrototyped,
   4039                                 isOptimized: true, templateParams: !5,
   4040                                 declaration: !6, variables: !7)
   4041 
   4042 .. _DILexicalBlock:
   4043 
   4044 DILexicalBlock
   4045 """"""""""""""
   4046 
   4047 ``DILexicalBlock`` nodes describe nested blocks within a :ref:`subprogram
   4048 <DISubprogram>`. The line number and column numbers are used to distinguish
   4049 two lexical blocks at same depth. They are valid targets for ``scope:``
   4050 fields.
   4051 
   4052 .. code-block:: llvm
   4053 
   4054     !0 = distinct !DILexicalBlock(scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7, column: 35)
   4055 
   4056 Usually lexical blocks are ``distinct`` to prevent node merging based on
   4057 operands.
   4058 
   4059 .. _DILexicalBlockFile:
   4060 
   4061 DILexicalBlockFile
   4062 """"""""""""""""""
   4063 
   4064 ``DILexicalBlockFile`` nodes are used to discriminate between sections of a
   4065 :ref:`lexical block <DILexicalBlock>`. The ``file:`` field can be changed to
   4066 indicate textual inclusion, or the ``discriminator:`` field can be used to
   4067 discriminate between control flow within a single block in the source language.
   4068 
   4069 .. code-block:: llvm
   4070 
   4071     !0 = !DILexicalBlock(scope: !3, file: !4, line: 7, column: 35)
   4072     !1 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 0)
   4073     !2 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 1)
   4074 
   4075 .. _DILocation:
   4076 
   4077 DILocation
   4078 """"""""""
   4079 
   4080 ``DILocation`` nodes represent source debug locations. The ``scope:`` field is
   4081 mandatory, and points at an :ref:`DILexicalBlockFile`, an
   4082 :ref:`DILexicalBlock`, or an :ref:`DISubprogram`.
   4083 
   4084 .. code-block:: llvm
   4085 
   4086     !0 = !DILocation(line: 2900, column: 42, scope: !1, inlinedAt: !2)
   4087 
   4088 .. _DILocalVariable:
   4089 
   4090 DILocalVariable
   4091 """""""""""""""
   4092 
   4093 ``DILocalVariable`` nodes represent local variables in the source language. If
   4094 the ``arg:`` field is set to non-zero, then this variable is a subprogram
   4095 parameter, and it will be included in the ``variables:`` field of its
   4096 :ref:`DISubprogram`.
   4097 
   4098 .. code-block:: llvm
   4099 
   4100     !0 = !DILocalVariable(name: "this", arg: 1, scope: !3, file: !2, line: 7,
   4101                           type: !3, flags: DIFlagArtificial)
   4102     !1 = !DILocalVariable(name: "x", arg: 2, scope: !4, file: !2, line: 7,
   4103                           type: !3)
   4104     !2 = !DILocalVariable(name: "y", scope: !5, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3)
   4105 
   4106 DIExpression
   4107 """"""""""""
   4108 
   4109 ``DIExpression`` nodes represent DWARF expression sequences. They are used in
   4110 :ref:`debug intrinsics<dbg_intrinsics>` (such as ``llvm.dbg.declare``) to
   4111 describe how the referenced LLVM variable relates to the source language
   4112 variable.
   4113 
   4114 The current supported vocabulary is limited:
   4115 
   4116 - ``DW_OP_deref`` dereferences the working expression.
   4117 - ``DW_OP_plus, 93`` adds ``93`` to the working expression.
   4118 - ``DW_OP_bit_piece, 16, 8`` specifies the offset and size (``16`` and ``8``
   4119   here, respectively) of the variable piece from the working expression.
   4120 
   4121 .. code-block:: llvm
   4122 
   4123     !0 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref)
   4124     !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_plus, 3)
   4125     !2 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
   4126     !3 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref, DW_OP_plus, 3, DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
   4127 
   4128 DIObjCProperty
   4129 """"""""""""""
   4130 
   4131 ``DIObjCProperty`` nodes represent Objective-C property nodes.
   4132 
   4133 .. code-block:: llvm
   4134 
   4135     !3 = !DIObjCProperty(name: "foo", file: !1, line: 7, setter: "setFoo",
   4136                          getter: "getFoo", attributes: 7, type: !2)
   4137 
   4138 DIImportedEntity
   4139 """"""""""""""""
   4140 
   4141 ``DIImportedEntity`` nodes represent entities (such as modules) imported into a
   4142 compile unit.
   4143 
   4144 .. code-block:: llvm
   4145 
   4146    !2 = !DIImportedEntity(tag: DW_TAG_imported_module, name: "foo", scope: !0,
   4147                           entity: !1, line: 7)
   4148 
   4149 DIMacro
   4150 """""""
   4151 
   4152 ``DIMacro`` nodes represent definition or undefinition of a macro identifiers.
   4153 The ``name:`` field is the macro identifier, followed by macro parameters when
   4154 definining a function-like macro, and the ``value`` field is the token-string
   4155 used to expand the macro identifier.
   4156 
   4157 .. code-block:: llvm
   4158 
   4159    !2 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_define, line: 7, name: "foo(x)",
   4160                  value: "((x) + 1)")
   4161    !3 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_undef, line: 30, name: "foo")
   4162 
   4163 DIMacroFile
   4164 """""""""""
   4165 
   4166 ``DIMacroFile`` nodes represent inclusion of source files.
   4167 The ``nodes:`` field is a list of ``DIMacro`` and ``DIMacroFile`` nodes that
   4168 appear in the included source file.
   4169 
   4170 .. code-block:: llvm
   4171 
   4172    !2 = !DIMacroFile(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_start_file, line: 7, file: !2,
   4173                      nodes: !3)
   4174 
   4175 '``tbaa``' Metadata
   4176 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4177 
   4178 In LLVM IR, memory does not have types, so LLVM's own type system is not
   4179 suitable for doing TBAA. Instead, metadata is added to the IR to
   4180 describe a type system of a higher level language. This can be used to
   4181 implement typical C/C++ TBAA, but it can also be used to implement
   4182 custom alias analysis behavior for other languages.
   4183 
   4184 The current metadata format is very simple. TBAA metadata nodes have up
   4185 to three fields, e.g.:
   4186 
   4187 .. code-block:: llvm
   4188 
   4189     !0 = !{ !"an example type tree" }
   4190     !1 = !{ !"int", !0 }
   4191     !2 = !{ !"float", !0 }
   4192     !3 = !{ !"const float", !2, i64 1 }
   4193 
   4194 The first field is an identity field. It can be any value, usually a
   4195 metadata string, which uniquely identifies the type. The most important
   4196 name in the tree is the name of the root node. Two trees with different
   4197 root node names are entirely disjoint, even if they have leaves with
   4198 common names.
   4199 
   4200 The second field identifies the type's parent node in the tree, or is
   4201 null or omitted for a root node. A type is considered to alias all of
   4202 its descendants and all of its ancestors in the tree. Also, a type is
   4203 considered to alias all types in other trees, so that bitcode produced
   4204 from multiple front-ends is handled conservatively.
   4205 
   4206 If the third field is present, it's an integer which if equal to 1
   4207 indicates that the type is "constant" (meaning
   4208 ``pointsToConstantMemory`` should return true; see `other useful
   4209 AliasAnalysis methods <AliasAnalysis.html#OtherItfs>`_).
   4210 
   4211 '``tbaa.struct``' Metadata
   4212 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4213 
   4214 The :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>` is often used to implement
   4215 aggregate assignment operations in C and similar languages, however it
   4216 is defined to copy a contiguous region of memory, which is more than
   4217 strictly necessary for aggregate types which contain holes due to
   4218 padding. Also, it doesn't contain any TBAA information about the fields
   4219 of the aggregate.
   4220 
   4221 ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata can describe which memory subregions in a
   4222 memcpy are padding and what the TBAA tags of the struct are.
   4223 
   4224 The current metadata format is very simple. ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata
   4225 nodes are a list of operands which are in conceptual groups of three.
   4226 For each group of three, the first operand gives the byte offset of a
   4227 field in bytes, the second gives its size in bytes, and the third gives
   4228 its tbaa tag. e.g.:
   4229 
   4230 .. code-block:: llvm
   4231 
   4232     !4 = !{ i64 0, i64 4, !1, i64 8, i64 4, !2 }
   4233 
   4234 This describes a struct with two fields. The first is at offset 0 bytes
   4235 with size 4 bytes, and has tbaa tag !1. The second is at offset 8 bytes
   4236 and has size 4 bytes and has tbaa tag !2.
   4237 
   4238 Note that the fields need not be contiguous. In this example, there is a
   4239 4 byte gap between the two fields. This gap represents padding which
   4240 does not carry useful data and need not be preserved.
   4241 
   4242 '``noalias``' and '``alias.scope``' Metadata
   4243 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4244 
   4245 ``noalias`` and ``alias.scope`` metadata provide the ability to specify generic
   4246 noalias memory-access sets. This means that some collection of memory access
   4247 instructions (loads, stores, memory-accessing calls, etc.) that carry
   4248 ``noalias`` metadata can specifically be specified not to alias with some other
   4249 collection of memory access instructions that carry ``alias.scope`` metadata.
   4250 Each type of metadata specifies a list of scopes where each scope has an id and
   4251 a domain. When evaluating an aliasing query, if for some domain, the set
   4252 of scopes with that domain in one instruction's ``alias.scope`` list is a
   4253 subset of (or equal to) the set of scopes for that domain in another
   4254 instruction's ``noalias`` list, then the two memory accesses are assumed not to
   4255 alias.
   4256 
   4257 The metadata identifying each domain is itself a list containing one or two
   4258 entries. The first entry is the name of the domain. Note that if the name is a
   4259 string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
   4260 self-reference can be used to create globally unique domain names. A
   4261 descriptive string may optionally be provided as a second list entry.
   4262 
   4263 The metadata identifying each scope is also itself a list containing two or
   4264 three entries. The first entry is the name of the scope. Note that if the name
   4265 is a string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
   4266 self-reference can be used to create globally unique scope names. A metadata
   4267 reference to the scope's domain is the second entry. A descriptive string may
   4268 optionally be provided as a third list entry.
   4269 
   4270 For example,
   4271 
   4272 .. code-block:: llvm
   4273 
   4274     ; Two scope domains:
   4275     !0 = !{!0}
   4276     !1 = !{!1}
   4277 
   4278     ; Some scopes in these domains:
   4279     !2 = !{!2, !0}
   4280     !3 = !{!3, !0}
   4281     !4 = !{!4, !1}
   4282 
   4283     ; Some scope lists:
   4284     !5 = !{!4} ; A list containing only scope !4
   4285     !6 = !{!4, !3, !2}
   4286     !7 = !{!3}
   4287 
   4288     ; These two instructions don't alias:
   4289     %0 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
   4290     store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !5
   4291 
   4292     ; These two instructions also don't alias (for domain !1, the set of scopes
   4293     ; in the !alias.scope equals that in the !noalias list):
   4294     %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
   4295     store float %2, float* %arrayidx.i2, align 4, !noalias !6
   4296 
   4297     ; These two instructions may alias (for domain !0, the set of scopes in
   4298     ; the !noalias list is not a superset of, or equal to, the scopes in the
   4299     ; !alias.scope list):
   4300     %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !6
   4301     store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !7
   4302 
   4303 '``fpmath``' Metadata
   4304 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4305 
   4306 ``fpmath`` metadata may be attached to any instruction of floating point
   4307 type. It can be used to express the maximum acceptable error in the
   4308 result of that instruction, in ULPs, thus potentially allowing the
   4309 compiler to use a more efficient but less accurate method of computing
   4310 it. ULP is defined as follows:
   4311 
   4312     If ``x`` is a real number that lies between two finite consecutive
   4313     floating-point numbers ``a`` and ``b``, without being equal to one
   4314     of them, then ``ulp(x) = |b - a|``, otherwise ``ulp(x)`` is the
   4315     distance between the two non-equal finite floating-point numbers
   4316     nearest ``x``. Moreover, ``ulp(NaN)`` is ``NaN``.
   4317 
   4318 The metadata node shall consist of a single positive floating point
   4319 number representing the maximum relative error, for example:
   4320 
   4321 .. code-block:: llvm
   4322 
   4323     !0 = !{ float 2.5 } ; maximum acceptable inaccuracy is 2.5 ULPs
   4324 
   4325 .. _range-metadata:
   4326 
   4327 '``range``' Metadata
   4328 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4329 
   4330 ``range`` metadata may be attached only to ``load``, ``call`` and ``invoke`` of
   4331 integer types. It expresses the possible ranges the loaded value or the value
   4332 returned by the called function at this call site is in. The ranges are
   4333 represented with a flattened list of integers. The loaded value or the value
   4334 returned is known to be in the union of the ranges defined by each consecutive
   4335 pair. Each pair has the following properties:
   4336 
   4337 -  The type must match the type loaded by the instruction.
   4338 -  The pair ``a,b`` represents the range ``[a,b)``.
   4339 -  Both ``a`` and ``b`` are constants.
   4340 -  The range is allowed to wrap.
   4341 -  The range should not represent the full or empty set. That is,
   4342    ``a!=b``.
   4343 
   4344 In addition, the pairs must be in signed order of the lower bound and
   4345 they must be non-contiguous.
   4346 
   4347 Examples:
   4348 
   4349 .. code-block:: llvm
   4350 
   4351       %a = load i8, i8* %x, align 1, !range !0 ; Can only be 0 or 1
   4352       %b = load i8, i8* %y, align 1, !range !1 ; Can only be 255 (-1), 0 or 1
   4353       %c = call i8 @foo(),       !range !2 ; Can only be 0, 1, 3, 4 or 5
   4354       %d = invoke i8 @bar() to label %cont
   4355              unwind label %lpad, !range !3 ; Can only be -2, -1, 3, 4 or 5
   4356     ...
   4357     !0 = !{ i8 0, i8 2 }
   4358     !1 = !{ i8 255, i8 2 }
   4359     !2 = !{ i8 0, i8 2, i8 3, i8 6 }
   4360     !3 = !{ i8 -2, i8 0, i8 3, i8 6 }
   4361 
   4362 '``unpredictable``' Metadata
   4363 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4364 
   4365 ``unpredictable`` metadata may be attached to any branch or switch
   4366 instruction. It can be used to express the unpredictability of control
   4367 flow. Similar to the llvm.expect intrinsic, it may be used to alter
   4368 optimizations related to compare and branch instructions. The metadata
   4369 is treated as a boolean value; if it exists, it signals that the branch
   4370 or switch that it is attached to is completely unpredictable.
   4371 
   4372 '``llvm.loop``'
   4373 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4374 
   4375 It is sometimes useful to attach information to loop constructs. Currently,
   4376 loop metadata is implemented as metadata attached to the branch instruction
   4377 in the loop latch block. This type of metadata refer to a metadata node that is
   4378 guaranteed to be separate for each loop. The loop identifier metadata is
   4379 specified with the name ``llvm.loop``.
   4380 
   4381 The loop identifier metadata is implemented using a metadata that refers to
   4382 itself to avoid merging it with any other identifier metadata, e.g.,
   4383 during module linkage or function inlining. That is, each loop should refer
   4384 to their own identification metadata even if they reside in separate functions.
   4385 The following example contains loop identifier metadata for two separate loop
   4386 constructs:
   4387 
   4388 .. code-block:: llvm
   4389 
   4390     !0 = !{!0}
   4391     !1 = !{!1}
   4392 
   4393 The loop identifier metadata can be used to specify additional
   4394 per-loop metadata. Any operands after the first operand can be treated
   4395 as user-defined metadata. For example the ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``
   4396 suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller:
   4397 
   4398 .. code-block:: llvm
   4399 
   4400       br i1 %exitcond, label %._crit_edge, label %.lr.ph, !llvm.loop !0
   4401     ...
   4402     !0 = !{!0, !1}
   4403     !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
   4404 
   4405 '``llvm.loop.vectorize``' and '``llvm.loop.interleave``'
   4406 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4407 
   4408 Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` or ``llvm.loop.interleave`` are
   4409 used to control per-loop vectorization and interleaving parameters such as
   4410 vectorization width and interleave count. These metadata should be used in
   4411 conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop identification metadata. The
   4412 ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` and ``llvm.loop.interleave`` metadata are only
   4413 optimization hints and the optimizer will only interleave and vectorize loops if
   4414 it believes it is safe to do so. The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata
   4415 which contains information about loop-carried memory dependencies can be helpful
   4416 in determining the safety of these transformations.
   4417 
   4418 '``llvm.loop.interleave.count``' Metadata
   4419 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4420 
   4421 This metadata suggests an interleave count to the loop interleaver.
   4422 The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` and the
   4423 second operand is an integer specifying the interleave count. For
   4424 example:
   4425 
   4426 .. code-block:: llvm
   4427 
   4428    !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.interleave.count", i32 4}
   4429 
   4430 Note that setting ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` to 1 disables interleaving
   4431 multiple iterations of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` is set to 0
   4432 then the interleave count will be determined automatically.
   4433 
   4434 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable``' Metadata
   4435 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4436 
   4437 This metadata selectively enables or disables vectorization for the loop. The
   4438 first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable`` and the second operand
   4439 is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 vectorization is enabled. A value of
   4440 0 disables vectorization:
   4441 
   4442 .. code-block:: llvm
   4443 
   4444    !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 0}
   4445    !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 1}
   4446 
   4447 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.width``' Metadata
   4448 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4449 
   4450 This metadata sets the target width of the vectorizer. The first
   4451 operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` and the second
   4452 operand is an integer specifying the width. For example:
   4453 
   4454 .. code-block:: llvm
   4455 
   4456    !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.width", i32 4}
   4457 
   4458 Note that setting ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` to 1 disables
   4459 vectorization of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` is set to
   4460 0 or if the loop does not have this metadata the width will be
   4461 determined automatically.
   4462 
   4463 '``llvm.loop.unroll``'
   4464 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4465 
   4466 Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.unroll`` are loop unrolling
   4467 optimization hints such as the unroll factor. ``llvm.loop.unroll``
   4468 metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
   4469 identification metadata. The ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata are only
   4470 optimization hints and the unrolling will only be performed if the
   4471 optimizer believes it is safe to do so.
   4472 
   4473 '``llvm.loop.unroll.count``' Metadata
   4474 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4475 
   4476 This metadata suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller. The
   4477 first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.count`` and the second
   4478 operand is a positive integer specifying the unroll factor. For
   4479 example:
   4480 
   4481 .. code-block:: llvm
   4482 
   4483    !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
   4484 
   4485 If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
   4486 will be partially unrolled.
   4487 
   4488 '``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``' Metadata
   4489 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4490 
   4491 This metadata disables loop unrolling. The metadata has a single operand
   4492 which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``. For example:
   4493 
   4494 .. code-block:: llvm
   4495 
   4496    !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.disable"}
   4497 
   4498 '``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``' Metadata
   4499 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4500 
   4501 This metadata disables runtime loop unrolling. The metadata has a single
   4502 operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``. For example:
   4503 
   4504 .. code-block:: llvm
   4505 
   4506    !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable"}
   4507 
   4508 '``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``' Metadata
   4509 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4510 
   4511 This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unrolled if the trip count
   4512 is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is not known
   4513 at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the string
   4514 ``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``.  For example:
   4515 
   4516 .. code-block:: llvm
   4517 
   4518    !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.enable"}
   4519 
   4520 '``llvm.loop.unroll.full``' Metadata
   4521 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4522 
   4523 This metadata suggests that the loop should be unrolled fully. The
   4524 metadata has a single operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.full``.
   4525 For example:
   4526 
   4527 .. code-block:: llvm
   4528 
   4529    !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.full"}
   4530 
   4531 '``llvm.mem``'
   4532 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4533 
   4534 Metadata types used to annotate memory accesses with information helpful
   4535 for optimizations are prefixed with ``llvm.mem``.
   4536 
   4537 '``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``' Metadata
   4538 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4539 
   4540 The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata refers to a loop identifier,
   4541 or metadata containing a list of loop identifiers for nested loops.
   4542 The metadata is attached to memory accessing instructions and denotes that
   4543 no loop carried memory dependence exist between it and other instructions denoted
   4544 with the same loop identifier.
   4545 
   4546 Precisely, given two instructions ``m1`` and ``m2`` that both have the
   4547 ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata, with ``L1`` and ``L2`` being the
   4548 set of loops associated with that metadata, respectively, then there is no loop
   4549 carried dependence between ``m1`` and ``m2`` for loops in both ``L1`` and
   4550 ``L2``.
   4551 
   4552 As a special case, if all memory accessing instructions in a loop have
   4553 ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata that refers to that loop, then the
   4554 loop has no loop carried memory dependences and is considered to be a parallel
   4555 loop.
   4556 
   4557 Note that if not all memory access instructions have such metadata referring to
   4558 the loop, then the loop is considered not being trivially parallel. Additional
   4559 memory dependence analysis is required to make that determination. As a fail
   4560 safe mechanism, this causes loops that were originally parallel to be considered
   4561 sequential (if optimization passes that are unaware of the parallel semantics
   4562 insert new memory instructions into the loop body).
   4563 
   4564 Example of a loop that is considered parallel due to its correct use of
   4565 both ``llvm.loop`` and ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``
   4566 metadata types that refer to the same loop identifier metadata.
   4567 
   4568 .. code-block:: llvm
   4569 
   4570    for.body:
   4571      ...
   4572      %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
   4573      ...
   4574      store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
   4575      ...
   4576      br i1 %exitcond, label %for.end, label %for.body, !llvm.loop !0
   4577 
   4578    for.end:
   4579    ...
   4580    !0 = !{!0}
   4581 
   4582 It is also possible to have nested parallel loops. In that case the
   4583 memory accesses refer to a list of loop identifier metadata nodes instead of
   4584 the loop identifier metadata node directly:
   4585 
   4586 .. code-block:: llvm
   4587 
   4588    outer.for.body:
   4589      ...
   4590      %val1 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx3, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
   4591      ...
   4592      br label %inner.for.body
   4593 
   4594    inner.for.body:
   4595      ...
   4596      %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
   4597      ...
   4598      store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx2, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
   4599      ...
   4600      br i1 %exitcond, label %inner.for.end, label %inner.for.body, !llvm.loop !1
   4601 
   4602    inner.for.end:
   4603      ...
   4604      store i32 %val1, i32* %arrayidx4, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
   4605      ...
   4606      br i1 %exitcond, label %outer.for.end, label %outer.for.body, !llvm.loop !2
   4607 
   4608    outer.for.end:                                          ; preds = %for.body
   4609    ...
   4610    !0 = !{!1, !2} ; a list of loop identifiers
   4611    !1 = !{!1} ; an identifier for the inner loop
   4612    !2 = !{!2} ; an identifier for the outer loop
   4613 
   4614 '``llvm.bitsets``'
   4615 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4616 
   4617 The ``llvm.bitsets`` global metadata is used to implement
   4618 :doc:`bitsets <BitSets>`.
   4619 
   4620 '``invariant.group``' Metadata
   4621 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   4622 
   4623 The ``invariant.group`` metadata may be attached to ``load``/``store`` instructions.
   4624 The existence of the ``invariant.group`` metadata on the instruction tells 
   4625 the optimizer that every ``load`` and ``store`` to the same pointer operand 
   4626 within the same invariant group can be assumed to load or store the same  
   4627 value (but see the ``llvm.invariant.group.barrier`` intrinsic which affects 
   4628 when two pointers are considered the same).
   4629 
   4630 Examples:
   4631 
   4632 .. code-block:: llvm
   4633 
   4634    @unknownPtr = external global i8
   4635    ...
   4636    %ptr = alloca i8
   4637    store i8 42, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0
   4638    call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
   4639    
   4640    %a = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that value under %ptr didn't change
   4641    call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
   4642    %b = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !1 ; Can't assume anything, because group changed
   4643   
   4644    %newPtr = call i8* @getPointer(i8* %ptr) 
   4645    %c = load i8, i8* %newPtr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't assume anything, because we only have information about %ptr
   4646    
   4647    %unknownValue = load i8, i8* @unknownPtr
   4648    store i8 %unknownValue, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that %unknownValue == 42
   4649    
   4650    call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
   4651    %newPtr2 = call i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8* %ptr)
   4652    %d = load i8, i8* %newPtr2, !invariant.group !0  ; Can't step through invariant.group.barrier to get value of %ptr
   4653    
   4654    ...
   4655    declare void @foo(i8*)
   4656    declare i8* @getPointer(i8*)
   4657    declare i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8*)
   4658    
   4659    !0 = !{!"magic ptr"}
   4660    !1 = !{!"other ptr"}
   4661 
   4662 
   4663 
   4664 Module Flags Metadata
   4665 =====================
   4666 
   4667 Information about the module as a whole is difficult to convey to LLVM's
   4668 subsystems. The LLVM IR isn't sufficient to transmit this information.
   4669 The ``llvm.module.flags`` named metadata exists in order to facilitate
   4670 this. These flags are in the form of key / value pairs --- much like a
   4671 dictionary --- making it easy for any subsystem who cares about a flag to
   4672 look it up.
   4673 
   4674 The ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata contains a list of metadata triplets.
   4675 Each triplet has the following form:
   4676 
   4677 -  The first element is a *behavior* flag, which specifies the behavior
   4678    when two (or more) modules are merged together, and it encounters two
   4679    (or more) metadata with the same ID. The supported behaviors are
   4680    described below.
   4681 -  The second element is a metadata string that is a unique ID for the
   4682    metadata. Each module may only have one flag entry for each unique ID (not
   4683    including entries with the **Require** behavior).
   4684 -  The third element is the value of the flag.
   4685 
   4686 When two (or more) modules are merged together, the resulting
   4687 ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata is the union of the modules' flags. That is, for
   4688 each unique metadata ID string, there will be exactly one entry in the merged
   4689 modules ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata table, and the value for that entry will
   4690 be determined by the merge behavior flag, as described below. The only exception
   4691 is that entries with the *Require* behavior are always preserved.
   4692 
   4693 The following behaviors are supported:
   4694 
   4695 .. list-table::
   4696    :header-rows: 1
   4697    :widths: 10 90
   4698 
   4699    * - Value
   4700      - Behavior
   4701 
   4702    * - 1
   4703      - **Error**
   4704            Emits an error if two values disagree, otherwise the resulting value
   4705            is that of the operands.
   4706 
   4707    * - 2
   4708      - **Warning**
   4709            Emits a warning if two values disagree. The result value will be the
   4710            operand for the flag from the first module being linked.
   4711 
   4712    * - 3
   4713      - **Require**
   4714            Adds a requirement that another module flag be present and have a
   4715            specified value after linking is performed. The value must be a
   4716            metadata pair, where the first element of the pair is the ID of the
   4717            module flag to be restricted, and the second element of the pair is
   4718            the value the module flag should be restricted to. This behavior can
   4719            be used to restrict the allowable results (via triggering of an
   4720            error) of linking IDs with the **Override** behavior.
   4721 
   4722    * - 4
   4723      - **Override**
   4724            Uses the specified value, regardless of the behavior or value of the
   4725            other module. If both modules specify **Override**, but the values
   4726            differ, an error will be emitted.
   4727 
   4728    * - 5
   4729      - **Append**
   4730            Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata nodes.
   4731 
   4732    * - 6
   4733      - **AppendUnique**
   4734            Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata
   4735            nodes. However, duplicate entries in the second list are dropped
   4736            during the append operation.
   4737 
   4738 It is an error for a particular unique flag ID to have multiple behaviors,
   4739 except in the case of **Require** (which adds restrictions on another metadata
   4740 value) or **Override**.
   4741 
   4742 An example of module flags:
   4743 
   4744 .. code-block:: llvm
   4745 
   4746     !0 = !{ i32 1, !"foo", i32 1 }
   4747     !1 = !{ i32 4, !"bar", i32 37 }
   4748     !2 = !{ i32 2, !"qux", i32 42 }
   4749     !3 = !{ i32 3, !"qux",
   4750       !{
   4751         !"foo", i32 1
   4752       }
   4753     }
   4754     !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0, !1, !2, !3 }
   4755 
   4756 -  Metadata ``!0`` has the ID ``!"foo"`` and the value '1'. The behavior
   4757    if two or more ``!"foo"`` flags are seen is to emit an error if their
   4758    values are not equal.
   4759 
   4760 -  Metadata ``!1`` has the ID ``!"bar"`` and the value '37'. The
   4761    behavior if two or more ``!"bar"`` flags are seen is to use the value
   4762    '37'.
   4763 
   4764 -  Metadata ``!2`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value '42'. The
   4765    behavior if two or more ``!"qux"`` flags are seen is to emit a
   4766    warning if their values are not equal.
   4767 
   4768 -  Metadata ``!3`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value:
   4769 
   4770    ::
   4771 
   4772        !{ !"foo", i32 1 }
   4773 
   4774    The behavior is to emit an error if the ``llvm.module.flags`` does not
   4775    contain a flag with the ID ``!"foo"`` that has the value '1' after linking is
   4776    performed.
   4777 
   4778 Objective-C Garbage Collection Module Flags Metadata
   4779 ----------------------------------------------------
   4780 
   4781 On the Mach-O platform, Objective-C stores metadata about garbage
   4782 collection in a special section called "image info". The metadata
   4783 consists of a version number and a bitmask specifying what types of
   4784 garbage collection are supported (if any) by the file. If two or more
   4785 modules are linked together their garbage collection metadata needs to
   4786 be merged rather than appended together.
   4787 
   4788 The Objective-C garbage collection module flags metadata consists of the
   4789 following key-value pairs:
   4790 
   4791 .. list-table::
   4792    :header-rows: 1
   4793    :widths: 30 70
   4794 
   4795    * - Key
   4796      - Value
   4797 
   4798    * - ``Objective-C Version``
   4799      - **[Required]** --- The Objective-C ABI version. Valid values are 1 and 2.
   4800 
   4801    * - ``Objective-C Image Info Version``
   4802      - **[Required]** --- The version of the image info section. Currently
   4803        always 0.
   4804 
   4805    * - ``Objective-C Image Info Section``
   4806      - **[Required]** --- The section to place the metadata. Valid values are
   4807        ``"__OBJC, __image_info, regular"`` for Objective-C ABI version 1, and
   4808        ``"__DATA,__objc_imageinfo, regular, no_dead_strip"`` for
   4809        Objective-C ABI version 2.
   4810 
   4811    * - ``Objective-C Garbage Collection``
   4812      - **[Required]** --- Specifies whether garbage collection is supported or
   4813        not. Valid values are 0, for no garbage collection, and 2, for garbage
   4814        collection supported.
   4815 
   4816    * - ``Objective-C GC Only``
   4817      - **[Optional]** --- Specifies that only garbage collection is supported.
   4818        If present, its value must be 6. This flag requires that the
   4819        ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag have the value 2.
   4820 
   4821 Some important flag interactions:
   4822 
   4823 -  If a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 is
   4824    merged with a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to
   4825    2, then the resulting module has the
   4826    ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag set to 0.
   4827 -  A module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 cannot be
   4828    merged with a module with ``Objective-C GC Only`` set to 6.
   4829 
   4830 Automatic Linker Flags Module Flags Metadata
   4831 --------------------------------------------
   4832 
   4833 Some targets support embedding flags to the linker inside individual object
   4834 files. Typically this is used in conjunction with language extensions which
   4835 allow source files to explicitly declare the libraries they depend on, and have
   4836 these automatically be transmitted to the linker via object files.
   4837 
   4838 These flags are encoded in the IR using metadata in the module flags section,
   4839 using the ``Linker Options`` key. The merge behavior for this flag is required
   4840 to be ``AppendUnique``, and the value for the key is expected to be a metadata
   4841 node which should be a list of other metadata nodes, each of which should be a
   4842 list of metadata strings defining linker options.
   4843 
   4844 For example, the following metadata section specifies two separate sets of
   4845 linker options, presumably to link against ``libz`` and the ``Cocoa``
   4846 framework::
   4847 
   4848     !0 = !{ i32 6, !"Linker Options",
   4849        !{
   4850           !{ !"-lz" },
   4851           !{ !"-framework", !"Cocoa" } } }
   4852     !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0 }
   4853 
   4854 The metadata encoding as lists of lists of options, as opposed to a collapsed
   4855 list of options, is chosen so that the IR encoding can use multiple option
   4856 strings to specify e.g., a single library, while still having that specifier be
   4857 preserved as an atomic element that can be recognized by a target specific
   4858 assembly writer or object file emitter.
   4859 
   4860 Each individual option is required to be either a valid option for the target's
   4861 linker, or an option that is reserved by the target specific assembly writer or
   4862 object file emitter. No other aspect of these options is defined by the IR.
   4863 
   4864 C type width Module Flags Metadata
   4865 ----------------------------------
   4866 
   4867 The ARM backend emits a section into each generated object file describing the
   4868 options that it was compiled with (in a compiler-independent way) to prevent
   4869 linking incompatible objects, and to allow automatic library selection. Some
   4870 of these options are not visible at the IR level, namely wchar_t width and enum
   4871 width.
   4872 
   4873 To pass this information to the backend, these options are encoded in module
   4874 flags metadata, using the following key-value pairs:
   4875 
   4876 .. list-table::
   4877    :header-rows: 1
   4878    :widths: 30 70
   4879 
   4880    * - Key
   4881      - Value
   4882 
   4883    * - short_wchar
   4884      - * 0 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 4
   4885        * 1 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 2
   4886 
   4887    * - short_enum
   4888      - * 0 --- Enums are at least as large as an ``int``.
   4889        * 1 --- Enums are stored in the smallest integer type which can
   4890          represent all of its values.
   4891 
   4892 For example, the following metadata section specifies that the module was
   4893 compiled with a ``wchar_t`` width of 4 bytes, and the underlying type of an
   4894 enum is the smallest type which can represent all of its values::
   4895 
   4896     !llvm.module.flags = !{!0, !1}
   4897     !0 = !{i32 1, !"short_wchar", i32 1}
   4898     !1 = !{i32 1, !"short_enum", i32 0}
   4899 
   4900 .. _intrinsicglobalvariables:
   4901 
   4902 Intrinsic Global Variables
   4903 ==========================
   4904 
   4905 LLVM has a number of "magic" global variables that contain data that
   4906 affect code generation or other IR semantics. These are documented here.
   4907 All globals of this sort should have a section specified as
   4908 "``llvm.metadata``". This section and all globals that start with
   4909 "``llvm.``" are reserved for use by LLVM.
   4910 
   4911 .. _gv_llvmused:
   4912 
   4913 The '``llvm.used``' Global Variable
   4914 -----------------------------------
   4915 
   4916 The ``@llvm.used`` global is an array which has
   4917 :ref:`appending linkage <linkage_appending>`. This array contains a list of
   4918 pointers to named global variables, functions and aliases which may optionally
   4919 have a pointer cast formed of bitcast or getelementptr. For example, a legal
   4920 use of it is:
   4921 
   4922 .. code-block:: llvm
   4923 
   4924     @X = global i8 4
   4925     @Y = global i32 123
   4926 
   4927     @llvm.used = appending global [2 x i8*] [
   4928        i8* @X,
   4929        i8* bitcast (i32* @Y to i8*)
   4930     ], section "llvm.metadata"
   4931 
   4932 If a symbol appears in the ``@llvm.used`` list, then the compiler, assembler,
   4933 and linker are required to treat the symbol as if there is a reference to the
   4934 symbol that it cannot see (which is why they have to be named). For example, if
   4935 a variable has internal linkage and no references other than that from the
   4936 ``@llvm.used`` list, it cannot be deleted. This is commonly used to represent
   4937 references from inline asms and other things the compiler cannot "see", and
   4938 corresponds to "``attribute((used))``" in GNU C.
   4939 
   4940 On some targets, the code generator must emit a directive to the
   4941 assembler or object file to prevent the assembler and linker from
   4942 molesting the symbol.
   4943 
   4944 .. _gv_llvmcompilerused:
   4945 
   4946 The '``llvm.compiler.used``' Global Variable
   4947 --------------------------------------------
   4948 
   4949 The ``@llvm.compiler.used`` directive is the same as the ``@llvm.used``
   4950 directive, except that it only prevents the compiler from touching the
   4951 symbol. On targets that support it, this allows an intelligent linker to
   4952 optimize references to the symbol without being impeded as it would be
   4953 by ``@llvm.used``.
   4954 
   4955 This is a rare construct that should only be used in rare circumstances,
   4956 and should not be exposed to source languages.
   4957 
   4958 .. _gv_llvmglobalctors:
   4959 
   4960 The '``llvm.global_ctors``' Global Variable
   4961 -------------------------------------------
   4962 
   4963 .. code-block:: llvm
   4964 
   4965     %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
   4966     @llvm.global_ctors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @ctor, i8* @data }]
   4967 
   4968 The ``@llvm.global_ctors`` array contains a list of constructor
   4969 functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
   4970 The functions referenced by this array will be called in ascending order
   4971 of priority (i.e. lowest first) when the module is loaded. The order of
   4972 functions with the same priority is not defined.
   4973 
   4974 If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
   4975 or function, the initializer function will only run if the associated
   4976 data from the current module is not discarded.
   4977 
   4978 .. _llvmglobaldtors:
   4979 
   4980 The '``llvm.global_dtors``' Global Variable
   4981 -------------------------------------------
   4982 
   4983 .. code-block:: llvm
   4984 
   4985     %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
   4986     @llvm.global_dtors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @dtor, i8* @data }]
   4987 
   4988 The ``@llvm.global_dtors`` array contains a list of destructor
   4989 functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
   4990 The functions referenced by this array will be called in descending
   4991 order of priority (i.e. highest first) when the module is unloaded. The
   4992 order of functions with the same priority is not defined.
   4993 
   4994 If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
   4995 or function, the destructor function will only run if the associated
   4996 data from the current module is not discarded.
   4997 
   4998 Instruction Reference
   4999 =====================
   5000 
   5001 The LLVM instruction set consists of several different classifications
   5002 of instructions: :ref:`terminator instructions <terminators>`, :ref:`binary
   5003 instructions <binaryops>`, :ref:`bitwise binary
   5004 instructions <bitwiseops>`, :ref:`memory instructions <memoryops>`, and
   5005 :ref:`other instructions <otherops>`.
   5006 
   5007 .. _terminators:
   5008 
   5009 Terminator Instructions
   5010 -----------------------
   5011 
   5012 As mentioned :ref:`previously <functionstructure>`, every basic block in a
   5013 program ends with a "Terminator" instruction, which indicates which
   5014 block should be executed after the current block is finished. These
   5015 terminator instructions typically yield a '``void``' value: they produce
   5016 control flow, not values (the one exception being the
   5017 ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`' instruction).
   5018 
   5019 The terminator instructions are: ':ref:`ret <i_ret>`',
   5020 ':ref:`br <i_br>`', ':ref:`switch <i_switch>`',
   5021 ':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`', ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`',
   5022 ':ref:`resume <i_resume>`', ':ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>`',
   5023 ':ref:`catchret <i_catchret>`',
   5024 ':ref:`cleanupret <i_cleanupret>`',
   5025 and ':ref:`unreachable <i_unreachable>`'.
   5026 
   5027 .. _i_ret:
   5028 
   5029 '``ret``' Instruction
   5030 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5031 
   5032 Syntax:
   5033 """""""
   5034 
   5035 ::
   5036 
   5037       ret <type> <value>       ; Return a value from a non-void function
   5038       ret void                 ; Return from void function
   5039 
   5040 Overview:
   5041 """""""""
   5042 
   5043 The '``ret``' instruction is used to return control flow (and optionally
   5044 a value) from a function back to the caller.
   5045 
   5046 There are two forms of the '``ret``' instruction: one that returns a
   5047 value and then causes control flow, and one that just causes control
   5048 flow to occur.
   5049 
   5050 Arguments:
   5051 """"""""""
   5052 
   5053 The '``ret``' instruction optionally accepts a single argument, the
   5054 return value. The type of the return value must be a ':ref:`first
   5055 class <t_firstclass>`' type.
   5056 
   5057 A function is not :ref:`well formed <wellformed>` if it it has a non-void
   5058 return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with no return value or
   5059 a return value with a type that does not match its type, or if it has a
   5060 void return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with a return
   5061 value.
   5062 
   5063 Semantics:
   5064 """"""""""
   5065 
   5066 When the '``ret``' instruction is executed, control flow returns back to
   5067 the calling function's context. If the caller is a
   5068 ":ref:`call <i_call>`" instruction, execution continues at the
   5069 instruction after the call. If the caller was an
   5070 ":ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`" instruction, execution continues at the
   5071 beginning of the "normal" destination block. If the instruction returns
   5072 a value, that value shall set the call or invoke instruction's return
   5073 value.
   5074 
   5075 Example:
   5076 """"""""
   5077 
   5078 .. code-block:: llvm
   5079 
   5080       ret i32 5                       ; Return an integer value of 5
   5081       ret void                        ; Return from a void function
   5082       ret { i32, i8 } { i32 4, i8 2 } ; Return a struct of values 4 and 2
   5083 
   5084 .. _i_br:
   5085 
   5086 '``br``' Instruction
   5087 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5088 
   5089 Syntax:
   5090 """""""
   5091 
   5092 ::
   5093 
   5094       br i1 <cond>, label <iftrue>, label <iffalse>
   5095       br label <dest>          ; Unconditional branch
   5096 
   5097 Overview:
   5098 """""""""
   5099 
   5100 The '``br``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to a
   5101 different basic block in the current function. There are two forms of
   5102 this instruction, corresponding to a conditional branch and an
   5103 unconditional branch.
   5104 
   5105 Arguments:
   5106 """"""""""
   5107 
   5108 The conditional branch form of the '``br``' instruction takes a single
   5109 '``i1``' value and two '``label``' values. The unconditional form of the
   5110 '``br``' instruction takes a single '``label``' value as a target.
   5111 
   5112 Semantics:
   5113 """"""""""
   5114 
   5115 Upon execution of a conditional '``br``' instruction, the '``i1``'
   5116 argument is evaluated. If the value is ``true``, control flows to the
   5117 '``iftrue``' ``label`` argument. If "cond" is ``false``, control flows
   5118 to the '``iffalse``' ``label`` argument.
   5119 
   5120 Example:
   5121 """"""""
   5122 
   5123 .. code-block:: llvm
   5124 
   5125     Test:
   5126       %cond = icmp eq i32 %a, %b
   5127       br i1 %cond, label %IfEqual, label %IfUnequal
   5128     IfEqual:
   5129       ret i32 1
   5130     IfUnequal:
   5131       ret i32 0
   5132 
   5133 .. _i_switch:
   5134 
   5135 '``switch``' Instruction
   5136 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5137 
   5138 Syntax:
   5139 """""""
   5140 
   5141 ::
   5142 
   5143       switch <intty> <value>, label <defaultdest> [ <intty> <val>, label <dest> ... ]
   5144 
   5145 Overview:
   5146 """""""""
   5147 
   5148 The '``switch``' instruction is used to transfer control flow to one of
   5149 several different places. It is a generalization of the '``br``'
   5150 instruction, allowing a branch to occur to one of many possible
   5151 destinations.
   5152 
   5153 Arguments:
   5154 """"""""""
   5155 
   5156 The '``switch``' instruction uses three parameters: an integer
   5157 comparison value '``value``', a default '``label``' destination, and an
   5158 array of pairs of comparison value constants and '``label``'s. The table
   5159 is not allowed to contain duplicate constant entries.
   5160 
   5161 Semantics:
   5162 """"""""""
   5163 
   5164 The ``switch`` instruction specifies a table of values and destinations.
   5165 When the '``switch``' instruction is executed, this table is searched
   5166 for the given value. If the value is found, control flow is transferred
   5167 to the corresponding destination; otherwise, control flow is transferred
   5168 to the default destination.
   5169 
   5170 Implementation:
   5171 """""""""""""""
   5172 
   5173 Depending on properties of the target machine and the particular
   5174 ``switch`` instruction, this instruction may be code generated in
   5175 different ways. For example, it could be generated as a series of
   5176 chained conditional branches or with a lookup table.
   5177 
   5178 Example:
   5179 """"""""
   5180 
   5181 .. code-block:: llvm
   5182 
   5183      ; Emulate a conditional br instruction
   5184      %Val = zext i1 %value to i32
   5185      switch i32 %Val, label %truedest [ i32 0, label %falsedest ]
   5186 
   5187      ; Emulate an unconditional br instruction
   5188      switch i32 0, label %dest [ ]
   5189 
   5190      ; Implement a jump table:
   5191      switch i32 %val, label %otherwise [ i32 0, label %onzero
   5192                                          i32 1, label %onone
   5193                                          i32 2, label %ontwo ]
   5194 
   5195 .. _i_indirectbr:
   5196 
   5197 '``indirectbr``' Instruction
   5198 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5199 
   5200 Syntax:
   5201 """""""
   5202 
   5203 ::
   5204 
   5205       indirectbr <somety>* <address>, [ label <dest1>, label <dest2>, ... ]
   5206 
   5207 Overview:
   5208 """""""""
   5209 
   5210 The '``indirectbr``' instruction implements an indirect branch to a
   5211 label within the current function, whose address is specified by
   5212 "``address``". Address must be derived from a
   5213 :ref:`blockaddress <blockaddress>` constant.
   5214 
   5215 Arguments:
   5216 """"""""""
   5217 
   5218 The '``address``' argument is the address of the label to jump to. The
   5219 rest of the arguments indicate the full set of possible destinations
   5220 that the address may point to. Blocks are allowed to occur multiple
   5221 times in the destination list, though this isn't particularly useful.
   5222 
   5223 This destination list is required so that dataflow analysis has an
   5224 accurate understanding of the CFG.
   5225 
   5226 Semantics:
   5227 """"""""""
   5228 
   5229 Control transfers to the block specified in the address argument. All
   5230 possible destination blocks must be listed in the label list, otherwise
   5231 this instruction has undefined behavior. This implies that jumps to
   5232 labels defined in other functions have undefined behavior as well.
   5233 
   5234 Implementation:
   5235 """""""""""""""
   5236 
   5237 This is typically implemented with a jump through a register.
   5238 
   5239 Example:
   5240 """"""""
   5241 
   5242 .. code-block:: llvm
   5243 
   5244      indirectbr i8* %Addr, [ label %bb1, label %bb2, label %bb3 ]
   5245 
   5246 .. _i_invoke:
   5247 
   5248 '``invoke``' Instruction
   5249 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5250 
   5251 Syntax:
   5252 """""""
   5253 
   5254 ::
   5255 
   5256       <result> = invoke [cconv] [ret attrs] <ptr to function ty> <function ptr val>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
   5257                     [operand bundles] to label <normal label> unwind label <exception label>
   5258 
   5259 Overview:
   5260 """""""""
   5261 
   5262 The '``invoke``' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
   5263 function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
   5264 '``normal``' label or the '``exception``' label. If the callee function
   5265 returns with the "``ret``" instruction, control flow will return to the
   5266 "normal" label. If the callee (or any indirect callees) returns via the
   5267 ":ref:`resume <i_resume>`" instruction or other exception handling
   5268 mechanism, control is interrupted and continued at the dynamically
   5269 nearest "exception" label.
   5270 
   5271 The '``exception``' label is a `landing
   5272 pad <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ for the exception. As such,
   5273 '``exception``' label is required to have the
   5274 ":ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>`" instruction, which contains the
   5275 information about the behavior of the program after unwinding happens,
   5276 as its first non-PHI instruction. The restrictions on the
   5277 "``landingpad``" instruction's tightly couples it to the "``invoke``"
   5278 instruction, so that the important information contained within the
   5279 "``landingpad``" instruction can't be lost through normal code motion.
   5280 
   5281 Arguments:
   5282 """"""""""
   5283 
   5284 This instruction requires several arguments:
   5285 
   5286 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
   5287    convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
   5288    specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions.
   5289 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
   5290    values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
   5291    are valid here.
   5292 #. '``ptr to function ty``': shall be the signature of the pointer to
   5293    function value being invoked. In most cases, this is a direct
   5294    function invocation, but indirect ``invoke``'s are just as possible,
   5295    branching off an arbitrary pointer to function value.
   5296 #. '``function ptr val``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a
   5297    function to be invoked.
   5298 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
   5299    signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
   5300    be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
   5301    indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
   5302    extra arguments can be specified.
   5303 #. '``normal label``': the label reached when the called function
   5304    executes a '``ret``' instruction.
   5305 #. '``exception label``': the label reached when a callee returns via
   5306    the :ref:`resume <i_resume>` instruction or other exception handling
   5307    mechanism.
   5308 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list. Only
   5309    '``noreturn``', '``nounwind``', '``readonly``' and '``readnone``'
   5310    attributes are valid here.
   5311 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
   5312 
   5313 Semantics:
   5314 """"""""""
   5315 
   5316 This instruction is designed to operate as a standard '``call``'
   5317 instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it
   5318 establishes an association with a label, which is used by the runtime
   5319 library to unwind the stack.
   5320 
   5321 This instruction is used in languages with destructors to ensure that
   5322 proper cleanup is performed in the case of either a ``longjmp`` or a
   5323 thrown exception. Additionally, this is important for implementation of
   5324 '``catch``' clauses in high-level languages that support them.
   5325 
   5326 For the purposes of the SSA form, the definition of the value returned
   5327 by the '``invoke``' instruction is deemed to occur on the edge from the
   5328 current block to the "normal" label. If the callee unwinds then no
   5329 return value is available.
   5330 
   5331 Example:
   5332 """"""""
   5333 
   5334 .. code-block:: llvm
   5335 
   5336       %retval = invoke i32 @Test(i32 15) to label %Continue
   5337                   unwind label %TestCleanup              ; i32:retval set
   5338       %retval = invoke coldcc i32 %Testfnptr(i32 15) to label %Continue
   5339                   unwind label %TestCleanup              ; i32:retval set
   5340 
   5341 .. _i_resume:
   5342 
   5343 '``resume``' Instruction
   5344 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5345 
   5346 Syntax:
   5347 """""""
   5348 
   5349 ::
   5350 
   5351       resume <type> <value>
   5352 
   5353 Overview:
   5354 """""""""
   5355 
   5356 The '``resume``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has no
   5357 successors.
   5358 
   5359 Arguments:
   5360 """"""""""
   5361 
   5362 The '``resume``' instruction requires one argument, which must have the
   5363 same type as the result of any '``landingpad``' instruction in the same
   5364 function.
   5365 
   5366 Semantics:
   5367 """"""""""
   5368 
   5369 The '``resume``' instruction resumes propagation of an existing
   5370 (in-flight) exception whose unwinding was interrupted with a
   5371 :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction.
   5372 
   5373 Example:
   5374 """"""""
   5375 
   5376 .. code-block:: llvm
   5377 
   5378       resume { i8*, i32 } %exn
   5379 
   5380 .. _i_catchswitch:
   5381 
   5382 '``catchswitch``' Instruction
   5383 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5384 
   5385 Syntax:
   5386 """""""
   5387 
   5388 ::
   5389 
   5390       <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind to caller
   5391       <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind label <default>
   5392 
   5393 Overview:
   5394 """""""""
   5395 
   5396 The '``catchswitch``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling system
   5397 <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to describe the set of possible catch handlers
   5398 that may be executed by the :ref:`EH personality routine <personalityfn>`.
   5399 
   5400 Arguments:
   5401 """"""""""
   5402 
   5403 The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
   5404 ``catchswitch`` instruction. If the ``catchswitch`` is not inside a funclet,
   5405 this operand may be the token ``none``.
   5406 
   5407 The ``default`` argument is the label of another basic block beginning with a
   5408 "pad" instruction, one of ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch``.
   5409 
   5410 The ``handlers`` are a list of successor blocks that each begin with a
   5411 :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction.
   5412 
   5413 Semantics:
   5414 """"""""""
   5415 
   5416 Executing this instruction transfers control to one of the successors in
   5417 ``handlers``, if appropriate, or continues to unwind via the unwind label if
   5418 present.
   5419 
   5420 The ``catchswitch`` is both a terminator and a "pad" instruction, meaning that
   5421 it must be both the first non-phi instruction and last instruction in the basic
   5422 block. Therefore, it must be the only non-phi instruction in the block.
   5423 
   5424 Example:
   5425 """"""""
   5426 
   5427 .. code-block:: llvm
   5428 
   5429     dispatch1:
   5430       %cs1 = catchswitch within none [label %handler0, label %handler1] unwind to caller
   5431     dispatch2:
   5432       %cs2 = catchswitch within %parenthandler [label %handler0] unwind label %cleanup
   5433 
   5434 .. _i_catchpad:
   5435 
   5436 '``catchpad``' Instruction
   5437 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5438 
   5439 Syntax:
   5440 """""""
   5441 
   5442 ::
   5443 
   5444       <resultval> = catchpad within <catchswitch> [<args>*]
   5445 
   5446 Overview:
   5447 """""""""
   5448 
   5449 The '``catchpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
   5450 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
   5451 begins a catch handler --- one where a personality routine attempts to transfer
   5452 control to catch an exception.
   5453 
   5454 Arguments:
   5455 """"""""""
   5456 
   5457 The ``catchswitch`` operand must always be a token produced by a
   5458 :ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>` instruction in a predecessor block. This
   5459 ensures that each ``catchpad`` has exactly one predecessor block, and it always
   5460 terminates in a ``catchswitch``.
   5461 
   5462 The ``args`` correspond to whatever information the personality routine
   5463 requires to know if this is an appropriate handler for the exception. Control
   5464 will transfer to the ``catchpad`` if this is the first appropriate handler for
   5465 the exception.
   5466 
   5467 The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to match the
   5468 ``catchpad`` to corresponding :ref:`catchrets <i_catchret>` and other nested EH
   5469 pads.
   5470 
   5471 Semantics:
   5472 """"""""""
   5473 
   5474 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown, the
   5475 exception is compared against the ``args``. If it doesn't match, control will
   5476 not reach the ``catchpad`` instruction.  The representation of ``args`` is
   5477 entirely target and personality function-specific.
   5478 
   5479 Like the :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction, the ``catchpad``
   5480 instruction must be the first non-phi of its parent basic block.
   5481 
   5482 The meaning of the tokens produced and consumed by ``catchpad`` and other "pad"
   5483 instructions is described in the
   5484 `Windows exception handling documentation <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh>`.
   5485 
   5486 Executing a ``catchpad`` instruction constitutes "entering" that pad.
   5487 The pad may then be "exited" in one of three ways:
   5488 
   5489 1)  explicitly via a ``catchret`` that consumes it.  Executing such a ``catchret``
   5490     is undefined behavior if any descendant pads have been entered but not yet
   5491     exited.
   5492 2)  implicitly via a call (which unwinds all the way to the current function's caller),
   5493     or via a ``catchswitch`` or a ``cleanupret`` that unwinds to caller.
   5494 3)  implicitly via an unwind edge whose destination EH pad isn't a descendant of
   5495     the ``catchpad``.  When the ``catchpad`` is exited in this manner, it is
   5496     undefined behavior if the destination EH pad has a parent which is not an
   5497     ancestor of the ``catchpad`` being exited.
   5498 
   5499 Example:
   5500 """"""""
   5501 
   5502 .. code-block:: llvm
   5503 
   5504     dispatch:
   5505       %cs = catchswitch within none [label %handler0] unwind to caller
   5506       ;; A catch block which can catch an integer.
   5507     handler0:
   5508       %tok = catchpad within %cs [i8** @_ZTIi]
   5509 
   5510 .. _i_catchret:
   5511 
   5512 '``catchret``' Instruction
   5513 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5514 
   5515 Syntax:
   5516 """""""
   5517 
   5518 ::
   5519 
   5520       catchret from <token> to label <normal>
   5521 
   5522 Overview:
   5523 """""""""
   5524 
   5525 The '``catchret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has a
   5526 single successor.
   5527 
   5528 
   5529 Arguments:
   5530 """"""""""
   5531 
   5532 The first argument to a '``catchret``' indicates which ``catchpad`` it
   5533 exits.  It must be a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>`.
   5534 The second argument to a '``catchret``' specifies where control will
   5535 transfer to next.
   5536 
   5537 Semantics:
   5538 """"""""""
   5539 
   5540 The '``catchret``' instruction ends an existing (in-flight) exception whose
   5541 unwinding was interrupted with a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction.  The
   5542 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` gets a chance to execute arbitrary
   5543 code to, for example, destroy the active exception.  Control then transfers to
   5544 ``normal``.
   5545 
   5546 The ``token`` argument must be a token produced by a dominating ``catchpad``
   5547 instruction. The ``catchret`` destroys the physical frame established by
   5548 ``catchpad``, so executing multiple returns on the same token without
   5549 re-executing the ``catchpad`` will result in undefined behavior.
   5550 See :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` for more details.
   5551 
   5552 Example:
   5553 """"""""
   5554 
   5555 .. code-block:: llvm
   5556 
   5557       catchret from %catch label %continue
   5558 
   5559 .. _i_cleanupret:
   5560 
   5561 '``cleanupret``' Instruction
   5562 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5563 
   5564 Syntax:
   5565 """""""
   5566 
   5567 ::
   5568 
   5569       cleanupret from <value> unwind label <continue>
   5570       cleanupret from <value> unwind to caller
   5571 
   5572 Overview:
   5573 """""""""
   5574 
   5575 The '``cleanupret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has
   5576 an optional successor.
   5577 
   5578 
   5579 Arguments:
   5580 """"""""""
   5581 
   5582 The '``cleanupret``' instruction requires one argument, which indicates
   5583 which ``cleanuppad`` it exits, and must be a :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>`.
   5584 It also has an optional successor, ``continue``.
   5585 
   5586 Semantics:
   5587 """"""""""
   5588 
   5589 The '``cleanupret``' instruction indicates to the
   5590 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` that one
   5591 :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>` it transferred control to has ended.
   5592 It transfers control to ``continue`` or unwinds out of the function.
   5593 
   5594 The unwind destination ``continue``, if present, must be an EH pad
   5595 whose parent is either ``none`` or an ancestor of the ``cleanuppad``
   5596 being returned from.  This constitutes an exceptional exit from all
   5597 ancestors of the completed ``cleanuppad``, up to but not including
   5598 the parent of ``continue``.
   5599 See :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>` for more details.
   5600 
   5601 Example:
   5602 """"""""
   5603 
   5604 .. code-block:: llvm
   5605 
   5606       cleanupret from %cleanup unwind to caller
   5607       cleanupret from %cleanup unwind label %continue
   5608 
   5609 .. _i_unreachable:
   5610 
   5611 '``unreachable``' Instruction
   5612 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5613 
   5614 Syntax:
   5615 """""""
   5616 
   5617 ::
   5618 
   5619       unreachable
   5620 
   5621 Overview:
   5622 """""""""
   5623 
   5624 The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics. This
   5625 instruction is used to inform the optimizer that a particular portion of
   5626 the code is not reachable. This can be used to indicate that the code
   5627 after a no-return function cannot be reached, and other facts.
   5628 
   5629 Semantics:
   5630 """"""""""
   5631 
   5632 The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics.
   5633 
   5634 .. _binaryops:
   5635 
   5636 Binary Operations
   5637 -----------------
   5638 
   5639 Binary operators are used to do most of the computation in a program.
   5640 They require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on
   5641 them, and produce a single value. The operands might represent multiple
   5642 data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The
   5643 result value has the same type as its operands.
   5644 
   5645 There are several different binary operators:
   5646 
   5647 .. _i_add:
   5648 
   5649 '``add``' Instruction
   5650 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5651 
   5652 Syntax:
   5653 """""""
   5654 
   5655 ::
   5656 
   5657       <result> = add <ty> <op1>, <op2>          ; yields ty:result
   5658       <result> = add nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2>      ; yields ty:result
   5659       <result> = add nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2>      ; yields ty:result
   5660       <result> = add nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2>  ; yields ty:result
   5661 
   5662 Overview:
   5663 """""""""
   5664 
   5665 The '``add``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
   5666 
   5667 Arguments:
   5668 """"""""""
   5669 
   5670 The two arguments to the '``add``' instruction must be
   5671 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
   5672 arguments must have identical types.
   5673 
   5674 Semantics:
   5675 """"""""""
   5676 
   5677 The value produced is the integer sum of the two operands.
   5678 
   5679 If the sum has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
   5680 mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
   5681 the result.
   5682 
   5683 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
   5684 instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
   5685 
   5686 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
   5687 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
   5688 result value of the ``add`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
   5689 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
   5690 
   5691 Example:
   5692 """"""""
   5693 
   5694 .. code-block:: llvm
   5695 
   5696       <result> = add i32 4, %var          ; yields i32:result = 4 + %var
   5697 
   5698 .. _i_fadd:
   5699 
   5700 '``fadd``' Instruction
   5701 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5702 
   5703 Syntax:
   5704 """""""
   5705 
   5706 ::
   5707 
   5708       <result> = fadd [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   5709 
   5710 Overview:
   5711 """""""""
   5712 
   5713 The '``fadd``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
   5714 
   5715 Arguments:
   5716 """"""""""
   5717 
   5718 The two arguments to the '``fadd``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
   5719 point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
   5720 Both arguments must have identical types.
   5721 
   5722 Semantics:
   5723 """"""""""
   5724 
   5725 The value produced is the floating point sum of the two operands. This
   5726 instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`,
   5727 which are optimization hints to enable otherwise unsafe floating point
   5728 optimizations:
   5729 
   5730 Example:
   5731 """"""""
   5732 
   5733 .. code-block:: llvm
   5734 
   5735       <result> = fadd float 4.0, %var          ; yields float:result = 4.0 + %var
   5736 
   5737 '``sub``' Instruction
   5738 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5739 
   5740 Syntax:
   5741 """""""
   5742 
   5743 ::
   5744 
   5745       <result> = sub <ty> <op1>, <op2>          ; yields ty:result
   5746       <result> = sub nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2>      ; yields ty:result
   5747       <result> = sub nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2>      ; yields ty:result
   5748       <result> = sub nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2>  ; yields ty:result
   5749 
   5750 Overview:
   5751 """""""""
   5752 
   5753 The '``sub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
   5754 
   5755 Note that the '``sub``' instruction is used to represent the '``neg``'
   5756 instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
   5757 
   5758 Arguments:
   5759 """"""""""
   5760 
   5761 The two arguments to the '``sub``' instruction must be
   5762 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
   5763 arguments must have identical types.
   5764 
   5765 Semantics:
   5766 """"""""""
   5767 
   5768 The value produced is the integer difference of the two operands.
   5769 
   5770 If the difference has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
   5771 mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
   5772 the result.
   5773 
   5774 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
   5775 instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
   5776 
   5777 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
   5778 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
   5779 result value of the ``sub`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
   5780 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
   5781 
   5782 Example:
   5783 """"""""
   5784 
   5785 .. code-block:: llvm
   5786 
   5787       <result> = sub i32 4, %var          ; yields i32:result = 4 - %var
   5788       <result> = sub i32 0, %val          ; yields i32:result = -%var
   5789 
   5790 .. _i_fsub:
   5791 
   5792 '``fsub``' Instruction
   5793 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5794 
   5795 Syntax:
   5796 """""""
   5797 
   5798 ::
   5799 
   5800       <result> = fsub [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   5801 
   5802 Overview:
   5803 """""""""
   5804 
   5805 The '``fsub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
   5806 
   5807 Note that the '``fsub``' instruction is used to represent the '``fneg``'
   5808 instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
   5809 
   5810 Arguments:
   5811 """"""""""
   5812 
   5813 The two arguments to the '``fsub``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
   5814 point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
   5815 Both arguments must have identical types.
   5816 
   5817 Semantics:
   5818 """"""""""
   5819 
   5820 The value produced is the floating point difference of the two operands.
   5821 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
   5822 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
   5823 unsafe floating point optimizations:
   5824 
   5825 Example:
   5826 """"""""
   5827 
   5828 .. code-block:: llvm
   5829 
   5830       <result> = fsub float 4.0, %var           ; yields float:result = 4.0 - %var
   5831       <result> = fsub float -0.0, %val          ; yields float:result = -%var
   5832 
   5833 '``mul``' Instruction
   5834 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5835 
   5836 Syntax:
   5837 """""""
   5838 
   5839 ::
   5840 
   5841       <result> = mul <ty> <op1>, <op2>          ; yields ty:result
   5842       <result> = mul nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2>      ; yields ty:result
   5843       <result> = mul nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2>      ; yields ty:result
   5844       <result> = mul nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2>  ; yields ty:result
   5845 
   5846 Overview:
   5847 """""""""
   5848 
   5849 The '``mul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
   5850 
   5851 Arguments:
   5852 """"""""""
   5853 
   5854 The two arguments to the '``mul``' instruction must be
   5855 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
   5856 arguments must have identical types.
   5857 
   5858 Semantics:
   5859 """"""""""
   5860 
   5861 The value produced is the integer product of the two operands.
   5862 
   5863 If the result of the multiplication has unsigned overflow, the result
   5864 returned is the mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the
   5865 bit width of the result.
   5866 
   5867 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, and the
   5868 result is the same width as the operands, this instruction returns the
   5869 correct result for both signed and unsigned integers. If a full product
   5870 (e.g. ``i32`` * ``i32`` -> ``i64``) is needed, the operands should be
   5871 sign-extended or zero-extended as appropriate to the width of the full
   5872 product.
   5873 
   5874 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
   5875 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
   5876 result value of the ``mul`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
   5877 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
   5878 
   5879 Example:
   5880 """"""""
   5881 
   5882 .. code-block:: llvm
   5883 
   5884       <result> = mul i32 4, %var          ; yields i32:result = 4 * %var
   5885 
   5886 .. _i_fmul:
   5887 
   5888 '``fmul``' Instruction
   5889 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5890 
   5891 Syntax:
   5892 """""""
   5893 
   5894 ::
   5895 
   5896       <result> = fmul [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   5897 
   5898 Overview:
   5899 """""""""
   5900 
   5901 The '``fmul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
   5902 
   5903 Arguments:
   5904 """"""""""
   5905 
   5906 The two arguments to the '``fmul``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
   5907 point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
   5908 Both arguments must have identical types.
   5909 
   5910 Semantics:
   5911 """"""""""
   5912 
   5913 The value produced is the floating point product of the two operands.
   5914 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
   5915 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
   5916 unsafe floating point optimizations:
   5917 
   5918 Example:
   5919 """"""""
   5920 
   5921 .. code-block:: llvm
   5922 
   5923       <result> = fmul float 4.0, %var          ; yields float:result = 4.0 * %var
   5924 
   5925 '``udiv``' Instruction
   5926 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5927 
   5928 Syntax:
   5929 """""""
   5930 
   5931 ::
   5932 
   5933       <result> = udiv <ty> <op1>, <op2>         ; yields ty:result
   5934       <result> = udiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   5935 
   5936 Overview:
   5937 """""""""
   5938 
   5939 The '``udiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
   5940 
   5941 Arguments:
   5942 """"""""""
   5943 
   5944 The two arguments to the '``udiv``' instruction must be
   5945 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
   5946 arguments must have identical types.
   5947 
   5948 Semantics:
   5949 """"""""""
   5950 
   5951 The value produced is the unsigned integer quotient of the two operands.
   5952 
   5953 Note that unsigned integer division and signed integer division are
   5954 distinct operations; for signed integer division, use '``sdiv``'.
   5955 
   5956 Division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
   5957 
   5958 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``udiv`` is
   5959 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if %op1 is not a multiple of %op2 (as
   5960 such, "((a udiv exact b) mul b) == a").
   5961 
   5962 Example:
   5963 """"""""
   5964 
   5965 .. code-block:: llvm
   5966 
   5967       <result> = udiv i32 4, %var          ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
   5968 
   5969 '``sdiv``' Instruction
   5970 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   5971 
   5972 Syntax:
   5973 """""""
   5974 
   5975 ::
   5976 
   5977       <result> = sdiv <ty> <op1>, <op2>         ; yields ty:result
   5978       <result> = sdiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   5979 
   5980 Overview:
   5981 """""""""
   5982 
   5983 The '``sdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
   5984 
   5985 Arguments:
   5986 """"""""""
   5987 
   5988 The two arguments to the '``sdiv``' instruction must be
   5989 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
   5990 arguments must have identical types.
   5991 
   5992 Semantics:
   5993 """"""""""
   5994 
   5995 The value produced is the signed integer quotient of the two operands
   5996 rounded towards zero.
   5997 
   5998 Note that signed integer division and unsigned integer division are
   5999 distinct operations; for unsigned integer division, use '``udiv``'.
   6000 
   6001 Division by zero leads to undefined behavior. Overflow also leads to
   6002 undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can occur, for example, by
   6003 doing a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1.
   6004 
   6005 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``sdiv`` is
   6006 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the result would be rounded.
   6007 
   6008 Example:
   6009 """"""""
   6010 
   6011 .. code-block:: llvm
   6012 
   6013       <result> = sdiv i32 4, %var          ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
   6014 
   6015 .. _i_fdiv:
   6016 
   6017 '``fdiv``' Instruction
   6018 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6019 
   6020 Syntax:
   6021 """""""
   6022 
   6023 ::
   6024 
   6025       <result> = fdiv [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   6026 
   6027 Overview:
   6028 """""""""
   6029 
   6030 The '``fdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
   6031 
   6032 Arguments:
   6033 """"""""""
   6034 
   6035 The two arguments to the '``fdiv``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
   6036 point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
   6037 Both arguments must have identical types.
   6038 
   6039 Semantics:
   6040 """"""""""
   6041 
   6042 The value produced is the floating point quotient of the two operands.
   6043 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
   6044 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
   6045 unsafe floating point optimizations:
   6046 
   6047 Example:
   6048 """"""""
   6049 
   6050 .. code-block:: llvm
   6051 
   6052       <result> = fdiv float 4.0, %var          ; yields float:result = 4.0 / %var
   6053 
   6054 '``urem``' Instruction
   6055 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6056 
   6057 Syntax:
   6058 """""""
   6059 
   6060 ::
   6061 
   6062       <result> = urem <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   6063 
   6064 Overview:
   6065 """""""""
   6066 
   6067 The '``urem``' instruction returns the remainder from the unsigned
   6068 division of its two arguments.
   6069 
   6070 Arguments:
   6071 """"""""""
   6072 
   6073 The two arguments to the '``urem``' instruction must be
   6074 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
   6075 arguments must have identical types.
   6076 
   6077 Semantics:
   6078 """"""""""
   6079 
   6080 This instruction returns the unsigned integer *remainder* of a division.
   6081 This instruction always performs an unsigned division to get the
   6082 remainder.
   6083 
   6084 Note that unsigned integer remainder and signed integer remainder are
   6085 distinct operations; for signed integer remainder, use '``srem``'.
   6086 
   6087 Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
   6088 
   6089 Example:
   6090 """"""""
   6091 
   6092 .. code-block:: llvm
   6093 
   6094       <result> = urem i32 4, %var          ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
   6095 
   6096 '``srem``' Instruction
   6097 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6098 
   6099 Syntax:
   6100 """""""
   6101 
   6102 ::
   6103 
   6104       <result> = srem <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   6105 
   6106 Overview:
   6107 """""""""
   6108 
   6109 The '``srem``' instruction returns the remainder from the signed
   6110 division of its two operands. This instruction can also take
   6111 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` versions of the values in which case the elements
   6112 must be integers.
   6113 
   6114 Arguments:
   6115 """"""""""
   6116 
   6117 The two arguments to the '``srem``' instruction must be
   6118 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
   6119 arguments must have identical types.
   6120 
   6121 Semantics:
   6122 """"""""""
   6123 
   6124 This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division (where the result
   6125 is either zero or has the same sign as the dividend, ``op1``), not the
   6126 *modulo* operator (where the result is either zero or has the same sign
   6127 as the divisor, ``op2``) of a value. For more information about the
   6128 difference, see `The Math
   6129 Forum <http://mathforum.org/dr.math/problems/anne.4.28.99.html>`_. For a
   6130 table of how this is implemented in various languages, please see
   6131 `Wikipedia: modulo
   6132 operation <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Modulo_operation>`_.
   6133 
   6134 Note that signed integer remainder and unsigned integer remainder are
   6135 distinct operations; for unsigned integer remainder, use '``urem``'.
   6136 
   6137 Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
   6138 Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
   6139 occur, for example, by taking the remainder of a 32-bit division of
   6140 -2147483648 by -1. (The remainder doesn't actually overflow, but this
   6141 rule lets srem be implemented using instructions that return both the
   6142 result of the division and the remainder.)
   6143 
   6144 Example:
   6145 """"""""
   6146 
   6147 .. code-block:: llvm
   6148 
   6149       <result> = srem i32 4, %var          ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
   6150 
   6151 .. _i_frem:
   6152 
   6153 '``frem``' Instruction
   6154 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6155 
   6156 Syntax:
   6157 """""""
   6158 
   6159 ::
   6160 
   6161       <result> = frem [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   6162 
   6163 Overview:
   6164 """""""""
   6165 
   6166 The '``frem``' instruction returns the remainder from the division of
   6167 its two operands.
   6168 
   6169 Arguments:
   6170 """"""""""
   6171 
   6172 The two arguments to the '``frem``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
   6173 point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
   6174 Both arguments must have identical types.
   6175 
   6176 Semantics:
   6177 """"""""""
   6178 
   6179 This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division. The remainder
   6180 has the same sign as the dividend. This instruction can also take any
   6181 number of :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints
   6182 to enable otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations:
   6183 
   6184 Example:
   6185 """"""""
   6186 
   6187 .. code-block:: llvm
   6188 
   6189       <result> = frem float 4.0, %var          ; yields float:result = 4.0 % %var
   6190 
   6191 .. _bitwiseops:
   6192 
   6193 Bitwise Binary Operations
   6194 -------------------------
   6195 
   6196 Bitwise binary operators are used to do various forms of bit-twiddling
   6197 in a program. They are generally very efficient instructions and can
   6198 commonly be strength reduced from other instructions. They require two
   6199 operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a
   6200 single value. The resulting value is the same type as its operands.
   6201 
   6202 '``shl``' Instruction
   6203 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6204 
   6205 Syntax:
   6206 """""""
   6207 
   6208 ::
   6209 
   6210       <result> = shl <ty> <op1>, <op2>           ; yields ty:result
   6211       <result> = shl nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2>       ; yields ty:result
   6212       <result> = shl nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2>       ; yields ty:result
   6213       <result> = shl nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   6214 
   6215 Overview:
   6216 """""""""
   6217 
   6218 The '``shl``' instruction returns the first operand shifted to the left
   6219 a specified number of bits.
   6220 
   6221 Arguments:
   6222 """"""""""
   6223 
   6224 Both arguments to the '``shl``' instruction must be the same
   6225 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
   6226 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
   6227 
   6228 Semantics:
   6229 """"""""""
   6230 
   6231 The value produced is ``op1`` \* 2\ :sup:`op2` mod 2\ :sup:`n`,
   6232 where ``n`` is the width of the result. If ``op2`` is (statically or
   6233 dynamically) equal to or larger than the number of bits in
   6234 ``op1``, the result is undefined. If the arguments are vectors, each
   6235 vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount
   6236 in ``op2``.
   6237 
   6238 If the ``nuw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a :ref:`poison
   6239 value <poisonvalues>` if it shifts out any non-zero bits. If the
   6240 ``nsw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a :ref:`poison
   6241 value <poisonvalues>` if it shifts out any bits that disagree with the
   6242 resultant sign bit. As such, NUW/NSW have the same semantics as they
   6243 would if the shift were expressed as a mul instruction with the same
   6244 nsw/nuw bits in (mul %op1, (shl 1, %op2)).
   6245 
   6246 Example:
   6247 """"""""
   6248 
   6249 .. code-block:: llvm
   6250 
   6251       <result> = shl i32 4, %var   ; yields i32: 4 << %var
   6252       <result> = shl i32 4, 2      ; yields i32: 16
   6253       <result> = shl i32 1, 10     ; yields i32: 1024
   6254       <result> = shl i32 1, 32     ; undefined
   6255       <result> = shl <2 x i32> < i32 1, i32 1>, < i32 1, i32 2>   ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 2, i32 4>
   6256 
   6257 '``lshr``' Instruction
   6258 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6259 
   6260 Syntax:
   6261 """""""
   6262 
   6263 ::
   6264 
   6265       <result> = lshr <ty> <op1>, <op2>         ; yields ty:result
   6266       <result> = lshr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   6267 
   6268 Overview:
   6269 """""""""
   6270 
   6271 The '``lshr``' instruction (logical shift right) returns the first
   6272 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with zero fill.
   6273 
   6274 Arguments:
   6275 """"""""""
   6276 
   6277 Both arguments to the '``lshr``' instruction must be the same
   6278 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
   6279 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
   6280 
   6281 Semantics:
   6282 """"""""""
   6283 
   6284 This instruction always performs a logical shift right operation. The
   6285 most significant bits of the result will be filled with zero bits after
   6286 the shift. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
   6287 than the number of bits in ``op1``, the result is undefined. If the
   6288 arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the
   6289 corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
   6290 
   6291 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``lshr`` is
   6292 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if any of the bits shifted out are
   6293 non-zero.
   6294 
   6295 Example:
   6296 """"""""
   6297 
   6298 .. code-block:: llvm
   6299 
   6300       <result> = lshr i32 4, 1   ; yields i32:result = 2
   6301       <result> = lshr i32 4, 2   ; yields i32:result = 1
   6302       <result> = lshr i8  4, 3   ; yields i8:result = 0
   6303       <result> = lshr i8 -2, 1   ; yields i8:result = 0x7F
   6304       <result> = lshr i32 1, 32  ; undefined
   6305       <result> = lshr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 2>   ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 0x7FFFFFFF, i32 1>
   6306 
   6307 '``ashr``' Instruction
   6308 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6309 
   6310 Syntax:
   6311 """""""
   6312 
   6313 ::
   6314 
   6315       <result> = ashr <ty> <op1>, <op2>         ; yields ty:result
   6316       <result> = ashr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   6317 
   6318 Overview:
   6319 """""""""
   6320 
   6321 The '``ashr``' instruction (arithmetic shift right) returns the first
   6322 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with sign
   6323 extension.
   6324 
   6325 Arguments:
   6326 """"""""""
   6327 
   6328 Both arguments to the '``ashr``' instruction must be the same
   6329 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
   6330 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
   6331 
   6332 Semantics:
   6333 """"""""""
   6334 
   6335 This instruction always performs an arithmetic shift right operation,
   6336 The most significant bits of the result will be filled with the sign bit
   6337 of ``op1``. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
   6338 than the number of bits in ``op1``, the result is undefined. If the
   6339 arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the
   6340 corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
   6341 
   6342 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``ashr`` is
   6343 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if any of the bits shifted out are
   6344 non-zero.
   6345 
   6346 Example:
   6347 """"""""
   6348 
   6349 .. code-block:: llvm
   6350 
   6351       <result> = ashr i32 4, 1   ; yields i32:result = 2
   6352       <result> = ashr i32 4, 2   ; yields i32:result = 1
   6353       <result> = ashr i8  4, 3   ; yields i8:result = 0
   6354       <result> = ashr i8 -2, 1   ; yields i8:result = -1
   6355       <result> = ashr i32 1, 32  ; undefined
   6356       <result> = ashr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 3>   ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 -1, i32 0>
   6357 
   6358 '``and``' Instruction
   6359 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6360 
   6361 Syntax:
   6362 """""""
   6363 
   6364 ::
   6365 
   6366       <result> = and <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   6367 
   6368 Overview:
   6369 """""""""
   6370 
   6371 The '``and``' instruction returns the bitwise logical and of its two
   6372 operands.
   6373 
   6374 Arguments:
   6375 """"""""""
   6376 
   6377 The two arguments to the '``and``' instruction must be
   6378 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
   6379 arguments must have identical types.
   6380 
   6381 Semantics:
   6382 """"""""""
   6383 
   6384 The truth table used for the '``and``' instruction is:
   6385 
   6386 +-----+-----+-----+
   6387 | In0 | In1 | Out |
   6388 +-----+-----+-----+
   6389 |   0 |   0 |   0 |
   6390 +-----+-----+-----+
   6391 |   0 |   1 |   0 |
   6392 +-----+-----+-----+
   6393 |   1 |   0 |   0 |
   6394 +-----+-----+-----+
   6395 |   1 |   1 |   1 |
   6396 +-----+-----+-----+
   6397 
   6398 Example:
   6399 """"""""
   6400 
   6401 .. code-block:: llvm
   6402 
   6403       <result> = and i32 4, %var         ; yields i32:result = 4 & %var
   6404       <result> = and i32 15, 40          ; yields i32:result = 8
   6405       <result> = and i32 4, 8            ; yields i32:result = 0
   6406 
   6407 '``or``' Instruction
   6408 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6409 
   6410 Syntax:
   6411 """""""
   6412 
   6413 ::
   6414 
   6415       <result> = or <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   6416 
   6417 Overview:
   6418 """""""""
   6419 
   6420 The '``or``' instruction returns the bitwise logical inclusive or of its
   6421 two operands.
   6422 
   6423 Arguments:
   6424 """"""""""
   6425 
   6426 The two arguments to the '``or``' instruction must be
   6427 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
   6428 arguments must have identical types.
   6429 
   6430 Semantics:
   6431 """"""""""
   6432 
   6433 The truth table used for the '``or``' instruction is:
   6434 
   6435 +-----+-----+-----+
   6436 | In0 | In1 | Out |
   6437 +-----+-----+-----+
   6438 |   0 |   0 |   0 |
   6439 +-----+-----+-----+
   6440 |   0 |   1 |   1 |
   6441 +-----+-----+-----+
   6442 |   1 |   0 |   1 |
   6443 +-----+-----+-----+
   6444 |   1 |   1 |   1 |
   6445 +-----+-----+-----+
   6446 
   6447 Example:
   6448 """"""""
   6449 
   6450 ::
   6451 
   6452       <result> = or i32 4, %var         ; yields i32:result = 4 | %var
   6453       <result> = or i32 15, 40          ; yields i32:result = 47
   6454       <result> = or i32 4, 8            ; yields i32:result = 12
   6455 
   6456 '``xor``' Instruction
   6457 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6458 
   6459 Syntax:
   6460 """""""
   6461 
   6462 ::
   6463 
   6464       <result> = xor <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields ty:result
   6465 
   6466 Overview:
   6467 """""""""
   6468 
   6469 The '``xor``' instruction returns the bitwise logical exclusive or of
   6470 its two operands. The ``xor`` is used to implement the "one's
   6471 complement" operation, which is the "~" operator in C.
   6472 
   6473 Arguments:
   6474 """"""""""
   6475 
   6476 The two arguments to the '``xor``' instruction must be
   6477 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
   6478 arguments must have identical types.
   6479 
   6480 Semantics:
   6481 """"""""""
   6482 
   6483 The truth table used for the '``xor``' instruction is:
   6484 
   6485 +-----+-----+-----+
   6486 | In0 | In1 | Out |
   6487 +-----+-----+-----+
   6488 |   0 |   0 |   0 |
   6489 +-----+-----+-----+
   6490 |   0 |   1 |   1 |
   6491 +-----+-----+-----+
   6492 |   1 |   0 |   1 |
   6493 +-----+-----+-----+
   6494 |   1 |   1 |   0 |
   6495 +-----+-----+-----+
   6496 
   6497 Example:
   6498 """"""""
   6499 
   6500 .. code-block:: llvm
   6501 
   6502       <result> = xor i32 4, %var         ; yields i32:result = 4 ^ %var
   6503       <result> = xor i32 15, 40          ; yields i32:result = 39
   6504       <result> = xor i32 4, 8            ; yields i32:result = 12
   6505       <result> = xor i32 %V, -1          ; yields i32:result = ~%V
   6506 
   6507 Vector Operations
   6508 -----------------
   6509 
   6510 LLVM supports several instructions to represent vector operations in a
   6511 target-independent manner. These instructions cover the element-access
   6512 and vector-specific operations needed to process vectors effectively.
   6513 While LLVM does directly support these vector operations, many
   6514 sophisticated algorithms will want to use target-specific intrinsics to
   6515 take full advantage of a specific target.
   6516 
   6517 .. _i_extractelement:
   6518 
   6519 '``extractelement``' Instruction
   6520 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6521 
   6522 Syntax:
   6523 """""""
   6524 
   6525 ::
   6526 
   6527       <result> = extractelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty2> <idx>  ; yields <ty>
   6528 
   6529 Overview:
   6530 """""""""
   6531 
   6532 The '``extractelement``' instruction extracts a single scalar element
   6533 from a vector at a specified index.
   6534 
   6535 Arguments:
   6536 """"""""""
   6537 
   6538 The first operand of an '``extractelement``' instruction is a value of
   6539 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is an index indicating
   6540 the position from which to extract the element. The index may be a
   6541 variable of any integer type.
   6542 
   6543 Semantics:
   6544 """"""""""
   6545 
   6546 The result is a scalar of the same type as the element type of ``val``.
   6547 Its value is the value at position ``idx`` of ``val``. If ``idx``
   6548 exceeds the length of ``val``, the results are undefined.
   6549 
   6550 Example:
   6551 """"""""
   6552 
   6553 .. code-block:: llvm
   6554 
   6555       <result> = extractelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 0    ; yields i32
   6556 
   6557 .. _i_insertelement:
   6558 
   6559 '``insertelement``' Instruction
   6560 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6561 
   6562 Syntax:
   6563 """""""
   6564 
   6565 ::
   6566 
   6567       <result> = insertelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <ty2> <idx>    ; yields <n x <ty>>
   6568 
   6569 Overview:
   6570 """""""""
   6571 
   6572 The '``insertelement``' instruction inserts a scalar element into a
   6573 vector at a specified index.
   6574 
   6575 Arguments:
   6576 """"""""""
   6577 
   6578 The first operand of an '``insertelement``' instruction is a value of
   6579 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is a scalar value whose
   6580 type must equal the element type of the first operand. The third operand
   6581 is an index indicating the position at which to insert the value. The
   6582 index may be a variable of any integer type.
   6583 
   6584 Semantics:
   6585 """"""""""
   6586 
   6587 The result is a vector of the same type as ``val``. Its element values
   6588 are those of ``val`` except at position ``idx``, where it gets the value
   6589 ``elt``. If ``idx`` exceeds the length of ``val``, the results are
   6590 undefined.
   6591 
   6592 Example:
   6593 """"""""
   6594 
   6595 .. code-block:: llvm
   6596 
   6597       <result> = insertelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 1, i32 0    ; yields <4 x i32>
   6598 
   6599 .. _i_shufflevector:
   6600 
   6601 '``shufflevector``' Instruction
   6602 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6603 
   6604 Syntax:
   6605 """""""
   6606 
   6607 ::
   6608 
   6609       <result> = shufflevector <n x <ty>> <v1>, <n x <ty>> <v2>, <m x i32> <mask>    ; yields <m x <ty>>
   6610 
   6611 Overview:
   6612 """""""""
   6613 
   6614 The '``shufflevector``' instruction constructs a permutation of elements
   6615 from two input vectors, returning a vector with the same element type as
   6616 the input and length that is the same as the shuffle mask.
   6617 
   6618 Arguments:
   6619 """"""""""
   6620 
   6621 The first two operands of a '``shufflevector``' instruction are vectors
   6622 with the same type. The third argument is a shuffle mask whose element
   6623 type is always 'i32'. The result of the instruction is a vector whose
   6624 length is the same as the shuffle mask and whose element type is the
   6625 same as the element type of the first two operands.
   6626 
   6627 The shuffle mask operand is required to be a constant vector with either
   6628 constant integer or undef values.
   6629 
   6630 Semantics:
   6631 """"""""""
   6632 
   6633 The elements of the two input vectors are numbered from left to right
   6634 across both of the vectors. The shuffle mask operand specifies, for each
   6635 element of the result vector, which element of the two input vectors the
   6636 result element gets. The element selector may be undef (meaning "don't
   6637 care") and the second operand may be undef if performing a shuffle from
   6638 only one vector.
   6639 
   6640 Example:
   6641 """"""""
   6642 
   6643 .. code-block:: llvm
   6644 
   6645       <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
   6646                               <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 4, i32 1, i32 5>  ; yields <4 x i32>
   6647       <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> undef,
   6648                               <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3>  ; yields <4 x i32> - Identity shuffle.
   6649       <result> = shufflevector <8 x i32> %v1, <8 x i32> undef,
   6650                               <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3>  ; yields <4 x i32>
   6651       <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
   6652                               <8 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3, i32 4, i32 5, i32 6, i32 7 >  ; yields <8 x i32>
   6653 
   6654 Aggregate Operations
   6655 --------------------
   6656 
   6657 LLVM supports several instructions for working with
   6658 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` values.
   6659 
   6660 .. _i_extractvalue:
   6661 
   6662 '``extractvalue``' Instruction
   6663 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6664 
   6665 Syntax:
   6666 """""""
   6667 
   6668 ::
   6669 
   6670       <result> = extractvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <idx>{, <idx>}*
   6671 
   6672 Overview:
   6673 """""""""
   6674 
   6675 The '``extractvalue``' instruction extracts the value of a member field
   6676 from an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
   6677 
   6678 Arguments:
   6679 """"""""""
   6680 
   6681 The first operand of an '``extractvalue``' instruction is a value of
   6682 :ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The other operands are
   6683 constant indices to specify which value to extract in a similar manner
   6684 as indices in a '``getelementptr``' instruction.
   6685 
   6686 The major differences to ``getelementptr`` indexing are:
   6687 
   6688 -  Since the value being indexed is not a pointer, the first index is
   6689    omitted and assumed to be zero.
   6690 -  At least one index must be specified.
   6691 -  Not only struct indices but also array indices must be in bounds.
   6692 
   6693 Semantics:
   6694 """"""""""
   6695 
   6696 The result is the value at the position in the aggregate specified by
   6697 the index operands.
   6698 
   6699 Example:
   6700 """"""""
   6701 
   6702 .. code-block:: llvm
   6703 
   6704       <result> = extractvalue {i32, float} %agg, 0    ; yields i32
   6705 
   6706 .. _i_insertvalue:
   6707 
   6708 '``insertvalue``' Instruction
   6709 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6710 
   6711 Syntax:
   6712 """""""
   6713 
   6714 ::
   6715 
   6716       <result> = insertvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <idx>{, <idx>}*    ; yields <aggregate type>
   6717 
   6718 Overview:
   6719 """""""""
   6720 
   6721 The '``insertvalue``' instruction inserts a value into a member field in
   6722 an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
   6723 
   6724 Arguments:
   6725 """"""""""
   6726 
   6727 The first operand of an '``insertvalue``' instruction is a value of
   6728 :ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The second operand is
   6729 a first-class value to insert. The following operands are constant
   6730 indices indicating the position at which to insert the value in a
   6731 similar manner as indices in a '``extractvalue``' instruction. The value
   6732 to insert must have the same type as the value identified by the
   6733 indices.
   6734 
   6735 Semantics:
   6736 """"""""""
   6737 
   6738 The result is an aggregate of the same type as ``val``. Its value is
   6739 that of ``val`` except that the value at the position specified by the
   6740 indices is that of ``elt``.
   6741 
   6742 Example:
   6743 """"""""
   6744 
   6745 .. code-block:: llvm
   6746 
   6747       %agg1 = insertvalue {i32, float} undef, i32 1, 0              ; yields {i32 1, float undef}
   6748       %agg2 = insertvalue {i32, float} %agg1, float %val, 1         ; yields {i32 1, float %val}
   6749       %agg3 = insertvalue {i32, {float}} undef, float %val, 1, 0    ; yields {i32 undef, {float %val}}
   6750 
   6751 .. _memoryops:
   6752 
   6753 Memory Access and Addressing Operations
   6754 ---------------------------------------
   6755 
   6756 A key design point of an SSA-based representation is how it represents
   6757 memory. In LLVM, no memory locations are in SSA form, which makes things
   6758 very simple. This section describes how to read, write, and allocate
   6759 memory in LLVM.
   6760 
   6761 .. _i_alloca:
   6762 
   6763 '``alloca``' Instruction
   6764 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6765 
   6766 Syntax:
   6767 """""""
   6768 
   6769 ::
   6770 
   6771       <result> = alloca [inalloca] <type> [, <ty> <NumElements>] [, align <alignment>]     ; yields type*:result
   6772 
   6773 Overview:
   6774 """""""""
   6775 
   6776 The '``alloca``' instruction allocates memory on the stack frame of the
   6777 currently executing function, to be automatically released when this
   6778 function returns to its caller. The object is always allocated in the
   6779 generic address space (address space zero).
   6780 
   6781 Arguments:
   6782 """"""""""
   6783 
   6784 The '``alloca``' instruction allocates ``sizeof(<type>)*NumElements``
   6785 bytes of memory on the runtime stack, returning a pointer of the
   6786 appropriate type to the program. If "NumElements" is specified, it is
   6787 the number of elements allocated, otherwise "NumElements" is defaulted
   6788 to be one. If a constant alignment is specified, the value result of the
   6789 allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to at least that boundary. The
   6790 alignment may not be greater than ``1 << 29``. If not specified, or if
   6791 zero, the target can choose to align the allocation on any convenient
   6792 boundary compatible with the type.
   6793 
   6794 '``type``' may be any sized type.
   6795 
   6796 Semantics:
   6797 """"""""""
   6798 
   6799 Memory is allocated; a pointer is returned. The operation is undefined
   6800 if there is insufficient stack space for the allocation. '``alloca``'d
   6801 memory is automatically released when the function returns. The
   6802 '``alloca``' instruction is commonly used to represent automatic
   6803 variables that must have an address available. When the function returns
   6804 (either with the ``ret`` or ``resume`` instructions), the memory is
   6805 reclaimed. Allocating zero bytes is legal, but the result is undefined.
   6806 The order in which memory is allocated (ie., which way the stack grows)
   6807 is not specified.
   6808 
   6809 Example:
   6810 """"""""
   6811 
   6812 .. code-block:: llvm
   6813 
   6814       %ptr = alloca i32                             ; yields i32*:ptr
   6815       %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4                      ; yields i32*:ptr
   6816       %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4, align 1024          ; yields i32*:ptr
   6817       %ptr = alloca i32, align 1024                 ; yields i32*:ptr
   6818 
   6819 .. _i_load:
   6820 
   6821 '``load``' Instruction
   6822 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6823 
   6824 Syntax:
   6825 """""""
   6826 
   6827 ::
   6828 
   6829       <result> = load [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.load !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>][, !nonnull !<index>][, !dereferenceable !<deref_bytes_node>][, !dereferenceable_or_null !<deref_bytes_node>][, !align !<align_node>]
   6830       <result> = load atomic [volatile] <ty>* <pointer> [singlethread] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>]
   6831       !<index> = !{ i32 1 }
   6832       !<deref_bytes_node> = !{i64 <dereferenceable_bytes>}
   6833       !<align_node> = !{ i64 <value_alignment> }
   6834 
   6835 Overview:
   6836 """""""""
   6837 
   6838 The '``load``' instruction is used to read from memory.
   6839 
   6840 Arguments:
   6841 """"""""""
   6842 
   6843 The argument to the ``load`` instruction specifies the memory address
   6844 from which to load. The type specified must be a :ref:`first
   6845 class <t_firstclass>` type. If the ``load`` is marked as ``volatile``,
   6846 then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of
   6847 execution of this ``load`` with other :ref:`volatile
   6848 operations <volatile>`.
   6849 
   6850 If the ``load`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
   6851 <ordering>` and optional ``singlethread`` argument. The ``release`` and
   6852 ``acq_rel`` orderings are not valid on ``load`` instructions. Atomic loads
   6853 produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see multiple atomic
   6854 stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or floating-point
   6855 type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
   6856 than or equal to a target-specific size limit.  ``align`` must be explicitly
   6857 specified on atomic loads, and the load has undefined behavior if the alignment
   6858 is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
   6859 pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic loads.
   6860 
   6861 The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
   6862 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
   6863 or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
   6864 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
   6865 to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
   6866 alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment
   6867 may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe. The
   6868 maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``.
   6869 
   6870 The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single
   6871 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
   6872 ``i32`` entry of value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal``
   6873 metadata on the instruction tells the optimizer and code generator
   6874 that this load is not expected to be reused in the cache. The code
   6875 generator may select special instructions to save cache bandwidth, such
   6876 as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on x86.
   6877 
   6878 The optional ``!invariant.load`` metadata must reference a single
   6879 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
   6880 entries. The existence of the ``!invariant.load`` metadata on the
   6881 instruction tells the optimizer and code generator that the address
   6882 operand to this load points to memory which can be assumed unchanged.
   6883 Being invariant does not imply that a location is dereferenceable,
   6884 but it does imply that once the location is known dereferenceable
   6885 its value is henceforth unchanging.
   6886 
   6887 The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
   6888  ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node. See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
   6889 
   6890 The optional ``!nonnull`` metadata must reference a single
   6891 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
   6892 entries. The existence of the ``!nonnull`` metadata on the
   6893 instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to
   6894 never be null. This is analogous to the ``nonnull`` attribute
   6895 on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
   6896 to loads of a pointer type.
   6897 
   6898 The optional ``!dereferenceable`` metadata must reference a single metadata
   6899 name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64``
   6900 entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable`` metadata on the instruction
   6901 tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be dereferenceable.
   6902 The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
   6903 value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable''
   6904 attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
   6905 to loads of a pointer type.
   6906 
   6907 The optional ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata must reference a single
   6908 metadata name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
   6909 ``i64`` entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata on the
   6910 instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be either
   6911 dereferenceable or null.
   6912 The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
   6913 value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable_or_null''
   6914 attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
   6915 to loads of a pointer type.
   6916 
   6917 The optional ``!align`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
   6918 ``<align_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64`` entry.
   6919 The existence of the ``!align`` metadata on the instruction tells the
   6920 optimizer that the value loaded is known to be aligned to a boundary specified
   6921 by the integer value in the metadata node. The alignment must be a power of 2.
   6922 This is analogous to the ''align'' attribute on parameters and return values.
   6923 This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type.
   6924 
   6925 Semantics:
   6926 """"""""""
   6927 
   6928 The location of memory pointed to is loaded. If the value being loaded
   6929 is of scalar type then the number of bytes read does not exceed the
   6930 minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
   6931 example, loading an ``i24`` reads at most three bytes. When loading a
   6932 value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
   6933 of bytes, the result is undefined if the value was not originally
   6934 written using a store of the same type.
   6935 
   6936 Examples:
   6937 """""""""
   6938 
   6939 .. code-block:: llvm
   6940 
   6941       %ptr = alloca i32                               ; yields i32*:ptr
   6942       store i32 3, i32* %ptr                          ; yields void
   6943       %val = load i32, i32* %ptr                      ; yields i32:val = i32 3
   6944 
   6945 .. _i_store:
   6946 
   6947 '``store``' Instruction
   6948 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   6949 
   6950 Syntax:
   6951 """""""
   6952 
   6953 ::
   6954 
   6955       store [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>]        ; yields void
   6956       store atomic [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer> [singlethread] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
   6957 
   6958 Overview:
   6959 """""""""
   6960 
   6961 The '``store``' instruction is used to write to memory.
   6962 
   6963 Arguments:
   6964 """"""""""
   6965 
   6966 There are two arguments to the ``store`` instruction: a value to store
   6967 and an address at which to store it. The type of the ``<pointer>``
   6968 operand must be a pointer to the :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of
   6969 the ``<value>`` operand. If the ``store`` is marked as ``volatile``,
   6970 then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of
   6971 execution of this ``store`` with other :ref:`volatile
   6972 operations <volatile>`.
   6973 
   6974 If the ``store`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
   6975 <ordering>` and optional ``singlethread`` argument. The ``acquire`` and
   6976 ``acq_rel`` orderings aren't valid on ``store`` instructions. Atomic loads
   6977 produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see multiple atomic
   6978 stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or floating-point
   6979 type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
   6980 than or equal to a target-specific size limit.  ``align`` must be explicitly
   6981 specified on atomic stores, and the store has undefined behavior if the
   6982 alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
   6983 pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic stores.
   6984 
   6985 The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
   6986 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
   6987 or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
   6988 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
   6989 to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
   6990 alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the
   6991 alignment may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always
   6992 safe. The maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``.
   6993 
   6994 The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single metadata
   6995 name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i32`` entry of
   6996 value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal`` metadata on the instruction
   6997 tells the optimizer and code generator that this load is not expected to
   6998 be reused in the cache. The code generator may select special
   6999 instructions to save cache bandwidth, such as the MOVNT instruction on
   7000 x86.
   7001 
   7002 The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a 
   7003 single metadata name ``<index>``. See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
   7004 
   7005 Semantics:
   7006 """"""""""
   7007 
   7008 The contents of memory are updated to contain ``<value>`` at the
   7009 location specified by the ``<pointer>`` operand. If ``<value>`` is
   7010 of scalar type then the number of bytes written does not exceed the
   7011 minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
   7012 example, storing an ``i24`` writes at most three bytes. When writing a
   7013 value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
   7014 of bytes, it is unspecified what happens to the extra bits that do not
   7015 belong to the type, but they will typically be overwritten.
   7016 
   7017 Example:
   7018 """"""""
   7019 
   7020 .. code-block:: llvm
   7021 
   7022       %ptr = alloca i32                               ; yields i32*:ptr
   7023       store i32 3, i32* %ptr                          ; yields void
   7024       %val = load i32, i32* %ptr                      ; yields i32:val = i32 3
   7025 
   7026 .. _i_fence:
   7027 
   7028 '``fence``' Instruction
   7029 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7030 
   7031 Syntax:
   7032 """""""
   7033 
   7034 ::
   7035 
   7036       fence [singlethread] <ordering>                   ; yields void
   7037 
   7038 Overview:
   7039 """""""""
   7040 
   7041 The '``fence``' instruction is used to introduce happens-before edges
   7042 between operations.
   7043 
   7044 Arguments:
   7045 """"""""""
   7046 
   7047 '``fence``' instructions take an :ref:`ordering <ordering>` argument which
   7048 defines what *synchronizes-with* edges they add. They can only be given
   7049 ``acquire``, ``release``, ``acq_rel``, and ``seq_cst`` orderings.
   7050 
   7051 Semantics:
   7052 """"""""""
   7053 
   7054 A fence A which has (at least) ``release`` ordering semantics
   7055 *synchronizes with* a fence B with (at least) ``acquire`` ordering
   7056 semantics if and only if there exist atomic operations X and Y, both
   7057 operating on some atomic object M, such that A is sequenced before X, X
   7058 modifies M (either directly or through some side effect of a sequence
   7059 headed by X), Y is sequenced before B, and Y observes M. This provides a
   7060 *happens-before* dependency between A and B. Rather than an explicit
   7061 ``fence``, one (but not both) of the atomic operations X or Y might
   7062 provide a ``release`` or ``acquire`` (resp.) ordering constraint and
   7063 still *synchronize-with* the explicit ``fence`` and establish the
   7064 *happens-before* edge.
   7065 
   7066 A ``fence`` which has ``seq_cst`` ordering, in addition to having both
   7067 ``acquire`` and ``release`` semantics specified above, participates in
   7068 the global program order of other ``seq_cst`` operations and/or fences.
   7069 
   7070 The optional ":ref:`singlethread <singlethread>`" argument specifies
   7071 that the fence only synchronizes with other fences in the same thread.
   7072 (This is useful for interacting with signal handlers.)
   7073 
   7074 Example:
   7075 """"""""
   7076 
   7077 .. code-block:: llvm
   7078 
   7079       fence acquire                          ; yields void
   7080       fence singlethread seq_cst             ; yields void
   7081 
   7082 .. _i_cmpxchg:
   7083 
   7084 '``cmpxchg``' Instruction
   7085 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7086 
   7087 Syntax:
   7088 """""""
   7089 
   7090 ::
   7091 
   7092       cmpxchg [weak] [volatile] <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <cmp>, <ty> <new> [singlethread] <success ordering> <failure ordering> ; yields  { ty, i1 }
   7093 
   7094 Overview:
   7095 """""""""
   7096 
   7097 The '``cmpxchg``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory. It
   7098 loads a value in memory and compares it to a given value. If they are
   7099 equal, it tries to store a new value into the memory.
   7100 
   7101 Arguments:
   7102 """"""""""
   7103 
   7104 There are three arguments to the '``cmpxchg``' instruction: an address
   7105 to operate on, a value to compare to the value currently be at that
   7106 address, and a new value to place at that address if the compared values
   7107 are equal. The type of '<cmp>' must be an integer type whose bit width
   7108 is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less than or equal
   7109 to a target-specific size limit. '<cmp>' and '<new>' must have the same
   7110 type, and the type of '<pointer>' must be a pointer to that type. If the
   7111 ``cmpxchg`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed
   7112 to modify the number or order of execution of this ``cmpxchg`` with
   7113 other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
   7114 
   7115 The success and failure :ref:`ordering <ordering>` arguments specify how this
   7116 ``cmpxchg`` synchronizes with other atomic operations. Both ordering parameters
   7117 must be at least ``monotonic``, the ordering constraint on failure must be no
   7118 stronger than that on success, and the failure ordering cannot be either
   7119 ``release`` or ``acq_rel``.
   7120 
   7121 The optional "``singlethread``" argument declares that the ``cmpxchg``
   7122 is only atomic with respect to code (usually signal handlers) running in
   7123 the same thread as the ``cmpxchg``. Otherwise the cmpxchg is atomic with
   7124 respect to all other code in the system.
   7125 
   7126 The pointer passed into cmpxchg must have alignment greater than or
   7127 equal to the size in memory of the operand.
   7128 
   7129 Semantics:
   7130 """"""""""
   7131 
   7132 The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``' operand
   7133 is read and compared to '``<cmp>``'; if the read value is the equal, the
   7134 '``<new>``' is written. The original value at the location is returned, together
   7135 with a flag indicating success (true) or failure (false).
   7136 
   7137 If the cmpxchg operation is marked as ``weak`` then a spurious failure is
   7138 permitted: the operation may not write ``<new>`` even if the comparison
   7139 matched.
   7140 
   7141 If the cmpxchg operation is strong (the default), the i1 value is 1 if and only
   7142 if the value loaded equals ``cmp``.
   7143 
   7144 A successful ``cmpxchg`` is a read-modify-write instruction for the purpose of
   7145 identifying release sequences. A failed ``cmpxchg`` is equivalent to an atomic
   7146 load with an ordering parameter determined the second ordering parameter.
   7147 
   7148 Example:
   7149 """"""""
   7150 
   7151 .. code-block:: llvm
   7152 
   7153     entry:
   7154       %orig = atomic load i32, i32* %ptr unordered                ; yields i32
   7155       br label %loop
   7156 
   7157     loop:
   7158       %cmp = phi i32 [ %orig, %entry ], [%old, %loop]
   7159       %squared = mul i32 %cmp, %cmp
   7160       %val_success = cmpxchg i32* %ptr, i32 %cmp, i32 %squared acq_rel monotonic ; yields  { i32, i1 }
   7161       %value_loaded = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 0
   7162       %success = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 1
   7163       br i1 %success, label %done, label %loop
   7164 
   7165     done:
   7166       ...
   7167 
   7168 .. _i_atomicrmw:
   7169 
   7170 '``atomicrmw``' Instruction
   7171 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7172 
   7173 Syntax:
   7174 """""""
   7175 
   7176 ::
   7177 
   7178       atomicrmw [volatile] <operation> <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <value> [singlethread] <ordering>                   ; yields ty
   7179 
   7180 Overview:
   7181 """""""""
   7182 
   7183 The '``atomicrmw``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory.
   7184 
   7185 Arguments:
   7186 """"""""""
   7187 
   7188 There are three arguments to the '``atomicrmw``' instruction: an
   7189 operation to apply, an address whose value to modify, an argument to the
   7190 operation. The operation must be one of the following keywords:
   7191 
   7192 -  xchg
   7193 -  add
   7194 -  sub
   7195 -  and
   7196 -  nand
   7197 -  or
   7198 -  xor
   7199 -  max
   7200 -  min
   7201 -  umax
   7202 -  umin
   7203 
   7204 The type of '<value>' must be an integer type whose bit width is a power
   7205 of two greater than or equal to eight and less than or equal to a
   7206 target-specific size limit. The type of the '``<pointer>``' operand must
   7207 be a pointer to that type. If the ``atomicrmw`` is marked as
   7208 ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or
   7209 order of execution of this ``atomicrmw`` with other :ref:`volatile
   7210 operations <volatile>`.
   7211 
   7212 Semantics:
   7213 """"""""""
   7214 
   7215 The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``'
   7216 operand are atomically read, modified, and written back. The original
   7217 value at the location is returned. The modification is specified by the
   7218 operation argument:
   7219 
   7220 -  xchg: ``*ptr = val``
   7221 -  add: ``*ptr = *ptr + val``
   7222 -  sub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val``
   7223 -  and: ``*ptr = *ptr & val``
   7224 -  nand: ``*ptr = ~(*ptr & val)``
   7225 -  or: ``*ptr = *ptr | val``
   7226 -  xor: ``*ptr = *ptr ^ val``
   7227 -  max: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
   7228 -  min: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
   7229 -  umax: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
   7230    comparison)
   7231 -  umin: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
   7232    comparison)
   7233 
   7234 Example:
   7235 """"""""
   7236 
   7237 .. code-block:: llvm
   7238 
   7239       %old = atomicrmw add i32* %ptr, i32 1 acquire                        ; yields i32
   7240 
   7241 .. _i_getelementptr:
   7242 
   7243 '``getelementptr``' Instruction
   7244 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7245 
   7246 Syntax:
   7247 """""""
   7248 
   7249 ::
   7250 
   7251       <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, <ty> <idx>}*
   7252       <result> = getelementptr inbounds <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, <ty> <idx>}*
   7253       <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ptr vector> <ptrval>, <vector index type> <idx>
   7254 
   7255 Overview:
   7256 """""""""
   7257 
   7258 The '``getelementptr``' instruction is used to get the address of a
   7259 subelement of an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` data structure. It performs
   7260 address calculation only and does not access memory. The instruction can also
   7261 be used to calculate a vector of such addresses.
   7262 
   7263 Arguments:
   7264 """"""""""
   7265 
   7266 The first argument is always a type used as the basis for the calculations.
   7267 The second argument is always a pointer or a vector of pointers, and is the
   7268 base address to start from. The remaining arguments are indices
   7269 that indicate which of the elements of the aggregate object are indexed.
   7270 The interpretation of each index is dependent on the type being indexed
   7271 into. The first index always indexes the pointer value given as the
   7272 first argument, the second index indexes a value of the type pointed to
   7273 (not necessarily the value directly pointed to, since the first index
   7274 can be non-zero), etc. The first type indexed into must be a pointer
   7275 value, subsequent types can be arrays, vectors, and structs. Note that
   7276 subsequent types being indexed into can never be pointers, since that
   7277 would require loading the pointer before continuing calculation.
   7278 
   7279 The type of each index argument depends on the type it is indexing into.
   7280 When indexing into a (optionally packed) structure, only ``i32`` integer
   7281 **constants** are allowed (when using a vector of indices they must all
   7282 be the **same** ``i32`` integer constant). When indexing into an array,
   7283 pointer or vector, integers of any width are allowed, and they are not
   7284 required to be constant. These integers are treated as signed values
   7285 where relevant.
   7286 
   7287 For example, let's consider a C code fragment and how it gets compiled
   7288 to LLVM:
   7289 
   7290 .. code-block:: c
   7291 
   7292     struct RT {
   7293       char A;
   7294       int B[10][20];
   7295       char C;
   7296     };
   7297     struct ST {
   7298       int X;
   7299       double Y;
   7300       struct RT Z;
   7301     };
   7302 
   7303     int *foo(struct ST *s) {
   7304       return &s[1].Z.B[5][13];
   7305     }
   7306 
   7307 The LLVM code generated by Clang is:
   7308 
   7309 .. code-block:: llvm
   7310 
   7311     %struct.RT = type { i8, [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }
   7312     %struct.ST = type { i32, double, %struct.RT }
   7313 
   7314     define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) nounwind uwtable readnone optsize ssp {
   7315     entry:
   7316       %arrayidx = getelementptr inbounds %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i64 1, i32 2, i32 1, i64 5, i64 13
   7317       ret i32* %arrayidx
   7318     }
   7319 
   7320 Semantics:
   7321 """"""""""
   7322 
   7323 In the example above, the first index is indexing into the
   7324 '``%struct.ST*``' type, which is a pointer, yielding a '``%struct.ST``'
   7325 = '``{ i32, double, %struct.RT }``' type, a structure. The second index
   7326 indexes into the third element of the structure, yielding a
   7327 '``%struct.RT``' = '``{ i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }``' type, another
   7328 structure. The third index indexes into the second element of the
   7329 structure, yielding a '``[10 x [20 x i32]]``' type, an array. The two
   7330 dimensions of the array are subscripted into, yielding an '``i32``'
   7331 type. The '``getelementptr``' instruction returns a pointer to this
   7332 element, thus computing a value of '``i32*``' type.
   7333 
   7334 Note that it is perfectly legal to index partially through a structure,
   7335 returning a pointer to an inner element. Because of this, the LLVM code
   7336 for the given testcase is equivalent to:
   7337 
   7338 .. code-block:: llvm
   7339 
   7340     define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) {
   7341       %t1 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i32 1                        ; yields %struct.ST*:%t1
   7342       %t2 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %t1, i32 0, i32 2                ; yields %struct.RT*:%t2
   7343       %t3 = getelementptr %struct.RT, %struct.RT* %t2, i32 0, i32 1                ; yields [10 x [20 x i32]]*:%t3
   7344       %t4 = getelementptr [10 x [20 x i32]], [10 x [20 x i32]]* %t3, i32 0, i32 5  ; yields [20 x i32]*:%t4
   7345       %t5 = getelementptr [20 x i32], [20 x i32]* %t4, i32 0, i32 13               ; yields i32*:%t5
   7346       ret i32* %t5
   7347     }
   7348 
   7349 If the ``inbounds`` keyword is present, the result value of the
   7350 ``getelementptr`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the base
   7351 pointer is not an *in bounds* address of an allocated object, or if any
   7352 of the addresses that would be formed by successive addition of the
   7353 offsets implied by the indices to the base address with infinitely
   7354 precise signed arithmetic are not an *in bounds* address of that
   7355 allocated object. The *in bounds* addresses for an allocated object are
   7356 all the addresses that point into the object, plus the address one byte
   7357 past the end. In cases where the base is a vector of pointers the
   7358 ``inbounds`` keyword applies to each of the computations element-wise.
   7359 
   7360 If the ``inbounds`` keyword is not present, the offsets are added to the
   7361 base address with silently-wrapping two's complement arithmetic. If the
   7362 offsets have a different width from the pointer, they are sign-extended
   7363 or truncated to the width of the pointer. The result value of the
   7364 ``getelementptr`` may be outside the object pointed to by the base
   7365 pointer. The result value may not necessarily be used to access memory
   7366 though, even if it happens to point into allocated storage. See the
   7367 :ref:`Pointer Aliasing Rules <pointeraliasing>` section for more
   7368 information.
   7369 
   7370 The getelementptr instruction is often confusing. For some more insight
   7371 into how it works, see :doc:`the getelementptr FAQ <GetElementPtr>`.
   7372 
   7373 Example:
   7374 """"""""
   7375 
   7376 .. code-block:: llvm
   7377 
   7378         ; yields [12 x i8]*:aptr
   7379         %aptr = getelementptr {i32, [12 x i8]}, {i32, [12 x i8]}* %saptr, i64 0, i32 1
   7380         ; yields i8*:vptr
   7381         %vptr = getelementptr {i32, <2 x i8>}, {i32, <2 x i8>}* %svptr, i64 0, i32 1, i32 1
   7382         ; yields i8*:eptr
   7383         %eptr = getelementptr [12 x i8], [12 x i8]* %aptr, i64 0, i32 1
   7384         ; yields i32*:iptr
   7385         %iptr = getelementptr [10 x i32], [10 x i32]* @arr, i16 0, i16 0
   7386 
   7387 Vector of pointers:
   7388 """""""""""""""""""
   7389 
   7390 The ``getelementptr`` returns a vector of pointers, instead of a single address,
   7391 when one or more of its arguments is a vector. In such cases, all vector
   7392 arguments should have the same number of elements, and every scalar argument
   7393 will be effectively broadcast into a vector during address calculation.
   7394 
   7395 .. code-block:: llvm
   7396 
   7397      ; All arguments are vectors:
   7398      ;   A[i] = ptrs[i] + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
   7399      %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, <4 x i64> %offsets
   7400 
   7401      ; Add the same scalar offset to each pointer of a vector:
   7402      ;   A[i] = ptrs[i] + offset*sizeof(i8)
   7403      %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, i64 %offset
   7404 
   7405      ; Add distinct offsets to the same pointer:
   7406      ;   A[i] = ptr + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
   7407      %A = getelementptr i8, i8* %ptr, <4 x i64> %offsets
   7408 
   7409      ; In all cases described above the type of the result is <4 x i8*>
   7410 
   7411 The two following instructions are equivalent:
   7412 
   7413 .. code-block:: llvm
   7414 
   7415      getelementptr  %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
   7416        <4 x i32> <i32 2, i32 2, i32 2, i32 2>,
   7417        <4 x i32> <i32 1, i32 1, i32 1, i32 1>,
   7418        <4 x i32> %ind4,
   7419        <4 x i64> <i64 13, i64 13, i64 13, i64 13>
   7420 
   7421      getelementptr  %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
   7422        i32 2, i32 1, <4 x i32> %ind4, i64 13
   7423 
   7424 Let's look at the C code, where the vector version of ``getelementptr``
   7425 makes sense:
   7426 
   7427 .. code-block:: c
   7428 
   7429     // Let's assume that we vectorize the following loop:
   7430     double *A, B; int *C;
   7431     for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
   7432       A[i] = B[C[i]];
   7433     }
   7434 
   7435 .. code-block:: llvm
   7436 
   7437     ; get pointers for 8 elements from array B
   7438     %ptrs = getelementptr double, double* %B, <8 x i32> %C
   7439     ; load 8 elements from array B into A
   7440     %A = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v8f64(<8 x double*> %ptrs,
   7441          i32 8, <8 x i1> %mask, <8 x double> %passthru)
   7442 
   7443 Conversion Operations
   7444 ---------------------
   7445 
   7446 The instructions in this category are the conversion instructions
   7447 (casting) which all take a single operand and a type. They perform
   7448 various bit conversions on the operand.
   7449 
   7450 '``trunc .. to``' Instruction
   7451 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7452 
   7453 Syntax:
   7454 """""""
   7455 
   7456 ::
   7457 
   7458       <result> = trunc <ty> <value> to <ty2>             ; yields ty2
   7459 
   7460 Overview:
   7461 """""""""
   7462 
   7463 The '``trunc``' instruction truncates its operand to the type ``ty2``.
   7464 
   7465 Arguments:
   7466 """"""""""
   7467 
   7468 The '``trunc``' instruction takes a value to trunc, and a type to trunc
   7469 it to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors
   7470 of the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
   7471 larger than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``. Equal sized
   7472 types are not allowed.
   7473 
   7474 Semantics:
   7475 """"""""""
   7476 
   7477 The '``trunc``' instruction truncates the high order bits in ``value``
   7478 and converts the remaining bits to ``ty2``. Since the source size must
   7479 be larger than the destination size, ``trunc`` cannot be a *no-op cast*.
   7480 It will always truncate bits.
   7481 
   7482 Example:
   7483 """"""""
   7484 
   7485 .. code-block:: llvm
   7486 
   7487       %X = trunc i32 257 to i8                        ; yields i8:1
   7488       %Y = trunc i32 123 to i1                        ; yields i1:true
   7489       %Z = trunc i32 122 to i1                        ; yields i1:false
   7490       %W = trunc <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i8> ; yields <i8 8, i8 7>
   7491 
   7492 '``zext .. to``' Instruction
   7493 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7494 
   7495 Syntax:
   7496 """""""
   7497 
   7498 ::
   7499 
   7500       <result> = zext <ty> <value> to <ty2>             ; yields ty2
   7501 
   7502 Overview:
   7503 """""""""
   7504 
   7505 The '``zext``' instruction zero extends its operand to type ``ty2``.
   7506 
   7507 Arguments:
   7508 """"""""""
   7509 
   7510 The '``zext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
   7511 to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
   7512 the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
   7513 smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
   7514 
   7515 Semantics:
   7516 """"""""""
   7517 
   7518 The ``zext`` fills the high order bits of the ``value`` with zero bits
   7519 until it reaches the size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
   7520 
   7521 When zero extending from i1, the result will always be either 0 or 1.
   7522 
   7523 Example:
   7524 """"""""
   7525 
   7526 .. code-block:: llvm
   7527 
   7528       %X = zext i32 257 to i64              ; yields i64:257
   7529       %Y = zext i1 true to i32              ; yields i32:1
   7530       %Z = zext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
   7531 
   7532 '``sext .. to``' Instruction
   7533 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7534 
   7535 Syntax:
   7536 """""""
   7537 
   7538 ::
   7539 
   7540       <result> = sext <ty> <value> to <ty2>             ; yields ty2
   7541 
   7542 Overview:
   7543 """""""""
   7544 
   7545 The '``sext``' sign extends ``value`` to the type ``ty2``.
   7546 
   7547 Arguments:
   7548 """"""""""
   7549 
   7550 The '``sext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
   7551 to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
   7552 the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
   7553 smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
   7554 
   7555 Semantics:
   7556 """"""""""
   7557 
   7558 The '``sext``' instruction performs a sign extension by copying the sign
   7559 bit (highest order bit) of the ``value`` until it reaches the bit size
   7560 of the type ``ty2``.
   7561 
   7562 When sign extending from i1, the extension always results in -1 or 0.
   7563 
   7564 Example:
   7565 """"""""
   7566 
   7567 .. code-block:: llvm
   7568 
   7569       %X = sext i8  -1 to i16              ; yields i16   :65535
   7570       %Y = sext i1 true to i32             ; yields i32:-1
   7571       %Z = sext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
   7572 
   7573 '``fptrunc .. to``' Instruction
   7574 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7575 
   7576 Syntax:
   7577 """""""
   7578 
   7579 ::
   7580 
   7581       <result> = fptrunc <ty> <value> to <ty2>             ; yields ty2
   7582 
   7583 Overview:
   7584 """""""""
   7585 
   7586 The '``fptrunc``' instruction truncates ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
   7587 
   7588 Arguments:
   7589 """"""""""
   7590 
   7591 The '``fptrunc``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>`
   7592 value to cast and a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to cast it to.
   7593 The size of ``value`` must be larger than the size of ``ty2``. This
   7594 implies that ``fptrunc`` cannot be used to make a *no-op cast*.
   7595 
   7596 Semantics:
   7597 """"""""""
   7598 
   7599 The '``fptrunc``' instruction casts a ``value`` from a larger
   7600 :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to a smaller :ref:`floating
   7601 point <t_floating>` type. If the value cannot fit (i.e. overflows) within the
   7602 destination type, ``ty2``, then the results are undefined. If the cast produces
   7603 an inexact result, how rounding is performed (e.g. truncation, also known as
   7604 round to zero) is undefined.
   7605 
   7606 Example:
   7607 """"""""
   7608 
   7609 .. code-block:: llvm
   7610 
   7611       %X = fptrunc double 123.0 to float         ; yields float:123.0
   7612       %Y = fptrunc double 1.0E+300 to float      ; yields undefined
   7613 
   7614 '``fpext .. to``' Instruction
   7615 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7616 
   7617 Syntax:
   7618 """""""
   7619 
   7620 ::
   7621 
   7622       <result> = fpext <ty> <value> to <ty2>             ; yields ty2
   7623 
   7624 Overview:
   7625 """""""""
   7626 
   7627 The '``fpext``' extends a floating point ``value`` to a larger floating
   7628 point value.
   7629 
   7630 Arguments:
   7631 """"""""""
   7632 
   7633 The '``fpext``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>`
   7634 ``value`` to cast, and a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to cast it
   7635 to. The source type must be smaller than the destination type.
   7636 
   7637 Semantics:
   7638 """"""""""
   7639 
   7640 The '``fpext``' instruction extends the ``value`` from a smaller
   7641 :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to a larger :ref:`floating
   7642 point <t_floating>` type. The ``fpext`` cannot be used to make a
   7643 *no-op cast* because it always changes bits. Use ``bitcast`` to make a
   7644 *no-op cast* for a floating point cast.
   7645 
   7646 Example:
   7647 """"""""
   7648 
   7649 .. code-block:: llvm
   7650 
   7651       %X = fpext float 3.125 to double         ; yields double:3.125000e+00
   7652       %Y = fpext double %X to fp128            ; yields fp128:0xL00000000000000004000900000000000
   7653 
   7654 '``fptoui .. to``' Instruction
   7655 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7656 
   7657 Syntax:
   7658 """""""
   7659 
   7660 ::
   7661 
   7662       <result> = fptoui <ty> <value> to <ty2>             ; yields ty2
   7663 
   7664 Overview:
   7665 """""""""
   7666 
   7667 The '``fptoui``' converts a floating point ``value`` to its unsigned
   7668 integer equivalent of type ``ty2``.
   7669 
   7670 Arguments:
   7671 """"""""""
   7672 
   7673 The '``fptoui``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
   7674 scalar or vector :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
   7675 cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
   7676 ``ty`` is a vector floating point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
   7677 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
   7678 
   7679 Semantics:
   7680 """"""""""
   7681 
   7682 The '``fptoui``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating
   7683 point <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
   7684 unsigned integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the results
   7685 are undefined.
   7686 
   7687 Example:
   7688 """"""""
   7689 
   7690 .. code-block:: llvm
   7691 
   7692       %X = fptoui double 123.0 to i32      ; yields i32:123
   7693       %Y = fptoui float 1.0E+300 to i1     ; yields undefined:1
   7694       %Z = fptoui float 1.04E+17 to i8     ; yields undefined:1
   7695 
   7696 '``fptosi .. to``' Instruction
   7697 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7698 
   7699 Syntax:
   7700 """""""
   7701 
   7702 ::
   7703 
   7704       <result> = fptosi <ty> <value> to <ty2>             ; yields ty2
   7705 
   7706 Overview:
   7707 """""""""
   7708 
   7709 The '``fptosi``' instruction converts :ref:`floating point <t_floating>`
   7710 ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
   7711 
   7712 Arguments:
   7713 """"""""""
   7714 
   7715 The '``fptosi``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
   7716 scalar or vector :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
   7717 cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
   7718 ``ty`` is a vector floating point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
   7719 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
   7720 
   7721 Semantics:
   7722 """"""""""
   7723 
   7724 The '``fptosi``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating
   7725 point <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
   7726 signed integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the results
   7727 are undefined.
   7728 
   7729 Example:
   7730 """"""""
   7731 
   7732 .. code-block:: llvm
   7733 
   7734       %X = fptosi double -123.0 to i32      ; yields i32:-123
   7735       %Y = fptosi float 1.0E-247 to i1      ; yields undefined:1
   7736       %Z = fptosi float 1.04E+17 to i8      ; yields undefined:1
   7737 
   7738 '``uitofp .. to``' Instruction
   7739 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7740 
   7741 Syntax:
   7742 """""""
   7743 
   7744 ::
   7745 
   7746       <result> = uitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2>             ; yields ty2
   7747 
   7748 Overview:
   7749 """""""""
   7750 
   7751 The '``uitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as an unsigned integer
   7752 and converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
   7753 
   7754 Arguments:
   7755 """"""""""
   7756 
   7757 The '``uitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
   7758 scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
   7759 ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type. If
   7760 ``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating point
   7761 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
   7762 
   7763 Semantics:
   7764 """"""""""
   7765 
   7766 The '``uitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as an unsigned
   7767 integer quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point
   7768 value. If the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results
   7769 are undefined.
   7770 
   7771 Example:
   7772 """"""""
   7773 
   7774 .. code-block:: llvm
   7775 
   7776       %X = uitofp i32 257 to float         ; yields float:257.0
   7777       %Y = uitofp i8 -1 to double          ; yields double:255.0
   7778 
   7779 '``sitofp .. to``' Instruction
   7780 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7781 
   7782 Syntax:
   7783 """""""
   7784 
   7785 ::
   7786 
   7787       <result> = sitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2>             ; yields ty2
   7788 
   7789 Overview:
   7790 """""""""
   7791 
   7792 The '``sitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as a signed integer and
   7793 converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
   7794 
   7795 Arguments:
   7796 """"""""""
   7797 
   7798 The '``sitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
   7799 scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
   7800 ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type. If
   7801 ``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating point
   7802 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
   7803 
   7804 Semantics:
   7805 """"""""""
   7806 
   7807 The '``sitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as a signed integer
   7808 quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point value. If
   7809 the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results are
   7810 undefined.
   7811 
   7812 Example:
   7813 """"""""
   7814 
   7815 .. code-block:: llvm
   7816 
   7817       %X = sitofp i32 257 to float         ; yields float:257.0
   7818       %Y = sitofp i8 -1 to double          ; yields double:-1.0
   7819 
   7820 .. _i_ptrtoint:
   7821 
   7822 '``ptrtoint .. to``' Instruction
   7823 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7824 
   7825 Syntax:
   7826 """""""
   7827 
   7828 ::
   7829 
   7830       <result> = ptrtoint <ty> <value> to <ty2>             ; yields ty2
   7831 
   7832 Overview:
   7833 """""""""
   7834 
   7835 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts the pointer or a vector of
   7836 pointers ``value`` to the integer (or vector of integers) type ``ty2``.
   7837 
   7838 Arguments:
   7839 """"""""""
   7840 
   7841 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction takes a ``value`` to cast, which must be
   7842 a value of type :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or a vector of pointers, and a
   7843 type to cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
   7844 a vector of integers type.
   7845 
   7846 Semantics:
   7847 """"""""""
   7848 
   7849 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts ``value`` to integer type
   7850 ``ty2`` by interpreting the pointer value as an integer and either
   7851 truncating or zero extending that value to the size of the integer type.
   7852 If ``value`` is smaller than ``ty2`` then a zero extension is done. If
   7853 ``value`` is larger than ``ty2`` then a truncation is done. If they are
   7854 the same size, then nothing is done (*no-op cast*) other than a type
   7855 change.
   7856 
   7857 Example:
   7858 """"""""
   7859 
   7860 .. code-block:: llvm
   7861 
   7862       %X = ptrtoint i32* %P to i8                         ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
   7863       %Y = ptrtoint i32* %P to i64                        ; yields zero extension on 32-bit architecture
   7864       %Z = ptrtoint <4 x i32*> %P to <4 x i64>; yields vector zero extension for a vector of addresses on 32-bit architecture
   7865 
   7866 .. _i_inttoptr:
   7867 
   7868 '``inttoptr .. to``' Instruction
   7869 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7870 
   7871 Syntax:
   7872 """""""
   7873 
   7874 ::
   7875 
   7876       <result> = inttoptr <ty> <value> to <ty2>             ; yields ty2
   7877 
   7878 Overview:
   7879 """""""""
   7880 
   7881 The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts an integer ``value`` to a
   7882 pointer type, ``ty2``.
   7883 
   7884 Arguments:
   7885 """"""""""
   7886 
   7887 The '``inttoptr``' instruction takes an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value to
   7888 cast, and a type to cast it to, which must be a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>`
   7889 type.
   7890 
   7891 Semantics:
   7892 """"""""""
   7893 
   7894 The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` by
   7895 applying either a zero extension or a truncation depending on the size
   7896 of the integer ``value``. If ``value`` is larger than the size of a
   7897 pointer then a truncation is done. If ``value`` is smaller than the size
   7898 of a pointer then a zero extension is done. If they are the same size,
   7899 nothing is done (*no-op cast*).
   7900 
   7901 Example:
   7902 """"""""
   7903 
   7904 .. code-block:: llvm
   7905 
   7906       %X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32*          ; yields zero extension on 64-bit architecture
   7907       %Y = inttoptr i32 255 to i32*          ; yields no-op on 32-bit architecture
   7908       %Z = inttoptr i64 0 to i32*            ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
   7909       %Z = inttoptr <4 x i32> %G to <4 x i8*>; yields truncation of vector G to four pointers
   7910 
   7911 .. _i_bitcast:
   7912 
   7913 '``bitcast .. to``' Instruction
   7914 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7915 
   7916 Syntax:
   7917 """""""
   7918 
   7919 ::
   7920 
   7921       <result> = bitcast <ty> <value> to <ty2>             ; yields ty2
   7922 
   7923 Overview:
   7924 """""""""
   7925 
   7926 The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` without
   7927 changing any bits.
   7928 
   7929 Arguments:
   7930 """"""""""
   7931 
   7932 The '``bitcast``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
   7933 non-aggregate first class value, and a type to cast it to, which must
   7934 also be a non-aggregate :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. The
   7935 bit sizes of ``value`` and the destination type, ``ty2``, must be
   7936 identical. If the source type is a pointer, the destination type must
   7937 also be a pointer of the same size. This instruction supports bitwise
   7938 conversion of vectors to integers and to vectors of other types (as
   7939 long as they have the same size).
   7940 
   7941 Semantics:
   7942 """"""""""
   7943 
   7944 The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2``. It
   7945 is always a *no-op cast* because no bits change with this
   7946 conversion. The conversion is done as if the ``value`` had been stored
   7947 to memory and read back as type ``ty2``. Pointer (or vector of
   7948 pointers) types may only be converted to other pointer (or vector of
   7949 pointers) types with the same address space through this instruction.
   7950 To convert pointers to other types, use the :ref:`inttoptr <i_inttoptr>`
   7951 or :ref:`ptrtoint <i_ptrtoint>` instructions first.
   7952 
   7953 Example:
   7954 """"""""
   7955 
   7956 .. code-block:: llvm
   7957 
   7958       %X = bitcast i8 255 to i8              ; yields i8 :-1
   7959       %Y = bitcast i32* %x to sint*          ; yields sint*:%x
   7960       %Z = bitcast <2 x int> %V to i64;        ; yields i64: %V
   7961       %Z = bitcast <2 x i32*> %V to <2 x i64*> ; yields <2 x i64*>
   7962 
   7963 .. _i_addrspacecast:
   7964 
   7965 '``addrspacecast .. to``' Instruction
   7966 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   7967 
   7968 Syntax:
   7969 """""""
   7970 
   7971 ::
   7972 
   7973       <result> = addrspacecast <pty> <ptrval> to <pty2>       ; yields pty2
   7974 
   7975 Overview:
   7976 """""""""
   7977 
   7978 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts ``ptrval`` from ``pty`` in
   7979 address space ``n`` to type ``pty2`` in address space ``m``.
   7980 
   7981 Arguments:
   7982 """"""""""
   7983 
   7984 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction takes a pointer or vector of pointer value
   7985 to cast and a pointer type to cast it to, which must have a different
   7986 address space.
   7987 
   7988 Semantics:
   7989 """"""""""
   7990 
   7991 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts the pointer value
   7992 ``ptrval`` to type ``pty2``. It can be a *no-op cast* or a complex
   7993 value modification, depending on the target and the address space
   7994 pair. Pointer conversions within the same address space must be
   7995 performed with the ``bitcast`` instruction. Note that if the address space
   7996 conversion is legal then both result and operand refer to the same memory
   7997 location.
   7998 
   7999 Example:
   8000 """"""""
   8001 
   8002 .. code-block:: llvm
   8003 
   8004       %X = addrspacecast i32* %x to i32 addrspace(1)*    ; yields i32 addrspace(1)*:%x
   8005       %Y = addrspacecast i32 addrspace(1)* %y to i64 addrspace(2)*    ; yields i64 addrspace(2)*:%y
   8006       %Z = addrspacecast <4 x i32*> %z to <4 x float addrspace(3)*>   ; yields <4 x float addrspace(3)*>:%z
   8007 
   8008 .. _otherops:
   8009 
   8010 Other Operations
   8011 ----------------
   8012 
   8013 The instructions in this category are the "miscellaneous" instructions,
   8014 which defy better classification.
   8015 
   8016 .. _i_icmp:
   8017 
   8018 '``icmp``' Instruction
   8019 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8020 
   8021 Syntax:
   8022 """""""
   8023 
   8024 ::
   8025 
   8026       <result> = icmp <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2>   ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
   8027 
   8028 Overview:
   8029 """""""""
   8030 
   8031 The '``icmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or a vector of
   8032 boolean values based on comparison of its two integer, integer vector,
   8033 pointer, or pointer vector operands.
   8034 
   8035 Arguments:
   8036 """"""""""
   8037 
   8038 The '``icmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
   8039 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
   8040 not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition code are:
   8041 
   8042 #. ``eq``: equal
   8043 #. ``ne``: not equal
   8044 #. ``ugt``: unsigned greater than
   8045 #. ``uge``: unsigned greater or equal
   8046 #. ``ult``: unsigned less than
   8047 #. ``ule``: unsigned less or equal
   8048 #. ``sgt``: signed greater than
   8049 #. ``sge``: signed greater or equal
   8050 #. ``slt``: signed less than
   8051 #. ``sle``: signed less or equal
   8052 
   8053 The remaining two arguments must be :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
   8054 :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or integer :ref:`vector <t_vector>` typed. They
   8055 must also be identical types.
   8056 
   8057 Semantics:
   8058 """"""""""
   8059 
   8060 The '``icmp``' compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the condition
   8061 code given as ``cond``. The comparison performed always yields either an
   8062 :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` or vector of ``i1`` result, as follows:
   8063 
   8064 #. ``eq``: yields ``true`` if the operands are equal, ``false``
   8065    otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
   8066 #. ``ne``: yields ``true`` if the operands are unequal, ``false``
   8067    otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
   8068 #. ``ugt``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
   8069    ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
   8070 #. ``uge``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
   8071    ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
   8072 #. ``ult``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
   8073    ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
   8074 #. ``ule``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
   8075    ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
   8076 #. ``sgt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
   8077    if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
   8078 #. ``sge``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
   8079    if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
   8080 #. ``slt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
   8081    if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
   8082 #. ``sle``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
   8083    if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
   8084 
   8085 If the operands are :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` typed, the pointer values
   8086 are compared as if they were integers.
   8087 
   8088 If the operands are integer vectors, then they are compared element by
   8089 element. The result is an ``i1`` vector with the same number of elements
   8090 as the values being compared. Otherwise, the result is an ``i1``.
   8091 
   8092 Example:
   8093 """"""""
   8094 
   8095 .. code-block:: llvm
   8096 
   8097       <result> = icmp eq i32 4, 5          ; yields: result=false
   8098       <result> = icmp ne float* %X, %X     ; yields: result=false
   8099       <result> = icmp ult i16  4, 5        ; yields: result=true
   8100       <result> = icmp sgt i16  4, 5        ; yields: result=false
   8101       <result> = icmp ule i16 -4, 5        ; yields: result=false
   8102       <result> = icmp sge i16  4, 5        ; yields: result=false
   8103 
   8104 Note that the code generator does not yet support vector types with the
   8105 ``icmp`` instruction.
   8106 
   8107 .. _i_fcmp:
   8108 
   8109 '``fcmp``' Instruction
   8110 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8111 
   8112 Syntax:
   8113 """""""
   8114 
   8115 ::
   8116 
   8117       <result> = fcmp [fast-math flags]* <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2>     ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
   8118 
   8119 Overview:
   8120 """""""""
   8121 
   8122 The '``fcmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or vector of boolean
   8123 values based on comparison of its operands.
   8124 
   8125 If the operands are floating point scalars, then the result type is a
   8126 boolean (:ref:`i1 <t_integer>`).
   8127 
   8128 If the operands are floating point vectors, then the result type is a
   8129 vector of boolean with the same number of elements as the operands being
   8130 compared.
   8131 
   8132 Arguments:
   8133 """"""""""
   8134 
   8135 The '``fcmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
   8136 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
   8137 not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition code are:
   8138 
   8139 #. ``false``: no comparison, always returns false
   8140 #. ``oeq``: ordered and equal
   8141 #. ``ogt``: ordered and greater than
   8142 #. ``oge``: ordered and greater than or equal
   8143 #. ``olt``: ordered and less than
   8144 #. ``ole``: ordered and less than or equal
   8145 #. ``one``: ordered and not equal
   8146 #. ``ord``: ordered (no nans)
   8147 #. ``ueq``: unordered or equal
   8148 #. ``ugt``: unordered or greater than
   8149 #. ``uge``: unordered or greater than or equal
   8150 #. ``ult``: unordered or less than
   8151 #. ``ule``: unordered or less than or equal
   8152 #. ``une``: unordered or not equal
   8153 #. ``uno``: unordered (either nans)
   8154 #. ``true``: no comparison, always returns true
   8155 
   8156 *Ordered* means that neither operand is a QNAN while *unordered* means
   8157 that either operand may be a QNAN.
   8158 
   8159 Each of ``val1`` and ``val2`` arguments must be either a :ref:`floating
   8160 point <t_floating>` type or a :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point
   8161 type. They must have identical types.
   8162 
   8163 Semantics:
   8164 """"""""""
   8165 
   8166 The '``fcmp``' instruction compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the
   8167 condition code given as ``cond``. If the operands are vectors, then the
   8168 vectors are compared element by element. Each comparison performed
   8169 always yields an :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` result, as follows:
   8170 
   8171 #. ``false``: always yields ``false``, regardless of operands.
   8172 #. ``oeq``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
   8173    is equal to ``op2``.
   8174 #. ``ogt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
   8175    is greater than ``op2``.
   8176 #. ``oge``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
   8177    is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
   8178 #. ``olt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
   8179    is less than ``op2``.
   8180 #. ``ole``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
   8181    is less than or equal to ``op2``.
   8182 #. ``one``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
   8183    is not equal to ``op2``.
   8184 #. ``ord``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN.
   8185 #. ``ueq``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
   8186    equal to ``op2``.
   8187 #. ``ugt``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
   8188    greater than ``op2``.
   8189 #. ``uge``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
   8190    greater than or equal to ``op2``.
   8191 #. ``ult``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
   8192    less than ``op2``.
   8193 #. ``ule``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
   8194    less than or equal to ``op2``.
   8195 #. ``une``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
   8196    not equal to ``op2``.
   8197 #. ``uno``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN.
   8198 #. ``true``: always yields ``true``, regardless of operands.
   8199 
   8200 The ``fcmp`` instruction can also optionally take any number of
   8201 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
   8202 otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations.
   8203 
   8204 Any set of fast-math flags are legal on an ``fcmp`` instruction, but the
   8205 only flags that have any effect on its semantics are those that allow
   8206 assumptions to be made about the values of input arguments; namely
   8207 ``nnan``, ``ninf``, and ``nsz``. See :ref:`fastmath` for more information.
   8208 
   8209 Example:
   8210 """"""""
   8211 
   8212 .. code-block:: llvm
   8213 
   8214       <result> = fcmp oeq float 4.0, 5.0    ; yields: result=false
   8215       <result> = fcmp one float 4.0, 5.0    ; yields: result=true
   8216       <result> = fcmp olt float 4.0, 5.0    ; yields: result=true
   8217       <result> = fcmp ueq double 1.0, 2.0   ; yields: result=false
   8218 
   8219 Note that the code generator does not yet support vector types with the
   8220 ``fcmp`` instruction.
   8221 
   8222 .. _i_phi:
   8223 
   8224 '``phi``' Instruction
   8225 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8226 
   8227 Syntax:
   8228 """""""
   8229 
   8230 ::
   8231 
   8232       <result> = phi <ty> [ <val0>, <label0>], ...
   8233 
   8234 Overview:
   8235 """""""""
   8236 
   8237 The '``phi``' instruction is used to implement the  node in the SSA
   8238 graph representing the function.
   8239 
   8240 Arguments:
   8241 """"""""""
   8242 
   8243 The type of the incoming values is specified with the first type field.
   8244 After this, the '``phi``' instruction takes a list of pairs as
   8245 arguments, with one pair for each predecessor basic block of the current
   8246 block. Only values of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type may be used as
   8247 the value arguments to the PHI node. Only labels may be used as the
   8248 label arguments.
   8249 
   8250 There must be no non-phi instructions between the start of a basic block
   8251 and the PHI instructions: i.e. PHI instructions must be first in a basic
   8252 block.
   8253 
   8254 For the purposes of the SSA form, the use of each incoming value is
   8255 deemed to occur on the edge from the corresponding predecessor block to
   8256 the current block (but after any definition of an '``invoke``'
   8257 instruction's return value on the same edge).
   8258 
   8259 Semantics:
   8260 """"""""""
   8261 
   8262 At runtime, the '``phi``' instruction logically takes on the value
   8263 specified by the pair corresponding to the predecessor basic block that
   8264 executed just prior to the current block.
   8265 
   8266 Example:
   8267 """"""""
   8268 
   8269 .. code-block:: llvm
   8270 
   8271     Loop:       ; Infinite loop that counts from 0 on up...
   8272       %indvar = phi i32 [ 0, %LoopHeader ], [ %nextindvar, %Loop ]
   8273       %nextindvar = add i32 %indvar, 1
   8274       br label %Loop
   8275 
   8276 .. _i_select:
   8277 
   8278 '``select``' Instruction
   8279 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8280 
   8281 Syntax:
   8282 """""""
   8283 
   8284 ::
   8285 
   8286       <result> = select selty <cond>, <ty> <val1>, <ty> <val2>             ; yields ty
   8287 
   8288       selty is either i1 or {<N x i1>}
   8289 
   8290 Overview:
   8291 """""""""
   8292 
   8293 The '``select``' instruction is used to choose one value based on a
   8294 condition, without IR-level branching.
   8295 
   8296 Arguments:
   8297 """"""""""
   8298 
   8299 The '``select``' instruction requires an 'i1' value or a vector of 'i1'
   8300 values indicating the condition, and two values of the same :ref:`first
   8301 class <t_firstclass>` type.
   8302 
   8303 Semantics:
   8304 """"""""""
   8305 
   8306 If the condition is an i1 and it evaluates to 1, the instruction returns
   8307 the first value argument; otherwise, it returns the second value
   8308 argument.
   8309 
   8310 If the condition is a vector of i1, then the value arguments must be
   8311 vectors of the same size, and the selection is done element by element.
   8312 
   8313 If the condition is an i1 and the value arguments are vectors of the
   8314 same size, then an entire vector is selected.
   8315 
   8316 Example:
   8317 """"""""
   8318 
   8319 .. code-block:: llvm
   8320 
   8321       %X = select i1 true, i8 17, i8 42          ; yields i8:17
   8322 
   8323 .. _i_call:
   8324 
   8325 '``call``' Instruction
   8326 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8327 
   8328 Syntax:
   8329 """""""
   8330 
   8331 ::
   8332 
   8333       <result> = [tail | musttail | notail ] call [fast-math flags] [cconv] [ret attrs] <ty> [<fnty>*] <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
   8334                    [ operand bundles ]
   8335 
   8336 Overview:
   8337 """""""""
   8338 
   8339 The '``call``' instruction represents a simple function call.
   8340 
   8341 Arguments:
   8342 """"""""""
   8343 
   8344 This instruction requires several arguments:
   8345 
   8346 #. The optional ``tail`` and ``musttail`` markers indicate that the optimizers
   8347    should perform tail call optimization. The ``tail`` marker is a hint that
   8348    `can be ignored <CodeGenerator.html#sibcallopt>`_. The ``musttail`` marker
   8349    means that the call must be tail call optimized in order for the program to
   8350    be correct. The ``musttail`` marker provides these guarantees:
   8351 
   8352    #. The call will not cause unbounded stack growth if it is part of a
   8353       recursive cycle in the call graph.
   8354    #. Arguments with the :ref:`inalloca <attr_inalloca>` attribute are
   8355       forwarded in place.
   8356 
   8357    Both markers imply that the callee does not access allocas or varargs from
   8358    the caller. Calls marked ``musttail`` must obey the following additional
   8359    rules:
   8360 
   8361    - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction,
   8362      or a pointer bitcast followed by a ret instruction.
   8363    - The ret instruction must return the (possibly bitcasted) value
   8364      produced by the call or void.
   8365    - The caller and callee prototypes must match. Pointer types of
   8366      parameters or return types may differ in pointee type, but not
   8367      in address space.
   8368    - The calling conventions of the caller and callee must match.
   8369    - All ABI-impacting function attributes, such as sret, byval, inreg,
   8370      returned, and inalloca, must match.
   8371    - The callee must be varargs iff the caller is varargs. Bitcasting a
   8372      non-varargs function to the appropriate varargs type is legal so
   8373      long as the non-varargs prefixes obey the other rules.
   8374 
   8375    Tail call optimization for calls marked ``tail`` is guaranteed to occur if
   8376    the following conditions are met:
   8377 
   8378    -  Caller and callee both have the calling convention ``fastcc``.
   8379    -  The call is in tail position (ret immediately follows call and ret
   8380       uses value of call or is void).
   8381    -  Option ``-tailcallopt`` is enabled, or
   8382       ``llvm::GuaranteedTailCallOpt`` is ``true``.
   8383    -  `Platform-specific constraints are
   8384       met. <CodeGenerator.html#tailcallopt>`_
   8385 
   8386 #. The optional ``notail`` marker indicates that the optimizers should not add
   8387    ``tail`` or ``musttail`` markers to the call. It is used to prevent tail
   8388    call optimization from being performed on the call.
   8389 
   8390 #. The optional ``fast-math flags`` marker indicates that the call has one or more 
   8391    :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
   8392    otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations. Fast-math flags are only valid
   8393    for calls that return a floating-point scalar or vector type.
   8394 
   8395 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
   8396    convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
   8397    specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions. The
   8398    calling convention of the call must match the calling convention of
   8399    the target function, or else the behavior is undefined.
   8400 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
   8401    values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
   8402    are valid here.
   8403 #. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
   8404    type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
   8405    ``void``.
   8406 #. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the pointer to function value
   8407    being invoked. The argument types must match the types implied by
   8408    this signature. This type can be omitted if the function is not
   8409    varargs and if the function type does not return a pointer to a
   8410    function.
   8411 #. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
   8412    be invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but
   8413    indirect ``call``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
   8414    to function value.
   8415 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
   8416    signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
   8417    be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
   8418    indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
   8419    extra arguments can be specified.
   8420 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list. Only
   8421    '``noreturn``', '``nounwind``', '``readonly``' and '``readnone``'
   8422    attributes are valid here.
   8423 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
   8424 
   8425 Semantics:
   8426 """"""""""
   8427 
   8428 The '``call``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to
   8429 a specified function, with its incoming arguments bound to the specified
   8430 values. Upon a '``ret``' instruction in the called function, control
   8431 flow continues with the instruction after the function call, and the
   8432 return value of the function is bound to the result argument.
   8433 
   8434 Example:
   8435 """"""""
   8436 
   8437 .. code-block:: llvm
   8438 
   8439       %retval = call i32 @test(i32 %argc)
   8440       call i32 (i8*, ...)* @printf(i8* %msg, i32 12, i8 42)        ; yields i32
   8441       %X = tail call i32 @foo()                                    ; yields i32
   8442       %Y = tail call fastcc i32 @foo()  ; yields i32
   8443       call void %foo(i8 97 signext)
   8444 
   8445       %struct.A = type { i32, i8 }
   8446       %r = call %struct.A @foo()                        ; yields { i32, i8 }
   8447       %gr = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 0                ; yields i32
   8448       %gr1 = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 1               ; yields i8
   8449       %Z = call void @foo() noreturn                    ; indicates that %foo never returns normally
   8450       %ZZ = call zeroext i32 @bar()                     ; Return value is %zero extended
   8451 
   8452 llvm treats calls to some functions with names and arguments that match
   8453 the standard C99 library as being the C99 library functions, and may
   8454 perform optimizations or generate code for them under that assumption.
   8455 This is something we'd like to change in the future to provide better
   8456 support for freestanding environments and non-C-based languages.
   8457 
   8458 .. _i_va_arg:
   8459 
   8460 '``va_arg``' Instruction
   8461 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8462 
   8463 Syntax:
   8464 """""""
   8465 
   8466 ::
   8467 
   8468       <resultval> = va_arg <va_list*> <arglist>, <argty>
   8469 
   8470 Overview:
   8471 """""""""
   8472 
   8473 The '``va_arg``' instruction is used to access arguments passed through
   8474 the "variable argument" area of a function call. It is used to implement
   8475 the ``va_arg`` macro in C.
   8476 
   8477 Arguments:
   8478 """"""""""
   8479 
   8480 This instruction takes a ``va_list*`` value and the type of the
   8481 argument. It returns a value of the specified argument type and
   8482 increments the ``va_list`` to point to the next argument. The actual
   8483 type of ``va_list`` is target specific.
   8484 
   8485 Semantics:
   8486 """"""""""
   8487 
   8488 The '``va_arg``' instruction loads an argument of the specified type
   8489 from the specified ``va_list`` and causes the ``va_list`` to point to
   8490 the next argument. For more information, see the variable argument
   8491 handling :ref:`Intrinsic Functions <int_varargs>`.
   8492 
   8493 It is legal for this instruction to be called in a function which does
   8494 not take a variable number of arguments, for example, the ``vfprintf``
   8495 function.
   8496 
   8497 ``va_arg`` is an LLVM instruction instead of an :ref:`intrinsic
   8498 function <intrinsics>` because it takes a type as an argument.
   8499 
   8500 Example:
   8501 """"""""
   8502 
   8503 See the :ref:`variable argument processing <int_varargs>` section.
   8504 
   8505 Note that the code generator does not yet fully support va\_arg on many
   8506 targets. Also, it does not currently support va\_arg with aggregate
   8507 types on any target.
   8508 
   8509 .. _i_landingpad:
   8510 
   8511 '``landingpad``' Instruction
   8512 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8513 
   8514 Syntax:
   8515 """""""
   8516 
   8517 ::
   8518 
   8519       <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> <clause>+
   8520       <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> cleanup <clause>*
   8521 
   8522       <clause> := catch <type> <value>
   8523       <clause> := filter <array constant type> <array constant>
   8524 
   8525 Overview:
   8526 """""""""
   8527 
   8528 The '``landingpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
   8529 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
   8530 is a landing pad --- one where the exception lands, and corresponds to the
   8531 code found in the ``catch`` portion of a ``try``/``catch`` sequence. It
   8532 defines values supplied by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon
   8533 re-entry to the function. The ``resultval`` has the type ``resultty``.
   8534 
   8535 Arguments:
   8536 """"""""""
   8537 
   8538 The optional
   8539 ``cleanup`` flag indicates that the landing pad block is a cleanup.
   8540 
   8541 A ``clause`` begins with the clause type --- ``catch`` or ``filter`` --- and
   8542 contains the global variable representing the "type" that may be caught
   8543 or filtered respectively. Unlike the ``catch`` clause, the ``filter``
   8544 clause takes an array constant as its argument. Use
   8545 "``[0 x i8**] undef``" for a filter which cannot throw. The
   8546 '``landingpad``' instruction must contain *at least* one ``clause`` or
   8547 the ``cleanup`` flag.
   8548 
   8549 Semantics:
   8550 """"""""""
   8551 
   8552 The '``landingpad``' instruction defines the values which are set by the
   8553 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the function, and
   8554 therefore the "result type" of the ``landingpad`` instruction. As with
   8555 calling conventions, how the personality function results are
   8556 represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
   8557 
   8558 The clauses are applied in order from top to bottom. If two
   8559 ``landingpad`` instructions are merged together through inlining, the
   8560 clauses from the calling function are appended to the list of clauses.
   8561 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
   8562 the exception is compared against each ``clause`` in turn. If it doesn't
   8563 match any of the clauses, and the ``cleanup`` flag is not set, then
   8564 unwinding continues further up the call stack.
   8565 
   8566 The ``landingpad`` instruction has several restrictions:
   8567 
   8568 -  A landing pad block is a basic block which is the unwind destination
   8569    of an '``invoke``' instruction.
   8570 -  A landing pad block must have a '``landingpad``' instruction as its
   8571    first non-PHI instruction.
   8572 -  There can be only one '``landingpad``' instruction within the landing
   8573    pad block.
   8574 -  A basic block that is not a landing pad block may not include a
   8575    '``landingpad``' instruction.
   8576 
   8577 Example:
   8578 """"""""
   8579 
   8580 .. code-block:: llvm
   8581 
   8582       ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer.
   8583       %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
   8584                catch i8** @_ZTIi
   8585       ;; A landing pad that is a cleanup.
   8586       %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
   8587                cleanup
   8588       ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer and can only throw a double.
   8589       %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
   8590                catch i8** @_ZTIi
   8591                filter [1 x i8**] [@_ZTId]
   8592 
   8593 .. _i_cleanuppad:
   8594 
   8595 '``cleanuppad``' Instruction
   8596 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8597 
   8598 Syntax:
   8599 """""""
   8600 
   8601 ::
   8602 
   8603       <resultval> = cleanuppad within <parent> [<args>*]
   8604 
   8605 Overview:
   8606 """""""""
   8607 
   8608 The '``cleanuppad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
   8609 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
   8610 is a cleanup block --- one where a personality routine attempts to
   8611 transfer control to run cleanup actions.
   8612 The ``args`` correspond to whatever additional
   8613 information the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` requires to
   8614 execute the cleanup.
   8615 The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to
   8616 match the ``cleanuppad`` to corresponding :ref:`cleanuprets <i_cleanupret>`.
   8617 The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
   8618 ``cleanuppad`` instruction. If the ``cleanuppad`` is not inside a funclet,
   8619 this operand may be the token ``none``.
   8620 
   8621 Arguments:
   8622 """"""""""
   8623 
   8624 The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted
   8625 by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>`.
   8626 
   8627 Semantics:
   8628 """"""""""
   8629 
   8630 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
   8631 the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` transfers control to the
   8632 ``cleanuppad`` with the aid of the personality-specific arguments.
   8633 As with calling conventions, how the personality function results are
   8634 represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
   8635 
   8636 The ``cleanuppad`` instruction has several restrictions:
   8637 
   8638 -  A cleanup block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of
   8639    an exceptional instruction.
   8640 -  A cleanup block must have a '``cleanuppad``' instruction as its
   8641    first non-PHI instruction.
   8642 -  There can be only one '``cleanuppad``' instruction within the
   8643    cleanup block.
   8644 -  A basic block that is not a cleanup block may not include a
   8645    '``cleanuppad``' instruction.
   8646 
   8647 Executing a ``cleanuppad`` instruction constitutes "entering" that pad.
   8648 The pad may then be "exited" in one of three ways:
   8649 
   8650 1)  explicitly via a ``cleanupret`` that consumes it.  Executing such a ``cleanupret``
   8651     is undefined behavior if any descendant pads have been entered but not yet
   8652     exited.
   8653 2)  implicitly via a call (which unwinds all the way to the current function's caller),
   8654     or via a ``catchswitch`` or a ``cleanupret`` that unwinds to caller.
   8655 3)  implicitly via an unwind edge whose destination EH pad isn't a descendant of
   8656     the ``cleanuppad``.  When the ``cleanuppad`` is exited in this manner, it is
   8657     undefined behavior if the destination EH pad has a parent which is not an
   8658     ancestor of the ``cleanuppad`` being exited.
   8659 
   8660 It is undefined behavior for the ``cleanuppad`` to exit via an unwind edge which
   8661 does not transitively unwind to the same destination as a constituent
   8662 ``cleanupret``.
   8663 
   8664 Example:
   8665 """"""""
   8666 
   8667 .. code-block:: llvm
   8668 
   8669       %tok = cleanuppad within %cs []
   8670 
   8671 .. _intrinsics:
   8672 
   8673 Intrinsic Functions
   8674 ===================
   8675 
   8676 LLVM supports the notion of an "intrinsic function". These functions
   8677 have well known names and semantics and are required to follow certain
   8678 restrictions. Overall, these intrinsics represent an extension mechanism
   8679 for the LLVM language that does not require changing all of the
   8680 transformations in LLVM when adding to the language (or the bitcode
   8681 reader/writer, the parser, etc...).
   8682 
   8683 Intrinsic function names must all start with an "``llvm.``" prefix. This
   8684 prefix is reserved in LLVM for intrinsic names; thus, function names may
   8685 not begin with this prefix. Intrinsic functions must always be external
   8686 functions: you cannot define the body of intrinsic functions. Intrinsic
   8687 functions may only be used in call or invoke instructions: it is illegal
   8688 to take the address of an intrinsic function. Additionally, because
   8689 intrinsic functions are part of the LLVM language, it is required if any
   8690 are added that they be documented here.
   8691 
   8692 Some intrinsic functions can be overloaded, i.e., the intrinsic
   8693 represents a family of functions that perform the same operation but on
   8694 different data types. Because LLVM can represent over 8 million
   8695 different integer types, overloading is used commonly to allow an
   8696 intrinsic function to operate on any integer type. One or more of the
   8697 argument types or the result type can be overloaded to accept any
   8698 integer type. Argument types may also be defined as exactly matching a
   8699 previous argument's type or the result type. This allows an intrinsic
   8700 function which accepts multiple arguments, but needs all of them to be
   8701 of the same type, to only be overloaded with respect to a single
   8702 argument or the result.
   8703 
   8704 Overloaded intrinsics will have the names of its overloaded argument
   8705 types encoded into its function name, each preceded by a period. Only
   8706 those types which are overloaded result in a name suffix. Arguments
   8707 whose type is matched against another type do not. For example, the
   8708 ``llvm.ctpop`` function can take an integer of any width and returns an
   8709 integer of exactly the same integer width. This leads to a family of
   8710 functions such as ``i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %val)`` and
   8711 ``i29 @llvm.ctpop.i29(i29 %val)``. Only one type, the return type, is
   8712 overloaded, and only one type suffix is required. Because the argument's
   8713 type is matched against the return type, it does not require its own
   8714 name suffix.
   8715 
   8716 To learn how to add an intrinsic function, please see the `Extending
   8717 LLVM Guide <ExtendingLLVM.html>`_.
   8718 
   8719 .. _int_varargs:
   8720 
   8721 Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics
   8722 -------------------------------------
   8723 
   8724 Variable argument support is defined in LLVM with the
   8725 :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and these three intrinsic
   8726 functions. These functions are related to the similarly named macros
   8727 defined in the ``<stdarg.h>`` header file.
   8728 
   8729 All of these functions operate on arguments that use a target-specific
   8730 value type "``va_list``". The LLVM assembly language reference manual
   8731 does not define what this type is, so all transformations should be
   8732 prepared to handle these functions regardless of the type used.
   8733 
   8734 This example shows how the :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and the
   8735 variable argument handling intrinsic functions are used.
   8736 
   8737 .. code-block:: llvm
   8738 
   8739     ; This struct is different for every platform. For most platforms,
   8740     ; it is merely an i8*.
   8741     %struct.va_list = type { i8* }
   8742 
   8743     ; For Unix x86_64 platforms, va_list is the following struct:
   8744     ; %struct.va_list = type { i32, i32, i8*, i8* }
   8745 
   8746     define i32 @test(i32 %X, ...) {
   8747       ; Initialize variable argument processing
   8748       %ap = alloca %struct.va_list
   8749       %ap2 = bitcast %struct.va_list* %ap to i8*
   8750       call void @llvm.va_start(i8* %ap2)
   8751 
   8752       ; Read a single integer argument
   8753       %tmp = va_arg i8* %ap2, i32
   8754 
   8755       ; Demonstrate usage of llvm.va_copy and llvm.va_end
   8756       %aq = alloca i8*
   8757       %aq2 = bitcast i8** %aq to i8*
   8758       call void @llvm.va_copy(i8* %aq2, i8* %ap2)
   8759       call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %aq2)
   8760 
   8761       ; Stop processing of arguments.
   8762       call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %ap2)
   8763       ret i32 %tmp
   8764     }
   8765 
   8766     declare void @llvm.va_start(i8*)
   8767     declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8*, i8*)
   8768     declare void @llvm.va_end(i8*)
   8769 
   8770 .. _int_va_start:
   8771 
   8772 '``llvm.va_start``' Intrinsic
   8773 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8774 
   8775 Syntax:
   8776 """""""
   8777 
   8778 ::
   8779 
   8780       declare void @llvm.va_start(i8* <arglist>)
   8781 
   8782 Overview:
   8783 """""""""
   8784 
   8785 The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic initializes ``*<arglist>`` for
   8786 subsequent use by ``va_arg``.
   8787 
   8788 Arguments:
   8789 """"""""""
   8790 
   8791 The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
   8792 
   8793 Semantics:
   8794 """"""""""
   8795 
   8796 The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_start`` macro
   8797 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it initializes the
   8798 ``va_list`` element to which the argument points, so that the next call
   8799 to ``va_arg`` will produce the first variable argument passed to the
   8800 function. Unlike the C ``va_start`` macro, this intrinsic does not need
   8801 to know the last argument of the function as the compiler can figure
   8802 that out.
   8803 
   8804 '``llvm.va_end``' Intrinsic
   8805 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8806 
   8807 Syntax:
   8808 """""""
   8809 
   8810 ::
   8811 
   8812       declare void @llvm.va_end(i8* <arglist>)
   8813 
   8814 Overview:
   8815 """""""""
   8816 
   8817 The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic destroys ``*<arglist>``, which has been
   8818 initialized previously with ``llvm.va_start`` or ``llvm.va_copy``.
   8819 
   8820 Arguments:
   8821 """"""""""
   8822 
   8823 The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` to destroy.
   8824 
   8825 Semantics:
   8826 """"""""""
   8827 
   8828 The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_end`` macro
   8829 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it destroys the ``va_list``
   8830 element to which the argument points. Calls to
   8831 :ref:`llvm.va_start <int_va_start>` and
   8832 :ref:`llvm.va_copy <int_va_copy>` must be matched exactly with calls to
   8833 ``llvm.va_end``.
   8834 
   8835 .. _int_va_copy:
   8836 
   8837 '``llvm.va_copy``' Intrinsic
   8838 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8839 
   8840 Syntax:
   8841 """""""
   8842 
   8843 ::
   8844 
   8845       declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8* <destarglist>, i8* <srcarglist>)
   8846 
   8847 Overview:
   8848 """""""""
   8849 
   8850 The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic copies the current argument position
   8851 from the source argument list to the destination argument list.
   8852 
   8853 Arguments:
   8854 """"""""""
   8855 
   8856 The first argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
   8857 The second argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to copy from.
   8858 
   8859 Semantics:
   8860 """"""""""
   8861 
   8862 The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_copy`` macro
   8863 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it copies the source
   8864 ``va_list`` element into the destination ``va_list`` element. This
   8865 intrinsic is necessary because the `` llvm.va_start`` intrinsic may be
   8866 arbitrarily complex and require, for example, memory allocation.
   8867 
   8868 Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics
   8869 --------------------------------------
   8870 
   8871 LLVM's support for `Accurate Garbage Collection <GarbageCollection.html>`_
   8872 (GC) requires the frontend to generate code containing appropriate intrinsic
   8873 calls and select an appropriate GC strategy which knows how to lower these
   8874 intrinsics in a manner which is appropriate for the target collector.
   8875 
   8876 These intrinsics allow identification of :ref:`GC roots on the
   8877 stack <int_gcroot>`, as well as garbage collector implementations that
   8878 require :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers.
   8879 Frontends for type-safe garbage collected languages should generate
   8880 these intrinsics to make use of the LLVM garbage collectors. For more
   8881 details, see `Garbage Collection with LLVM <GarbageCollection.html>`_.
   8882 
   8883 Experimental Statepoint Intrinsics
   8884 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8885 
   8886 LLVM provides an second experimental set of intrinsics for describing garbage
   8887 collection safepoints in compiled code. These intrinsics are an alternative
   8888 to the ``llvm.gcroot`` intrinsics, but are compatible with the ones for
   8889 :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers. The
   8890 differences in approach are covered in the `Garbage Collection with LLVM
   8891 <GarbageCollection.html>`_ documentation. The intrinsics themselves are
   8892 described in :doc:`Statepoints`.
   8893 
   8894 .. _int_gcroot:
   8895 
   8896 '``llvm.gcroot``' Intrinsic
   8897 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8898 
   8899 Syntax:
   8900 """""""
   8901 
   8902 ::
   8903 
   8904       declare void @llvm.gcroot(i8** %ptrloc, i8* %metadata)
   8905 
   8906 Overview:
   8907 """""""""
   8908 
   8909 The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic declares the existence of a GC root to
   8910 the code generator, and allows some metadata to be associated with it.
   8911 
   8912 Arguments:
   8913 """"""""""
   8914 
   8915 The first argument specifies the address of a stack object that contains
   8916 the root pointer. The second pointer (which must be either a constant or
   8917 a global value address) contains the meta-data to be associated with the
   8918 root.
   8919 
   8920 Semantics:
   8921 """"""""""
   8922 
   8923 At runtime, a call to this intrinsic stores a null pointer into the
   8924 "ptrloc" location. At compile-time, the code generator generates
   8925 information to allow the runtime to find the pointer at GC safe points.
   8926 The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic may only be used in a function which
   8927 :ref:`specifies a GC algorithm <gc>`.
   8928 
   8929 .. _int_gcread:
   8930 
   8931 '``llvm.gcread``' Intrinsic
   8932 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8933 
   8934 Syntax:
   8935 """""""
   8936 
   8937 ::
   8938 
   8939       declare i8* @llvm.gcread(i8* %ObjPtr, i8** %Ptr)
   8940 
   8941 Overview:
   8942 """""""""
   8943 
   8944 The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic identifies reads of references from heap
   8945 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require read
   8946 barriers.
   8947 
   8948 Arguments:
   8949 """"""""""
   8950 
   8951 The second argument is the address to read from, which should be an
   8952 address allocated from the garbage collector. The first object is a
   8953 pointer to the start of the referenced object, if needed by the language
   8954 runtime (otherwise null).
   8955 
   8956 Semantics:
   8957 """"""""""
   8958 
   8959 The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a load
   8960 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
   8961 the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcread``'
   8962 intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
   8963 algorithm <gc>`.
   8964 
   8965 .. _int_gcwrite:
   8966 
   8967 '``llvm.gcwrite``' Intrinsic
   8968 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   8969 
   8970 Syntax:
   8971 """""""
   8972 
   8973 ::
   8974 
   8975       declare void @llvm.gcwrite(i8* %P1, i8* %Obj, i8** %P2)
   8976 
   8977 Overview:
   8978 """""""""
   8979 
   8980 The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic identifies writes of references to heap
   8981 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require write
   8982 barriers (such as generational or reference counting collectors).
   8983 
   8984 Arguments:
   8985 """"""""""
   8986 
   8987 The first argument is the reference to store, the second is the start of
   8988 the object to store it to, and the third is the address of the field of
   8989 Obj to store to. If the runtime does not require a pointer to the
   8990 object, Obj may be null.
   8991 
   8992 Semantics:
   8993 """"""""""
   8994 
   8995 The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a store
   8996 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
   8997 the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcwrite``'
   8998 intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
   8999 algorithm <gc>`.
   9000 
   9001 Code Generator Intrinsics
   9002 -------------------------
   9003 
   9004 These intrinsics are provided by LLVM to expose special features that
   9005 may only be implemented with code generator support.
   9006 
   9007 '``llvm.returnaddress``' Intrinsic
   9008 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9009 
   9010 Syntax:
   9011 """""""
   9012 
   9013 ::
   9014 
   9015       declare i8  *@llvm.returnaddress(i32 <level>)
   9016 
   9017 Overview:
   9018 """""""""
   9019 
   9020 The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic attempts to compute a
   9021 target-specific value indicating the return address of the current
   9022 function or one of its callers.
   9023 
   9024 Arguments:
   9025 """"""""""
   9026 
   9027 The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
   9028 address for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its
   9029 caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
   9030 value.
   9031 
   9032 Semantics:
   9033 """"""""""
   9034 
   9035 The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
   9036 indicating the return address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
   9037 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
   9038 be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
   9039 used for debugging purposes.
   9040 
   9041 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
   9042 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
   9043 of the obvious source-language caller.
   9044 
   9045 '``llvm.frameaddress``' Intrinsic
   9046 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9047 
   9048 Syntax:
   9049 """""""
   9050 
   9051 ::
   9052 
   9053       declare i8* @llvm.frameaddress(i32 <level>)
   9054 
   9055 Overview:
   9056 """""""""
   9057 
   9058 The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic attempts to return the
   9059 target-specific frame pointer value for the specified stack frame.
   9060 
   9061 Arguments:
   9062 """"""""""
   9063 
   9064 The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
   9065 frame pointer for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates
   9066 its caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
   9067 value.
   9068 
   9069 Semantics:
   9070 """"""""""
   9071 
   9072 The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
   9073 indicating the frame address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
   9074 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
   9075 be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
   9076 used for debugging purposes.
   9077 
   9078 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
   9079 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
   9080 of the obvious source-language caller.
   9081 
   9082 '``llvm.localescape``' and '``llvm.localrecover``' Intrinsics
   9083 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9084 
   9085 Syntax:
   9086 """""""
   9087 
   9088 ::
   9089 
   9090       declare void @llvm.localescape(...)
   9091       declare i8* @llvm.localrecover(i8* %func, i8* %fp, i32 %idx)
   9092 
   9093 Overview:
   9094 """""""""
   9095 
   9096 The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic escapes offsets of a collection of static
   9097 allocas, and the '``llvm.localrecover``' intrinsic applies those offsets to a
   9098 live frame pointer to recover the address of the allocation. The offset is
   9099 computed during frame layout of the caller of ``llvm.localescape``.
   9100 
   9101 Arguments:
   9102 """"""""""
   9103 
   9104 All arguments to '``llvm.localescape``' must be pointers to static allocas or
   9105 casts of static allocas. Each function can only call '``llvm.localescape``'
   9106 once, and it can only do so from the entry block.
   9107 
   9108 The ``func`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a constant
   9109 bitcasted pointer to a function defined in the current module. The code
   9110 generator cannot determine the frame allocation offset of functions defined in
   9111 other modules.
   9112 
   9113 The ``fp`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a frame pointer of a
   9114 call frame that is currently live. The return value of '``llvm.localaddress``'
   9115 is one way to produce such a value, but various runtimes also expose a suitable
   9116 pointer in platform-specific ways.
   9117 
   9118 The ``idx`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' indicates which alloca passed to
   9119 '``llvm.localescape``' to recover. It is zero-indexed.
   9120 
   9121 Semantics:
   9122 """"""""""
   9123 
   9124 These intrinsics allow a group of functions to share access to a set of local
   9125 stack allocations of a one parent function. The parent function may call the
   9126 '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic once from the function entry block, and the
   9127 child functions can use '``llvm.localrecover``' to access the escaped allocas.
   9128 The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic blocks inlining, as inlining changes where
   9129 the escaped allocas are allocated, which would break attempts to use
   9130 '``llvm.localrecover``'.
   9131 
   9132 .. _int_read_register:
   9133 .. _int_write_register:
   9134 
   9135 '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' Intrinsics
   9136 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9137 
   9138 Syntax:
   9139 """""""
   9140 
   9141 ::
   9142 
   9143       declare i32 @llvm.read_register.i32(metadata)
   9144       declare i64 @llvm.read_register.i64(metadata)
   9145       declare void @llvm.write_register.i32(metadata, i32 @value)
   9146       declare void @llvm.write_register.i64(metadata, i64 @value)
   9147       !0 = !{!"sp\00"}
   9148 
   9149 Overview:
   9150 """""""""
   9151 
   9152 The '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsics
   9153 provides access to the named register. The register must be valid on
   9154 the architecture being compiled to. The type needs to be compatible
   9155 with the register being read.
   9156 
   9157 Semantics:
   9158 """"""""""
   9159 
   9160 The '``llvm.read_register``' intrinsic returns the current value of the
   9161 register, where possible. The '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsic sets
   9162 the current value of the register, where possible.
   9163 
   9164 This is useful to implement named register global variables that need
   9165 to always be mapped to a specific register, as is common practice on
   9166 bare-metal programs including OS kernels.
   9167 
   9168 The compiler doesn't check for register availability or use of the used
   9169 register in surrounding code, including inline assembly. Because of that,
   9170 allocatable registers are not supported.
   9171 
   9172 Warning: So far it only works with the stack pointer on selected
   9173 architectures (ARM, AArch64, PowerPC and x86_64). Significant amount of
   9174 work is needed to support other registers and even more so, allocatable
   9175 registers.
   9176 
   9177 .. _int_stacksave:
   9178 
   9179 '``llvm.stacksave``' Intrinsic
   9180 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9181 
   9182 Syntax:
   9183 """""""
   9184 
   9185 ::
   9186 
   9187       declare i8* @llvm.stacksave()
   9188 
   9189 Overview:
   9190 """""""""
   9191 
   9192 The '``llvm.stacksave``' intrinsic is used to remember the current state
   9193 of the function stack, for use with
   9194 :ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. This is useful for
   9195 implementing language features like scoped automatic variable sized
   9196 arrays in C99.
   9197 
   9198 Semantics:
   9199 """"""""""
   9200 
   9201 This intrinsic returns a opaque pointer value that can be passed to
   9202 :ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. When an
   9203 ``llvm.stackrestore`` intrinsic is executed with a value saved from
   9204 ``llvm.stacksave``, it effectively restores the state of the stack to
   9205 the state it was in when the ``llvm.stacksave`` intrinsic executed. In
   9206 practice, this pops any :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>` blocks from the stack that
   9207 were allocated after the ``llvm.stacksave`` was executed.
   9208 
   9209 .. _int_stackrestore:
   9210 
   9211 '``llvm.stackrestore``' Intrinsic
   9212 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9213 
   9214 Syntax:
   9215 """""""
   9216 
   9217 ::
   9218 
   9219       declare void @llvm.stackrestore(i8* %ptr)
   9220 
   9221 Overview:
   9222 """""""""
   9223 
   9224 The '``llvm.stackrestore``' intrinsic is used to restore the state of
   9225 the function stack to the state it was in when the corresponding
   9226 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` intrinsic executed. This is
   9227 useful for implementing language features like scoped automatic variable
   9228 sized arrays in C99.
   9229 
   9230 Semantics:
   9231 """"""""""
   9232 
   9233 See the description for :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>`.
   9234 
   9235 .. _int_get_dynamic_area_offset:
   9236 
   9237 '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset``' Intrinsic
   9238 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9239 
   9240 Syntax:
   9241 """""""
   9242 
   9243 ::
   9244 
   9245       declare i32 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i32()
   9246       declare i64 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i64()
   9247 
   9248       Overview:
   9249       """""""""
   9250 
   9251       The '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.*``' intrinsic family is used to
   9252       get the offset from native stack pointer to the address of the most
   9253       recent dynamic alloca on the caller's stack. These intrinsics are
   9254       intendend for use in combination with
   9255       :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` to get a
   9256       pointer to the most recent dynamic alloca. This is useful, for example,
   9257       for AddressSanitizer's stack unpoisoning routines.
   9258 
   9259 Semantics:
   9260 """"""""""
   9261 
   9262       These intrinsics return a non-negative integer value that can be used to
   9263       get the address of the most recent dynamic alloca, allocated by :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>`
   9264       on the caller's stack. In particular, for targets where stack grows downwards,
   9265       adding this offset to the native stack pointer would get the address of the most
   9266       recent dynamic alloca. For targets where stack grows upwards, the situation is a bit more
   9267       complicated, because substracting this value from stack pointer would get the address
   9268       one past the end of the most recent dynamic alloca.
   9269 
   9270       Although for most targets `llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
   9271       returns just a zero, for others, such as PowerPC and PowerPC64, it returns a
   9272       compile-time-known constant value.
   9273 
   9274       The return value type of :ref:`llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
   9275       must match the target's generic address space's (address space 0) pointer type.
   9276 
   9277 '``llvm.prefetch``' Intrinsic
   9278 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9279 
   9280 Syntax:
   9281 """""""
   9282 
   9283 ::
   9284 
   9285       declare void @llvm.prefetch(i8* <address>, i32 <rw>, i32 <locality>, i32 <cache type>)
   9286 
   9287 Overview:
   9288 """""""""
   9289 
   9290 The '``llvm.prefetch``' intrinsic is a hint to the code generator to
   9291 insert a prefetch instruction if supported; otherwise, it is a noop.
   9292 Prefetches have no effect on the behavior of the program but can change
   9293 its performance characteristics.
   9294 
   9295 Arguments:
   9296 """"""""""
   9297 
   9298 ``address`` is the address to be prefetched, ``rw`` is the specifier
   9299 determining if the fetch should be for a read (0) or write (1), and
   9300 ``locality`` is a temporal locality specifier ranging from (0) - no
   9301 locality, to (3) - extremely local keep in cache. The ``cache type``
   9302 specifies whether the prefetch is performed on the data (1) or
   9303 instruction (0) cache. The ``rw``, ``locality`` and ``cache type``
   9304 arguments must be constant integers.
   9305 
   9306 Semantics:
   9307 """"""""""
   9308 
   9309 This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. In
   9310 particular, prefetches cannot trap and do not produce a value. On
   9311 targets that support this intrinsic, the prefetch can provide hints to
   9312 the processor cache for better performance.
   9313 
   9314 '``llvm.pcmarker``' Intrinsic
   9315 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9316 
   9317 Syntax:
   9318 """""""
   9319 
   9320 ::
   9321 
   9322       declare void @llvm.pcmarker(i32 <id>)
   9323 
   9324 Overview:
   9325 """""""""
   9326 
   9327 The '``llvm.pcmarker``' intrinsic is a method to export a Program
   9328 Counter (PC) in a region of code to simulators and other tools. The
   9329 method is target specific, but it is expected that the marker will use
   9330 exported symbols to transmit the PC of the marker. The marker makes no
   9331 guarantees that it will remain with any specific instruction after
   9332 optimizations. It is possible that the presence of a marker will inhibit
   9333 optimizations. The intended use is to be inserted after optimizations to
   9334 allow correlations of simulation runs.
   9335 
   9336 Arguments:
   9337 """"""""""
   9338 
   9339 ``id`` is a numerical id identifying the marker.
   9340 
   9341 Semantics:
   9342 """"""""""
   9343 
   9344 This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. Backends
   9345 that do not support this intrinsic may ignore it.
   9346 
   9347 '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' Intrinsic
   9348 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9349 
   9350 Syntax:
   9351 """""""
   9352 
   9353 ::
   9354 
   9355       declare i64 @llvm.readcyclecounter()
   9356 
   9357 Overview:
   9358 """""""""
   9359 
   9360 The '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' intrinsic provides access to the cycle
   9361 counter register (or similar low latency, high accuracy clocks) on those
   9362 targets that support it. On X86, it should map to RDTSC. On Alpha, it
   9363 should map to RPCC. As the backing counters overflow quickly (on the
   9364 order of 9 seconds on alpha), this should only be used for small
   9365 timings.
   9366 
   9367 Semantics:
   9368 """"""""""
   9369 
   9370 When directly supported, reading the cycle counter should not modify any
   9371 memory. Implementations are allowed to either return a application
   9372 specific value or a system wide value. On backends without support, this
   9373 is lowered to a constant 0.
   9374 
   9375 Note that runtime support may be conditional on the privilege-level code is
   9376 running at and the host platform.
   9377 
   9378 '``llvm.clear_cache``' Intrinsic
   9379 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9380 
   9381 Syntax:
   9382 """""""
   9383 
   9384 ::
   9385 
   9386       declare void @llvm.clear_cache(i8*, i8*)
   9387 
   9388 Overview:
   9389 """""""""
   9390 
   9391 The '``llvm.clear_cache``' intrinsic ensures visibility of modifications
   9392 in the specified range to the execution unit of the processor. On
   9393 targets with non-unified instruction and data cache, the implementation
   9394 flushes the instruction cache.
   9395 
   9396 Semantics:
   9397 """"""""""
   9398 
   9399 On platforms with coherent instruction and data caches (e.g. x86), this
   9400 intrinsic is a nop. On platforms with non-coherent instruction and data
   9401 cache (e.g. ARM, MIPS), the intrinsic is lowered either to appropriate
   9402 instructions or a system call, if cache flushing requires special
   9403 privileges.
   9404 
   9405 The default behavior is to emit a call to ``__clear_cache`` from the run
   9406 time library.
   9407 
   9408 This instrinsic does *not* empty the instruction pipeline. Modifications
   9409 of the current function are outside the scope of the intrinsic.
   9410 
   9411 '``llvm.instrprof_increment``' Intrinsic
   9412 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9413 
   9414 Syntax:
   9415 """""""
   9416 
   9417 ::
   9418 
   9419       declare void @llvm.instrprof_increment(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
   9420                                              i32 <num-counters>, i32 <index>)
   9421 
   9422 Overview:
   9423 """""""""
   9424 
   9425 The '``llvm.instrprof_increment``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
   9426 frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. These will be
   9427 lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate execution counts of a
   9428 program at runtime.
   9429 
   9430 Arguments:
   9431 """"""""""
   9432 
   9433 The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
   9434 name of the entity being instrumented. This should generally be the
   9435 (mangled) function name for a set of counters.
   9436 
   9437 The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
   9438 of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source, and
   9439 the third is the number of counters associated with ``name``. It is an
   9440 error if ``hash`` or ``num-counters`` differ between two instances of
   9441 ``instrprof_increment`` that refer to the same name.
   9442 
   9443 The last argument refers to which of the counters for ``name`` should
   9444 be incremented. It should be a value between 0 and ``num-counters``.
   9445 
   9446 Semantics:
   9447 """"""""""
   9448 
   9449 This intrinsic represents an increment of a profiling counter. It will
   9450 cause the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate the appropriate data
   9451 structures and the code to increment the appropriate value, in a
   9452 format that can be written out by a compiler runtime and consumed via
   9453 the ``llvm-profdata`` tool.
   9454 
   9455 '``llvm.instrprof_value_profile``' Intrinsic
   9456 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9457 
   9458 Syntax:
   9459 """""""
   9460 
   9461 ::
   9462 
   9463       declare void @llvm.instrprof_value_profile(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
   9464                                                  i64 <value>, i32 <value_kind>,
   9465                                                  i32 <index>)
   9466 
   9467 Overview:
   9468 """""""""
   9469 
   9470 The '``llvm.instrprof_value_profile``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
   9471 frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. This will be
   9472 lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to find out the target values,
   9473 instrumented expressions take in a program at runtime.
   9474 
   9475 Arguments:
   9476 """"""""""
   9477 
   9478 The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
   9479 name of the entity being instrumented. ``name`` should generally be the
   9480 (mangled) function name for a set of counters.
   9481 
   9482 The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
   9483 of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source. It
   9484 is an error if ``hash`` differs between two instances of
   9485 ``llvm.instrprof_*`` that refer to the same name.
   9486 
   9487 The third argument is the value of the expression being profiled. The profiled
   9488 expression's value should be representable as an unsigned 64-bit value. The
   9489 fourth argument represents the kind of value profiling that is being done. The
   9490 supported value profiling kinds are enumerated through the
   9491 ``InstrProfValueKind`` type declared in the
   9492 ``<include/llvm/ProfileData/InstrProf.h>`` header file. The last argument is the
   9493 index of the instrumented expression within ``name``. It should be >= 0.
   9494 
   9495 Semantics:
   9496 """"""""""
   9497 
   9498 This intrinsic represents the point where a call to a runtime routine
   9499 should be inserted for value profiling of target expressions. ``-instrprof``
   9500 pass will generate the appropriate data structures and replace the
   9501 ``llvm.instrprof_value_profile`` intrinsic with the call to the profile
   9502 runtime library with proper arguments.
   9503 
   9504 Standard C Library Intrinsics
   9505 -----------------------------
   9506 
   9507 LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important standard C library
   9508 functions. These intrinsics allow source-language front-ends to pass
   9509 information about the alignment of the pointer arguments to the code
   9510 generator, providing opportunity for more efficient code generation.
   9511 
   9512 .. _int_memcpy:
   9513 
   9514 '``llvm.memcpy``' Intrinsic
   9515 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9516 
   9517 Syntax:
   9518 """""""
   9519 
   9520 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy`` on any
   9521 integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
   9522 support all bit widths however.
   9523 
   9524 ::
   9525 
   9526       declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
   9527                                               i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
   9528       declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
   9529                                               i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
   9530 
   9531 Overview:
   9532 """""""""
   9533 
   9534 The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
   9535 source location to the destination location.
   9536 
   9537 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memcpy.*``
   9538 intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra alignment/isvolatile
   9539 arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
   9540 
   9541 Arguments:
   9542 """"""""""
   9543 
   9544 The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
   9545 pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
   9546 specifying the number of bytes to copy, the fourth argument is the
   9547 alignment of the source and destination locations, and the fifth is a
   9548 boolean indicating a volatile access.
   9549 
   9550 If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
   9551 then the caller guarantees that both the source and destination pointers
   9552 are aligned to that boundary.
   9553 
   9554 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memcpy`` call is
   9555 a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
   9556 very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
   9557 
   9558 Semantics:
   9559 """"""""""
   9560 
   9561 The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
   9562 source location to the destination location, which are not allowed to
   9563 overlap. It copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known
   9564 to be aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth
   9565 argument, otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
   9566 
   9567 '``llvm.memmove``' Intrinsic
   9568 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9569 
   9570 Syntax:
   9571 """""""
   9572 
   9573 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memmove on any integer
   9574 bit width and for different address space. Not all targets support all
   9575 bit widths however.
   9576 
   9577 ::
   9578 
   9579       declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
   9580                                                i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
   9581       declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
   9582                                                i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
   9583 
   9584 Overview:
   9585 """""""""
   9586 
   9587 The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics move a block of memory from the
   9588 source location to the destination location. It is similar to the
   9589 '``llvm.memcpy``' intrinsic but allows the two memory locations to
   9590 overlap.
   9591 
   9592 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memmove.*``
   9593 intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra alignment/isvolatile
   9594 arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
   9595 
   9596 Arguments:
   9597 """"""""""
   9598 
   9599 The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
   9600 pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
   9601 specifying the number of bytes to copy, the fourth argument is the
   9602 alignment of the source and destination locations, and the fifth is a
   9603 boolean indicating a volatile access.
   9604 
   9605 If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
   9606 then the caller guarantees that the source and destination pointers are
   9607 aligned to that boundary.
   9608 
   9609 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memmove`` call
   9610 is a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is
   9611 not very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
   9612 
   9613 Semantics:
   9614 """"""""""
   9615 
   9616 The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
   9617 source location to the destination location, which may overlap. It
   9618 copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to be
   9619 aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument,
   9620 otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
   9621 
   9622 '``llvm.memset.*``' Intrinsics
   9623 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9624 
   9625 Syntax:
   9626 """""""
   9627 
   9628 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memset on any integer
   9629 bit width and for different address spaces. However, not all targets
   9630 support all bit widths.
   9631 
   9632 ::
   9633 
   9634       declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
   9635                                          i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
   9636       declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
   9637                                          i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
   9638 
   9639 Overview:
   9640 """""""""
   9641 
   9642 The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill a block of memory with a
   9643 particular byte value.
   9644 
   9645 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memset``
   9646 intrinsic does not return a value and takes extra alignment/volatile
   9647 arguments. Also, the destination can be in an arbitrary address space.
   9648 
   9649 Arguments:
   9650 """"""""""
   9651 
   9652 The first argument is a pointer to the destination to fill, the second
   9653 is the byte value with which to fill it, the third argument is an
   9654 integer argument specifying the number of bytes to fill, and the fourth
   9655 argument is the known alignment of the destination location.
   9656 
   9657 If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
   9658 then the caller guarantees that the destination pointer is aligned to
   9659 that boundary.
   9660 
   9661 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memset`` call is
   9662 a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
   9663 very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
   9664 
   9665 Semantics:
   9666 """"""""""
   9667 
   9668 The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill "len" bytes of memory starting
   9669 at the destination location. If the argument is known to be aligned to
   9670 some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument, otherwise
   9671 it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
   9672 
   9673 '``llvm.sqrt.*``' Intrinsic
   9674 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9675 
   9676 Syntax:
   9677 """""""
   9678 
   9679 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sqrt`` on any
   9680 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   9681 all types however.
   9682 
   9683 ::
   9684 
   9685       declare float     @llvm.sqrt.f32(float %Val)
   9686       declare double    @llvm.sqrt.f64(double %Val)
   9687       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.sqrt.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
   9688       declare fp128     @llvm.sqrt.f128(fp128 %Val)
   9689       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sqrt.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
   9690 
   9691 Overview:
   9692 """""""""
   9693 
   9694 The '``llvm.sqrt``' intrinsics return the sqrt of the specified operand,
   9695 returning the same value as the libm '``sqrt``' functions would. Unlike
   9696 ``sqrt`` in libm, however, ``llvm.sqrt`` has undefined behavior for
   9697 negative numbers other than -0.0 (which allows for better optimization,
   9698 because there is no need to worry about errno being set).
   9699 ``llvm.sqrt(-0.0)`` is defined to return -0.0 like IEEE sqrt.
   9700 
   9701 Arguments:
   9702 """"""""""
   9703 
   9704 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   9705 type.
   9706 
   9707 Semantics:
   9708 """"""""""
   9709 
   9710 This function returns the sqrt of the specified operand if it is a
   9711 nonnegative floating point number.
   9712 
   9713 '``llvm.powi.*``' Intrinsic
   9714 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9715 
   9716 Syntax:
   9717 """""""
   9718 
   9719 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.powi`` on any
   9720 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   9721 all types however.
   9722 
   9723 ::
   9724 
   9725       declare float     @llvm.powi.f32(float  %Val, i32 %power)
   9726       declare double    @llvm.powi.f64(double %Val, i32 %power)
   9727       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.powi.f80(x86_fp80  %Val, i32 %power)
   9728       declare fp128     @llvm.powi.f128(fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
   9729       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.powi.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val, i32 %power)
   9730 
   9731 Overview:
   9732 """""""""
   9733 
   9734 The '``llvm.powi.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
   9735 specified (positive or negative) power. The order of evaluation of
   9736 multiplications is not defined. When a vector of floating point type is
   9737 used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
   9738 
   9739 Arguments:
   9740 """"""""""
   9741 
   9742 The second argument is an integer power, and the first is a value to
   9743 raise to that power.
   9744 
   9745 Semantics:
   9746 """"""""""
   9747 
   9748 This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
   9749 unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
   9750 
   9751 '``llvm.sin.*``' Intrinsic
   9752 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9753 
   9754 Syntax:
   9755 """""""
   9756 
   9757 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sin`` on any
   9758 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   9759 all types however.
   9760 
   9761 ::
   9762 
   9763       declare float     @llvm.sin.f32(float  %Val)
   9764       declare double    @llvm.sin.f64(double %Val)
   9765       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.sin.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   9766       declare fp128     @llvm.sin.f128(fp128 %Val)
   9767       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sin.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   9768 
   9769 Overview:
   9770 """""""""
   9771 
   9772 The '``llvm.sin.*``' intrinsics return the sine of the operand.
   9773 
   9774 Arguments:
   9775 """"""""""
   9776 
   9777 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   9778 type.
   9779 
   9780 Semantics:
   9781 """"""""""
   9782 
   9783 This function returns the sine of the specified operand, returning the
   9784 same values as the libm ``sin`` functions would, and handles error
   9785 conditions in the same way.
   9786 
   9787 '``llvm.cos.*``' Intrinsic
   9788 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9789 
   9790 Syntax:
   9791 """""""
   9792 
   9793 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cos`` on any
   9794 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   9795 all types however.
   9796 
   9797 ::
   9798 
   9799       declare float     @llvm.cos.f32(float  %Val)
   9800       declare double    @llvm.cos.f64(double %Val)
   9801       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.cos.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   9802       declare fp128     @llvm.cos.f128(fp128 %Val)
   9803       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.cos.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   9804 
   9805 Overview:
   9806 """""""""
   9807 
   9808 The '``llvm.cos.*``' intrinsics return the cosine of the operand.
   9809 
   9810 Arguments:
   9811 """"""""""
   9812 
   9813 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   9814 type.
   9815 
   9816 Semantics:
   9817 """"""""""
   9818 
   9819 This function returns the cosine of the specified operand, returning the
   9820 same values as the libm ``cos`` functions would, and handles error
   9821 conditions in the same way.
   9822 
   9823 '``llvm.pow.*``' Intrinsic
   9824 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9825 
   9826 Syntax:
   9827 """""""
   9828 
   9829 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.pow`` on any
   9830 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   9831 all types however.
   9832 
   9833 ::
   9834 
   9835       declare float     @llvm.pow.f32(float  %Val, float %Power)
   9836       declare double    @llvm.pow.f64(double %Val, double %Power)
   9837       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.pow.f80(x86_fp80  %Val, x86_fp80 %Power)
   9838       declare fp128     @llvm.pow.f128(fp128 %Val, fp128 %Power)
   9839       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.pow.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val, ppc_fp128 Power)
   9840 
   9841 Overview:
   9842 """""""""
   9843 
   9844 The '``llvm.pow.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
   9845 specified (positive or negative) power.
   9846 
   9847 Arguments:
   9848 """"""""""
   9849 
   9850 The second argument is a floating point power, and the first is a value
   9851 to raise to that power.
   9852 
   9853 Semantics:
   9854 """"""""""
   9855 
   9856 This function returns the first value raised to the second power,
   9857 returning the same values as the libm ``pow`` functions would, and
   9858 handles error conditions in the same way.
   9859 
   9860 '``llvm.exp.*``' Intrinsic
   9861 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9862 
   9863 Syntax:
   9864 """""""
   9865 
   9866 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp`` on any
   9867 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   9868 all types however.
   9869 
   9870 ::
   9871 
   9872       declare float     @llvm.exp.f32(float  %Val)
   9873       declare double    @llvm.exp.f64(double %Val)
   9874       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.exp.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   9875       declare fp128     @llvm.exp.f128(fp128 %Val)
   9876       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   9877 
   9878 Overview:
   9879 """""""""
   9880 
   9881 The '``llvm.exp.*``' intrinsics perform the exp function.
   9882 
   9883 Arguments:
   9884 """"""""""
   9885 
   9886 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   9887 type.
   9888 
   9889 Semantics:
   9890 """"""""""
   9891 
   9892 This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp`` functions
   9893 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   9894 
   9895 '``llvm.exp2.*``' Intrinsic
   9896 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9897 
   9898 Syntax:
   9899 """""""
   9900 
   9901 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp2`` on any
   9902 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   9903 all types however.
   9904 
   9905 ::
   9906 
   9907       declare float     @llvm.exp2.f32(float  %Val)
   9908       declare double    @llvm.exp2.f64(double %Val)
   9909       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.exp2.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   9910       declare fp128     @llvm.exp2.f128(fp128 %Val)
   9911       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   9912 
   9913 Overview:
   9914 """""""""
   9915 
   9916 The '``llvm.exp2.*``' intrinsics perform the exp2 function.
   9917 
   9918 Arguments:
   9919 """"""""""
   9920 
   9921 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   9922 type.
   9923 
   9924 Semantics:
   9925 """"""""""
   9926 
   9927 This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp2`` functions
   9928 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   9929 
   9930 '``llvm.log.*``' Intrinsic
   9931 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9932 
   9933 Syntax:
   9934 """""""
   9935 
   9936 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log`` on any
   9937 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   9938 all types however.
   9939 
   9940 ::
   9941 
   9942       declare float     @llvm.log.f32(float  %Val)
   9943       declare double    @llvm.log.f64(double %Val)
   9944       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.log.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   9945       declare fp128     @llvm.log.f128(fp128 %Val)
   9946       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   9947 
   9948 Overview:
   9949 """""""""
   9950 
   9951 The '``llvm.log.*``' intrinsics perform the log function.
   9952 
   9953 Arguments:
   9954 """"""""""
   9955 
   9956 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   9957 type.
   9958 
   9959 Semantics:
   9960 """"""""""
   9961 
   9962 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log`` functions
   9963 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   9964 
   9965 '``llvm.log10.*``' Intrinsic
   9966 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   9967 
   9968 Syntax:
   9969 """""""
   9970 
   9971 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log10`` on any
   9972 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   9973 all types however.
   9974 
   9975 ::
   9976 
   9977       declare float     @llvm.log10.f32(float  %Val)
   9978       declare double    @llvm.log10.f64(double %Val)
   9979       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.log10.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   9980       declare fp128     @llvm.log10.f128(fp128 %Val)
   9981       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log10.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   9982 
   9983 Overview:
   9984 """""""""
   9985 
   9986 The '``llvm.log10.*``' intrinsics perform the log10 function.
   9987 
   9988 Arguments:
   9989 """"""""""
   9990 
   9991 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   9992 type.
   9993 
   9994 Semantics:
   9995 """"""""""
   9996 
   9997 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log10`` functions
   9998 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   9999 
   10000 '``llvm.log2.*``' Intrinsic
   10001 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10002 
   10003 Syntax:
   10004 """""""
   10005 
   10006 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log2`` on any
   10007 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   10008 all types however.
   10009 
   10010 ::
   10011 
   10012       declare float     @llvm.log2.f32(float  %Val)
   10013       declare double    @llvm.log2.f64(double %Val)
   10014       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.log2.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   10015       declare fp128     @llvm.log2.f128(fp128 %Val)
   10016       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   10017 
   10018 Overview:
   10019 """""""""
   10020 
   10021 The '``llvm.log2.*``' intrinsics perform the log2 function.
   10022 
   10023 Arguments:
   10024 """"""""""
   10025 
   10026 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   10027 type.
   10028 
   10029 Semantics:
   10030 """"""""""
   10031 
   10032 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log2`` functions
   10033 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   10034 
   10035 '``llvm.fma.*``' Intrinsic
   10036 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10037 
   10038 Syntax:
   10039 """""""
   10040 
   10041 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fma`` on any
   10042 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   10043 all types however.
   10044 
   10045 ::
   10046 
   10047       declare float     @llvm.fma.f32(float  %a, float  %b, float  %c)
   10048       declare double    @llvm.fma.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
   10049       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.fma.f80(x86_fp80 %a, x86_fp80 %b, x86_fp80 %c)
   10050       declare fp128     @llvm.fma.f128(fp128 %a, fp128 %b, fp128 %c)
   10051       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fma.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %a, ppc_fp128 %b, ppc_fp128 %c)
   10052 
   10053 Overview:
   10054 """""""""
   10055 
   10056 The '``llvm.fma.*``' intrinsics perform the fused multiply-add
   10057 operation.
   10058 
   10059 Arguments:
   10060 """"""""""
   10061 
   10062 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   10063 type.
   10064 
   10065 Semantics:
   10066 """"""""""
   10067 
   10068 This function returns the same values as the libm ``fma`` functions
   10069 would, and does not set errno.
   10070 
   10071 '``llvm.fabs.*``' Intrinsic
   10072 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10073 
   10074 Syntax:
   10075 """""""
   10076 
   10077 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fabs`` on any
   10078 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   10079 all types however.
   10080 
   10081 ::
   10082 
   10083       declare float     @llvm.fabs.f32(float  %Val)
   10084       declare double    @llvm.fabs.f64(double %Val)
   10085       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.fabs.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
   10086       declare fp128     @llvm.fabs.f128(fp128 %Val)
   10087       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fabs.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
   10088 
   10089 Overview:
   10090 """""""""
   10091 
   10092 The '``llvm.fabs.*``' intrinsics return the absolute value of the
   10093 operand.
   10094 
   10095 Arguments:
   10096 """"""""""
   10097 
   10098 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   10099 type.
   10100 
   10101 Semantics:
   10102 """"""""""
   10103 
   10104 This function returns the same values as the libm ``fabs`` functions
   10105 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   10106 
   10107 '``llvm.minnum.*``' Intrinsic
   10108 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10109 
   10110 Syntax:
   10111 """""""
   10112 
   10113 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minnum`` on any
   10114 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   10115 all types however.
   10116 
   10117 ::
   10118 
   10119       declare float     @llvm.minnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
   10120       declare double    @llvm.minnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
   10121       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.minnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
   10122       declare fp128     @llvm.minnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
   10123       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
   10124 
   10125 Overview:
   10126 """""""""
   10127 
   10128 The '``llvm.minnum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
   10129 arguments.
   10130 
   10131 
   10132 Arguments:
   10133 """"""""""
   10134 
   10135 The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   10136 type.
   10137 
   10138 Semantics:
   10139 """"""""""
   10140 
   10141 Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum, which also match for libm's
   10142 fmin.
   10143 
   10144 If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
   10145 NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal,
   10146 returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that
   10147 fmin(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0.
   10148 
   10149 '``llvm.maxnum.*``' Intrinsic
   10150 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10151 
   10152 Syntax:
   10153 """""""
   10154 
   10155 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maxnum`` on any
   10156 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   10157 all types however.
   10158 
   10159 ::
   10160 
   10161       declare float     @llvm.maxnum.f32(float  %Val0, float  %Val1l)
   10162       declare double    @llvm.maxnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
   10163       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.maxnum.f80(x86_fp80  %Val0, x86_fp80  %Val1)
   10164       declare fp128     @llvm.maxnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
   10165       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maxnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val0, ppc_fp128  %Val1)
   10166 
   10167 Overview:
   10168 """""""""
   10169 
   10170 The '``llvm.maxnum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
   10171 arguments.
   10172 
   10173 
   10174 Arguments:
   10175 """"""""""
   10176 
   10177 The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   10178 type.
   10179 
   10180 Semantics:
   10181 """"""""""
   10182 Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum, which also match for libm's
   10183 fmax.
   10184 
   10185 If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
   10186 NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal,
   10187 returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that
   10188 fmax(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0.
   10189 
   10190 '``llvm.copysign.*``' Intrinsic
   10191 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10192 
   10193 Syntax:
   10194 """""""
   10195 
   10196 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.copysign`` on any
   10197 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   10198 all types however.
   10199 
   10200 ::
   10201 
   10202       declare float     @llvm.copysign.f32(float  %Mag, float  %Sgn)
   10203       declare double    @llvm.copysign.f64(double %Mag, double %Sgn)
   10204       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.copysign.f80(x86_fp80  %Mag, x86_fp80  %Sgn)
   10205       declare fp128     @llvm.copysign.f128(fp128 %Mag, fp128 %Sgn)
   10206       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.copysign.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Mag, ppc_fp128  %Sgn)
   10207 
   10208 Overview:
   10209 """""""""
   10210 
   10211 The '``llvm.copysign.*``' intrinsics return a value with the magnitude of the
   10212 first operand and the sign of the second operand.
   10213 
   10214 Arguments:
   10215 """"""""""
   10216 
   10217 The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   10218 type.
   10219 
   10220 Semantics:
   10221 """"""""""
   10222 
   10223 This function returns the same values as the libm ``copysign``
   10224 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   10225 
   10226 '``llvm.floor.*``' Intrinsic
   10227 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10228 
   10229 Syntax:
   10230 """""""
   10231 
   10232 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.floor`` on any
   10233 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   10234 all types however.
   10235 
   10236 ::
   10237 
   10238       declare float     @llvm.floor.f32(float  %Val)
   10239       declare double    @llvm.floor.f64(double %Val)
   10240       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.floor.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   10241       declare fp128     @llvm.floor.f128(fp128 %Val)
   10242       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.floor.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   10243 
   10244 Overview:
   10245 """""""""
   10246 
   10247 The '``llvm.floor.*``' intrinsics return the floor of the operand.
   10248 
   10249 Arguments:
   10250 """"""""""
   10251 
   10252 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   10253 type.
   10254 
   10255 Semantics:
   10256 """"""""""
   10257 
   10258 This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions
   10259 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   10260 
   10261 '``llvm.ceil.*``' Intrinsic
   10262 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10263 
   10264 Syntax:
   10265 """""""
   10266 
   10267 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ceil`` on any
   10268 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   10269 all types however.
   10270 
   10271 ::
   10272 
   10273       declare float     @llvm.ceil.f32(float  %Val)
   10274       declare double    @llvm.ceil.f64(double %Val)
   10275       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.ceil.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   10276       declare fp128     @llvm.ceil.f128(fp128 %Val)
   10277       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.ceil.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   10278 
   10279 Overview:
   10280 """""""""
   10281 
   10282 The '``llvm.ceil.*``' intrinsics return the ceiling of the operand.
   10283 
   10284 Arguments:
   10285 """"""""""
   10286 
   10287 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   10288 type.
   10289 
   10290 Semantics:
   10291 """"""""""
   10292 
   10293 This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions
   10294 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   10295 
   10296 '``llvm.trunc.*``' Intrinsic
   10297 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10298 
   10299 Syntax:
   10300 """""""
   10301 
   10302 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.trunc`` on any
   10303 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   10304 all types however.
   10305 
   10306 ::
   10307 
   10308       declare float     @llvm.trunc.f32(float  %Val)
   10309       declare double    @llvm.trunc.f64(double %Val)
   10310       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.trunc.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   10311       declare fp128     @llvm.trunc.f128(fp128 %Val)
   10312       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.trunc.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   10313 
   10314 Overview:
   10315 """""""""
   10316 
   10317 The '``llvm.trunc.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
   10318 nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the operand.
   10319 
   10320 Arguments:
   10321 """"""""""
   10322 
   10323 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   10324 type.
   10325 
   10326 Semantics:
   10327 """"""""""
   10328 
   10329 This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions
   10330 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   10331 
   10332 '``llvm.rint.*``' Intrinsic
   10333 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10334 
   10335 Syntax:
   10336 """""""
   10337 
   10338 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.rint`` on any
   10339 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   10340 all types however.
   10341 
   10342 ::
   10343 
   10344       declare float     @llvm.rint.f32(float  %Val)
   10345       declare double    @llvm.rint.f64(double %Val)
   10346       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.rint.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   10347       declare fp128     @llvm.rint.f128(fp128 %Val)
   10348       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.rint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   10349 
   10350 Overview:
   10351 """""""""
   10352 
   10353 The '``llvm.rint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
   10354 nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point exception if the
   10355 operand isn't an integer.
   10356 
   10357 Arguments:
   10358 """"""""""
   10359 
   10360 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   10361 type.
   10362 
   10363 Semantics:
   10364 """"""""""
   10365 
   10366 This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
   10367 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   10368 
   10369 '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' Intrinsic
   10370 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10371 
   10372 Syntax:
   10373 """""""
   10374 
   10375 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.nearbyint`` on any
   10376 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   10377 all types however.
   10378 
   10379 ::
   10380 
   10381       declare float     @llvm.nearbyint.f32(float  %Val)
   10382       declare double    @llvm.nearbyint.f64(double %Val)
   10383       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.nearbyint.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   10384       declare fp128     @llvm.nearbyint.f128(fp128 %Val)
   10385       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   10386 
   10387 Overview:
   10388 """""""""
   10389 
   10390 The '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
   10391 nearest integer.
   10392 
   10393 Arguments:
   10394 """"""""""
   10395 
   10396 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   10397 type.
   10398 
   10399 Semantics:
   10400 """"""""""
   10401 
   10402 This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint``
   10403 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   10404 
   10405 '``llvm.round.*``' Intrinsic
   10406 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10407 
   10408 Syntax:
   10409 """""""
   10410 
   10411 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.round`` on any
   10412 floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
   10413 all types however.
   10414 
   10415 ::
   10416 
   10417       declare float     @llvm.round.f32(float  %Val)
   10418       declare double    @llvm.round.f64(double %Val)
   10419       declare x86_fp80  @llvm.round.f80(x86_fp80  %Val)
   10420       declare fp128     @llvm.round.f128(fp128 %Val)
   10421       declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.round.ppcf128(ppc_fp128  %Val)
   10422 
   10423 Overview:
   10424 """""""""
   10425 
   10426 The '``llvm.round.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
   10427 nearest integer.
   10428 
   10429 Arguments:
   10430 """"""""""
   10431 
   10432 The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
   10433 type.
   10434 
   10435 Semantics:
   10436 """"""""""
   10437 
   10438 This function returns the same values as the libm ``round``
   10439 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
   10440 
   10441 Bit Manipulation Intrinsics
   10442 ---------------------------
   10443 
   10444 LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important bit manipulation
   10445 operations. These allow efficient code generation for some algorithms.
   10446 
   10447 '``llvm.bitreverse.*``' Intrinsics
   10448 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10449 
   10450 Syntax:
   10451 """""""
   10452 
   10453 This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bitreverse on any
   10454 integer type.
   10455 
   10456 ::
   10457 
   10458       declare i16 @llvm.bitreverse.i16(i16 <id>)
   10459       declare i32 @llvm.bitreverse.i32(i32 <id>)
   10460       declare i64 @llvm.bitreverse.i64(i64 <id>)
   10461 
   10462 Overview:
   10463 """""""""
   10464 
   10465 The '``llvm.bitreverse``' family of intrinsics is used to reverse the
   10466 bitpattern of an integer value; for example ``0b1234567`` becomes
   10467 ``0b7654321``.
   10468 
   10469 Semantics:
   10470 """"""""""
   10471 
   10472 The ``llvm.bitreverse.iN`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has bit
   10473 ``M`` in the input moved to bit ``N-M`` in the output.
   10474 
   10475 '``llvm.bswap.*``' Intrinsics
   10476 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10477 
   10478 Syntax:
   10479 """""""
   10480 
   10481 This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bswap on any
   10482 integer type that is an even number of bytes (i.e. BitWidth % 16 == 0).
   10483 
   10484 ::
   10485 
   10486       declare i16 @llvm.bswap.i16(i16 <id>)
   10487       declare i32 @llvm.bswap.i32(i32 <id>)
   10488       declare i64 @llvm.bswap.i64(i64 <id>)
   10489 
   10490 Overview:
   10491 """""""""
   10492 
   10493 The '``llvm.bswap``' family of intrinsics is used to byte swap integer
   10494 values with an even number of bytes (positive multiple of 16 bits).
   10495 These are useful for performing operations on data that is not in the
   10496 target's native byte order.
   10497 
   10498 Semantics:
   10499 """"""""""
   10500 
   10501 The ``llvm.bswap.i16`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has the high
   10502 and low byte of the input i16 swapped. Similarly, the ``llvm.bswap.i32``
   10503 intrinsic returns an i32 value that has the four bytes of the input i32
   10504 swapped, so that if the input bytes are numbered 0, 1, 2, 3 then the
   10505 returned i32 will have its bytes in 3, 2, 1, 0 order. The
   10506 ``llvm.bswap.i48``, ``llvm.bswap.i64`` and other intrinsics extend this
   10507 concept to additional even-byte lengths (6 bytes, 8 bytes and more,
   10508 respectively).
   10509 
   10510 '``llvm.ctpop.*``' Intrinsic
   10511 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10512 
   10513 Syntax:
   10514 """""""
   10515 
   10516 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctpop on any integer
   10517 bit width, or on any vector with integer elements. Not all targets
   10518 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
   10519 
   10520 ::
   10521 
   10522       declare i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8  <src>)
   10523       declare i16 @llvm.ctpop.i16(i16 <src>)
   10524       declare i32 @llvm.ctpop.i32(i32 <src>)
   10525       declare i64 @llvm.ctpop.i64(i64 <src>)
   10526       declare i256 @llvm.ctpop.i256(i256 <src>)
   10527       declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctpop.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>)
   10528 
   10529 Overview:
   10530 """""""""
   10531 
   10532 The '``llvm.ctpop``' family of intrinsics counts the number of bits set
   10533 in a value.
   10534 
   10535 Arguments:
   10536 """"""""""
   10537 
   10538 The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any
   10539 integer type, or a vector with integer elements. The return type must
   10540 match the argument type.
   10541 
   10542 Semantics:
   10543 """"""""""
   10544 
   10545 The '``llvm.ctpop``' intrinsic counts the 1's in a variable, or within
   10546 each element of a vector.
   10547 
   10548 '``llvm.ctlz.*``' Intrinsic
   10549 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10550 
   10551 Syntax:
   10552 """""""
   10553 
   10554 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ctlz`` on any
   10555 integer bit width, or any vector whose elements are integers. Not all
   10556 targets support all bit widths or vector types, however.
   10557 
   10558 ::
   10559 
   10560       declare i8   @llvm.ctlz.i8  (i8   <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
   10561       declare i16  @llvm.ctlz.i16 (i16  <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
   10562       declare i32  @llvm.ctlz.i32 (i32  <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
   10563       declare i64  @llvm.ctlz.i64 (i64  <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
   10564       declare i256 @llvm.ctlz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
   10565       declase <2 x i32> @llvm.ctlz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
   10566 
   10567 Overview:
   10568 """""""""
   10569 
   10570 The '``llvm.ctlz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
   10571 leading zeros in a variable.
   10572 
   10573 Arguments:
   10574 """"""""""
   10575 
   10576 The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
   10577 any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
   10578 type must match the first argument type.
   10579 
   10580 The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
   10581 the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
   10582 defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
   10583 defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
   10584 now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
   10585 
   10586 Semantics:
   10587 """"""""""
   10588 
   10589 The '``llvm.ctlz``' intrinsic counts the leading (most significant)
   10590 zeros in a variable, or within each element of the vector. If
   10591 ``src == 0`` then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src``
   10592 if ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
   10593 ``llvm.ctlz(i32 2) = 30``.
   10594 
   10595 '``llvm.cttz.*``' Intrinsic
   10596 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10597 
   10598 Syntax:
   10599 """""""
   10600 
   10601 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cttz`` on any
   10602 integer bit width, or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
   10603 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
   10604 
   10605 ::
   10606 
   10607       declare i8   @llvm.cttz.i8  (i8   <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
   10608       declare i16  @llvm.cttz.i16 (i16  <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
   10609       declare i32  @llvm.cttz.i32 (i32  <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
   10610       declare i64  @llvm.cttz.i64 (i64  <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
   10611       declare i256 @llvm.cttz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
   10612       declase <2 x i32> @llvm.cttz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
   10613 
   10614 Overview:
   10615 """""""""
   10616 
   10617 The '``llvm.cttz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
   10618 trailing zeros.
   10619 
   10620 Arguments:
   10621 """"""""""
   10622 
   10623 The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
   10624 any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
   10625 type must match the first argument type.
   10626 
   10627 The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
   10628 the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
   10629 defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
   10630 defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
   10631 now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
   10632 
   10633 Semantics:
   10634 """"""""""
   10635 
   10636 The '``llvm.cttz``' intrinsic counts the trailing (least significant)
   10637 zeros in a variable, or within each element of a vector. If ``src == 0``
   10638 then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src`` if
   10639 ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
   10640 ``llvm.cttz(2) = 1``.
   10641 
   10642 .. _int_overflow:
   10643 
   10644 Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics
   10645 -----------------------------------
   10646 
   10647 LLVM provides intrinsics for some arithmetic with overflow operations.
   10648 
   10649 '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
   10650 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10651 
   10652 Syntax:
   10653 """""""
   10654 
   10655 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``
   10656 on any integer bit width.
   10657 
   10658 ::
   10659 
   10660       declare {i16, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
   10661       declare {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
   10662       declare {i64, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
   10663 
   10664 Overview:
   10665 """""""""
   10666 
   10667 The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
   10668 a signed addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow
   10669 occurred during the signed summation.
   10670 
   10671 Arguments:
   10672 """"""""""
   10673 
   10674 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
   10675 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
   10676 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
   10677 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
   10678 addition.
   10679 
   10680 Semantics:
   10681 """"""""""
   10682 
   10683 The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
   10684 a signed addition of the two variables. They return a structure --- the
   10685 first element of which is the signed summation, and the second element
   10686 of which is a bit specifying if the signed summation resulted in an
   10687 overflow.
   10688 
   10689 Examples:
   10690 """""""""
   10691 
   10692 .. code-block:: llvm
   10693 
   10694       %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
   10695       %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
   10696       %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
   10697       br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
   10698 
   10699 '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
   10700 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10701 
   10702 Syntax:
   10703 """""""
   10704 
   10705 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``
   10706 on any integer bit width.
   10707 
   10708 ::
   10709 
   10710       declare {i16, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
   10711       declare {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
   10712       declare {i64, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
   10713 
   10714 Overview:
   10715 """""""""
   10716 
   10717 The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
   10718 an unsigned addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether a carry
   10719 occurred during the unsigned summation.
   10720 
   10721 Arguments:
   10722 """"""""""
   10723 
   10724 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
   10725 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
   10726 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
   10727 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
   10728 addition.
   10729 
   10730 Semantics:
   10731 """"""""""
   10732 
   10733 The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
   10734 an unsigned addition of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
   10735 first element of which is the sum, and the second element of which is a
   10736 bit specifying if the unsigned summation resulted in a carry.
   10737 
   10738 Examples:
   10739 """""""""
   10740 
   10741 .. code-block:: llvm
   10742 
   10743       %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
   10744       %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
   10745       %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
   10746       br i1 %obit, label %carry, label %normal
   10747 
   10748 '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
   10749 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10750 
   10751 Syntax:
   10752 """""""
   10753 
   10754 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``
   10755 on any integer bit width.
   10756 
   10757 ::
   10758 
   10759       declare {i16, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
   10760       declare {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
   10761       declare {i64, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
   10762 
   10763 Overview:
   10764 """""""""
   10765 
   10766 The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
   10767 a signed subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
   10768 overflow occurred during the signed subtraction.
   10769 
   10770 Arguments:
   10771 """"""""""
   10772 
   10773 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
   10774 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
   10775 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
   10776 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
   10777 subtraction.
   10778 
   10779 Semantics:
   10780 """"""""""
   10781 
   10782 The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
   10783 a signed subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
   10784 first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
   10785 which is a bit specifying if the signed subtraction resulted in an
   10786 overflow.
   10787 
   10788 Examples:
   10789 """""""""
   10790 
   10791 .. code-block:: llvm
   10792 
   10793       %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
   10794       %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
   10795       %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
   10796       br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
   10797 
   10798 '``llvm.usub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
   10799 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10800 
   10801 Syntax:
   10802 """""""
   10803 
   10804 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.with.overflow``
   10805 on any integer bit width.
   10806 
   10807 ::
   10808 
   10809       declare {i16, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
   10810       declare {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
   10811       declare {i64, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
   10812 
   10813 Overview:
   10814 """""""""
   10815 
   10816 The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
   10817 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
   10818 overflow occurred during the unsigned subtraction.
   10819 
   10820 Arguments:
   10821 """"""""""
   10822 
   10823 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
   10824 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
   10825 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
   10826 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
   10827 subtraction.
   10828 
   10829 Semantics:
   10830 """"""""""
   10831 
   10832 The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
   10833 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
   10834 the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
   10835 which is a bit specifying if the unsigned subtraction resulted in an
   10836 overflow.
   10837 
   10838 Examples:
   10839 """""""""
   10840 
   10841 .. code-block:: llvm
   10842 
   10843       %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
   10844       %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
   10845       %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
   10846       br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
   10847 
   10848 '``llvm.smul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
   10849 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10850 
   10851 Syntax:
   10852 """""""
   10853 
   10854 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.with.overflow``
   10855 on any integer bit width.
   10856 
   10857 ::
   10858 
   10859       declare {i16, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
   10860       declare {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
   10861       declare {i64, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
   10862 
   10863 Overview:
   10864 """""""""
   10865 
   10866 The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
   10867 a signed multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
   10868 overflow occurred during the signed multiplication.
   10869 
   10870 Arguments:
   10871 """"""""""
   10872 
   10873 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
   10874 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
   10875 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
   10876 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
   10877 multiplication.
   10878 
   10879 Semantics:
   10880 """"""""""
   10881 
   10882 The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
   10883 a signed multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
   10884 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second element
   10885 of which is a bit specifying if the signed multiplication resulted in an
   10886 overflow.
   10887 
   10888 Examples:
   10889 """""""""
   10890 
   10891 .. code-block:: llvm
   10892 
   10893       %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
   10894       %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
   10895       %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
   10896       br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
   10897 
   10898 '``llvm.umul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
   10899 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10900 
   10901 Syntax:
   10902 """""""
   10903 
   10904 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.with.overflow``
   10905 on any integer bit width.
   10906 
   10907 ::
   10908 
   10909       declare {i16, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
   10910       declare {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
   10911       declare {i64, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
   10912 
   10913 Overview:
   10914 """""""""
   10915 
   10916 The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
   10917 a unsigned multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
   10918 overflow occurred during the unsigned multiplication.
   10919 
   10920 Arguments:
   10921 """"""""""
   10922 
   10923 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
   10924 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
   10925 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
   10926 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
   10927 multiplication.
   10928 
   10929 Semantics:
   10930 """"""""""
   10931 
   10932 The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
   10933 an unsigned multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
   10934 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second
   10935 element of which is a bit specifying if the unsigned multiplication
   10936 resulted in an overflow.
   10937 
   10938 Examples:
   10939 """""""""
   10940 
   10941 .. code-block:: llvm
   10942 
   10943       %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
   10944       %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
   10945       %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
   10946       br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
   10947 
   10948 Specialised Arithmetic Intrinsics
   10949 ---------------------------------
   10950 
   10951 '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' Intrinsic
   10952 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   10953 
   10954 Syntax:
   10955 """""""
   10956 
   10957 ::
   10958 
   10959       declare float @llvm.canonicalize.f32(float %a)
   10960       declare double @llvm.canonicalize.f64(double %b)
   10961 
   10962 Overview:
   10963 """""""""
   10964 
   10965 The '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' intrinsic returns the platform specific canonical
   10966 encoding of a floating point number. This canonicalization is useful for
   10967 implementing certain numeric primitives such as frexp. The canonical encoding is
   10968 defined by IEEE-754-2008 to be:
   10969 
   10970 ::
   10971 
   10972       2.1.8 canonical encoding: The preferred encoding of a floating-point
   10973       representation in a format. Applied to declets, significands of finite
   10974       numbers, infinities, and NaNs, especially in decimal formats.
   10975 
   10976 This operation can also be considered equivalent to the IEEE-754-2008
   10977 conversion of a floating-point value to the same format. NaNs are handled
   10978 according to section 6.2.
   10979 
   10980 Examples of non-canonical encodings:
   10981 
   10982 - x87 pseudo denormals, pseudo NaNs, pseudo Infinity, Unnormals. These are
   10983   converted to a canonical representation per hardware-specific protocol.
   10984 - Many normal decimal floating point numbers have non-canonical alternative
   10985   encodings.
   10986 - Some machines, like GPUs or ARMv7 NEON, do not support subnormal values.
   10987   These are treated as non-canonical encodings of zero and with be flushed to
   10988   a zero of the same sign by this operation.
   10989 
   10990 Note that per IEEE-754-2008 6.2, systems that support signaling NaNs with
   10991 default exception handling must signal an invalid exception, and produce a
   10992 quiet NaN result.
   10993 
   10994 This function should always be implementable as multiplication by 1.0, provided
   10995 that the compiler does not constant fold the operation. Likewise, division by
   10996 1.0 and ``llvm.minnum(x, x)`` are possible implementations. Addition with
   10997 -0.0 is also sufficient provided that the rounding mode is not -Infinity.
   10998 
   10999 ``@llvm.canonicalize`` must preserve the equality relation. That is:
   11000 
   11001 - ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == x)`` is equivalent to ``(x == x)``
   11002 - ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == @llvm.canonicalize(y))`` is equivalent to
   11003   to ``(x == y)``
   11004 
   11005 Additionally, the sign of zero must be conserved:
   11006 ``@llvm.canonicalize(-0.0) = -0.0`` and ``@llvm.canonicalize(+0.0) = +0.0``
   11007 
   11008 The payload bits of a NaN must be conserved, with two exceptions.
   11009 First, environments which use only a single canonical representation of NaN
   11010 must perform said canonicalization. Second, SNaNs must be quieted per the
   11011 usual methods.
   11012 
   11013 The canonicalization operation may be optimized away if:
   11014 
   11015 - The input is known to be canonical. For example, it was produced by a
   11016   floating-point operation that is required by the standard to be canonical.
   11017 - The result is consumed only by (or fused with) other floating-point
   11018   operations. That is, the bits of the floating point value are not examined.
   11019 
   11020 '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' Intrinsic
   11021 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11022 
   11023 Syntax:
   11024 """""""
   11025 
   11026 ::
   11027 
   11028       declare float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
   11029       declare double @llvm.fmuladd.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
   11030 
   11031 Overview:
   11032 """""""""
   11033 
   11034 The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsic functions represent multiply-add
   11035 expressions that can be fused if the code generator determines that (a) the
   11036 target instruction set has support for a fused operation, and (b) that the
   11037 fused operation is more efficient than the equivalent, separate pair of mul
   11038 and add instructions.
   11039 
   11040 Arguments:
   11041 """"""""""
   11042 
   11043 The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsics each take three arguments: two
   11044 multiplicands, a and b, and an addend c.
   11045 
   11046 Semantics:
   11047 """"""""""
   11048 
   11049 The expression:
   11050 
   11051 ::
   11052 
   11053       %0 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(%a, %b, %c)
   11054 
   11055 is equivalent to the expression a \* b + c, except that rounding will
   11056 not be performed between the multiplication and addition steps if the
   11057 code generator fuses the operations. Fusion is not guaranteed, even if
   11058 the target platform supports it. If a fused multiply-add is required the
   11059 corresponding llvm.fma.\* intrinsic function should be used
   11060 instead. This never sets errno, just as '``llvm.fma.*``'.
   11061 
   11062 Examples:
   11063 """""""""
   11064 
   11065 .. code-block:: llvm
   11066 
   11067       %r2 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c) ; yields float:r2 = (a * b) + c
   11068 
   11069 Half Precision Floating Point Intrinsics
   11070 ----------------------------------------
   11071 
   11072 For most target platforms, half precision floating point is a
   11073 storage-only format. This means that it is a dense encoding (in memory)
   11074 but does not support computation in the format.
   11075 
   11076 This means that code must first load the half-precision floating point
   11077 value as an i16, then convert it to float with
   11078 :ref:`llvm.convert.from.fp16 <int_convert_from_fp16>`. Computation can
   11079 then be performed on the float value (including extending to double
   11080 etc). To store the value back to memory, it is first converted to float
   11081 if needed, then converted to i16 with
   11082 :ref:`llvm.convert.to.fp16 <int_convert_to_fp16>`, then storing as an
   11083 i16 value.
   11084 
   11085 .. _int_convert_to_fp16:
   11086 
   11087 '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' Intrinsic
   11088 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11089 
   11090 Syntax:
   11091 """""""
   11092 
   11093 ::
   11094 
   11095       declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
   11096       declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f64(double %a)
   11097 
   11098 Overview:
   11099 """""""""
   11100 
   11101 The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
   11102 conventional floating point type to half precision floating point format.
   11103 
   11104 Arguments:
   11105 """"""""""
   11106 
   11107 The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
   11108 converted.
   11109 
   11110 Semantics:
   11111 """"""""""
   11112 
   11113 The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
   11114 conventional floating point format to half precision floating point format. The
   11115 return value is an ``i16`` which contains the converted number.
   11116 
   11117 Examples:
   11118 """""""""
   11119 
   11120 .. code-block:: llvm
   11121 
   11122       %res = call i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
   11123       store i16 %res, i16* @x, align 2
   11124 
   11125 .. _int_convert_from_fp16:
   11126 
   11127 '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' Intrinsic
   11128 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11129 
   11130 Syntax:
   11131 """""""
   11132 
   11133 ::
   11134 
   11135       declare float @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f32(i16 %a)
   11136       declare double @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f64(i16 %a)
   11137 
   11138 Overview:
   11139 """""""""
   11140 
   11141 The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
   11142 conversion from half precision floating point format to single precision
   11143 floating point format.
   11144 
   11145 Arguments:
   11146 """"""""""
   11147 
   11148 The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
   11149 converted.
   11150 
   11151 Semantics:
   11152 """"""""""
   11153 
   11154 The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
   11155 conversion from half single precision floating point format to single
   11156 precision floating point format. The input half-float value is
   11157 represented by an ``i16`` value.
   11158 
   11159 Examples:
   11160 """""""""
   11161 
   11162 .. code-block:: llvm
   11163 
   11164       %a = load i16, i16* @x, align 2
   11165       %res = call float @llvm.convert.from.fp16(i16 %a)
   11166 
   11167 .. _dbg_intrinsics:
   11168 
   11169 Debugger Intrinsics
   11170 -------------------
   11171 
   11172 The LLVM debugger intrinsics (which all start with ``llvm.dbg.``
   11173 prefix), are described in the `LLVM Source Level
   11174 Debugging <SourceLevelDebugging.html#format_common_intrinsics>`_
   11175 document.
   11176 
   11177 Exception Handling Intrinsics
   11178 -----------------------------
   11179 
   11180 The LLVM exception handling intrinsics (which all start with
   11181 ``llvm.eh.`` prefix), are described in the `LLVM Exception
   11182 Handling <ExceptionHandling.html#format_common_intrinsics>`_ document.
   11183 
   11184 .. _int_trampoline:
   11185 
   11186 Trampoline Intrinsics
   11187 ---------------------
   11188 
   11189 These intrinsics make it possible to excise one parameter, marked with
   11190 the :ref:`nest <nest>` attribute, from a function. The result is a
   11191 callable function pointer lacking the nest parameter - the caller does
   11192 not need to provide a value for it. Instead, the value to use is stored
   11193 in advance in a "trampoline", a block of memory usually allocated on the
   11194 stack, which also contains code to splice the nest value into the
   11195 argument list. This is used to implement the GCC nested function address
   11196 extension.
   11197 
   11198 For example, if the function is ``i32 f(i8* nest %c, i32 %x, i32 %y)``
   11199 then the resulting function pointer has signature ``i32 (i32, i32)*``.
   11200 It can be created as follows:
   11201 
   11202 .. code-block:: llvm
   11203 
   11204       %tramp = alloca [10 x i8], align 4 ; size and alignment only correct for X86
   11205       %tramp1 = getelementptr [10 x i8], [10 x i8]* %tramp, i32 0, i32 0
   11206       call i8* @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* %tramp1, i8* bitcast (i32 (i8*, i32, i32)* @f to i8*), i8* %nval)
   11207       %p = call i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* %tramp1)
   11208       %fp = bitcast i8* %p to i32 (i32, i32)*
   11209 
   11210 The call ``%val = call i32 %fp(i32 %x, i32 %y)`` is then equivalent to
   11211 ``%val = call i32 %f(i8* %nval, i32 %x, i32 %y)``.
   11212 
   11213 .. _int_it:
   11214 
   11215 '``llvm.init.trampoline``' Intrinsic
   11216 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11217 
   11218 Syntax:
   11219 """""""
   11220 
   11221 ::
   11222 
   11223       declare void @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* <tramp>, i8* <func>, i8* <nval>)
   11224 
   11225 Overview:
   11226 """""""""
   11227 
   11228 This fills the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` with executable code,
   11229 turning it into a trampoline.
   11230 
   11231 Arguments:
   11232 """"""""""
   11233 
   11234 The ``llvm.init.trampoline`` intrinsic takes three arguments, all
   11235 pointers. The ``tramp`` argument must point to a sufficiently large and
   11236 sufficiently aligned block of memory; this memory is written to by the
   11237 intrinsic. Note that the size and the alignment are target-specific -
   11238 LLVM currently provides no portable way of determining them, so a
   11239 front-end that generates this intrinsic needs to have some
   11240 target-specific knowledge. The ``func`` argument must hold a function
   11241 bitcast to an ``i8*``.
   11242 
   11243 Semantics:
   11244 """"""""""
   11245 
   11246 The block of memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is filled with target
   11247 dependent code, turning it into a function. Then ``tramp`` needs to be
   11248 passed to :ref:`llvm.adjust.trampoline <int_at>` to get a pointer which can
   11249 be :ref:`bitcast (to a new function) and called <int_trampoline>`. The new
   11250 function's signature is the same as that of ``func`` with any arguments
   11251 marked with the ``nest`` attribute removed. At most one such ``nest``
   11252 argument is allowed, and it must be of pointer type. Calling the new
   11253 function is equivalent to calling ``func`` with the same argument list,
   11254 but with ``nval`` used for the missing ``nest`` argument. If, after
   11255 calling ``llvm.init.trampoline``, the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is
   11256 modified, then the effect of any later call to the returned function
   11257 pointer is undefined.
   11258 
   11259 .. _int_at:
   11260 
   11261 '``llvm.adjust.trampoline``' Intrinsic
   11262 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11263 
   11264 Syntax:
   11265 """""""
   11266 
   11267 ::
   11268 
   11269       declare i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* <tramp>)
   11270 
   11271 Overview:
   11272 """""""""
   11273 
   11274 This performs any required machine-specific adjustment to the address of
   11275 a trampoline (passed as ``tramp``).
   11276 
   11277 Arguments:
   11278 """"""""""
   11279 
   11280 ``tramp`` must point to a block of memory which already has trampoline
   11281 code filled in by a previous call to
   11282 :ref:`llvm.init.trampoline <int_it>`.
   11283 
   11284 Semantics:
   11285 """"""""""
   11286 
   11287 On some architectures the address of the code to be executed needs to be
   11288 different than the address where the trampoline is actually stored. This
   11289 intrinsic returns the executable address corresponding to ``tramp``
   11290 after performing the required machine specific adjustments. The pointer
   11291 returned can then be :ref:`bitcast and executed <int_trampoline>`.
   11292 
   11293 .. _int_mload_mstore:
   11294 
   11295 Masked Vector Load and Store Intrinsics
   11296 ---------------------------------------
   11297 
   11298 LLVM provides intrinsics for predicated vector load and store operations. The predicate is specified by a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits of the mask are on, the intrinsic is identical to a regular vector load or store. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
   11299 
   11300 .. _int_mload:
   11301 
   11302 '``llvm.masked.load.*``' Intrinsics
   11303 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11304 
   11305 Syntax:
   11306 """""""
   11307 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type.
   11308 
   11309 ::
   11310 
   11311       declare <16 x float>  @llvm.masked.load.v16f32 (<16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
   11312       declare <2 x double>  @llvm.masked.load.v2f64  (<2 x double>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1>  <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
   11313       ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
   11314       declare <8 x double*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f64    (<8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x double*> <passthru>)
   11315       ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
   11316       declare <8 x i32 ()*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f_i32f (<8 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x i32 ()*> <passthru>)
   11317 
   11318 Overview:
   11319 """""""""
   11320 
   11321 Reads a vector from memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
   11322 
   11323 
   11324 Arguments:
   11325 """"""""""
   11326 
   11327 The first operand is the base pointer for the load. The second operand is the alignment of the source location. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the base pointer and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
   11328 
   11329 
   11330 Semantics:
   11331 """"""""""
   11332 
   11333 The '``llvm.masked.load``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked loads and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar load operations.
   11334 The result of this operation is equivalent to a regular vector load instruction followed by a 'select' between the loaded and the passthru values, predicated on the same mask. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions on memory access to masked-off lanes.
   11335 
   11336 
   11337 ::
   11338 
   11339        %res = call <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32 (<16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1>%mask, <16 x float> %passthru)
   11340 
   11341        ;; The result of the two following instructions is identical aside from potential memory access exception
   11342        %loadlal = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
   11343        %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %loadlal, <16 x float> %passthru
   11344 
   11345 .. _int_mstore:
   11346 
   11347 '``llvm.masked.store.*``' Intrinsics
   11348 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11349 
   11350 Syntax:
   11351 """""""
   11352 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type.
   11353 
   11354 ::
   11355 
   11356        declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8i32  (<8  x i32>   <value>, <8  x i32>*   <ptr>, i32 <alignment>,  <8  x i1> <mask>)
   11357        declare void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>,  <16 x i1> <mask>)
   11358        ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
   11359        declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8p0f64    (<8 x double*> <value>, <8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
   11360        ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
   11361        declare void @llvm.masked.store.v4p0f_i32f (<4 x i32 ()*> <value>, <4 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
   11362 
   11363 Overview:
   11364 """""""""
   11365 
   11366 Writes a vector to memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
   11367 
   11368 Arguments:
   11369 """"""""""
   11370 
   11371 The first operand is the vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is the alignment of the destination location. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
   11372 
   11373 
   11374 Semantics:
   11375 """"""""""
   11376 
   11377 The '``llvm.masked.store``' intrinsics is designed for conditional writing of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked store and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
   11378 The result of this operation is equivalent to a load-modify-store sequence. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions and data races on memory access to masked-off lanes.
   11379 
   11380 ::
   11381 
   11382        call void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32(<16 x float> %value, <16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4,  <16 x i1> %mask)
   11383 
   11384        ;; The result of the following instructions is identical aside from potential data races and memory access exceptions
   11385        %oldval = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
   11386        %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %value, <16 x float> %oldval
   11387        store <16 x float> %res, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
   11388 
   11389 
   11390 Masked Vector Gather and Scatter Intrinsics
   11391 -------------------------------------------
   11392 
   11393 LLVM provides intrinsics for vector gather and scatter operations. They are similar to :ref:`Masked Vector Load and Store <int_mload_mstore>`, except they are designed for arbitrary memory accesses, rather than sequential memory accesses. Gather and scatter also employ a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
   11394 
   11395 .. _int_mgather:
   11396 
   11397 '``llvm.masked.gather.*``' Intrinsics
   11398 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11399 
   11400 Syntax:
   11401 """""""
   11402 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data are multiple scalar values of any integer, floating point or pointer data type gathered together into one vector.
   11403 
   11404 ::
   11405 
   11406       declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.gather.v16f32   (<16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
   11407       declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v2f64    (<2 x double*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1>  <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
   11408       declare <8 x float*> @llvm.masked.gather.v8p0f32  (<8 x float**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1>  <mask>, <8 x float*> <passthru>)
   11409 
   11410 Overview:
   11411 """""""""
   11412 
   11413 Reads scalar values from arbitrary memory locations and gathers them into one vector. The memory locations are provided in the vector of pointers '``ptrs``'. The memory is accessed according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
   11414 
   11415 
   11416 Arguments:
   11417 """"""""""
   11418 
   11419 The first operand is a vector of pointers which holds all memory addresses to read. The second operand is an alignment of the source addresses. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the vector of pointers and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
   11420 
   11421 
   11422 Semantics:
   11423 """"""""""
   11424 
   11425 The '``llvm.masked.gather``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of multiple scalar values from arbitrary memory locations in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked gathers and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of scalar load operations.
   11426 The semantics of this operation are equivalent to a sequence of conditional scalar loads with subsequent gathering all loaded values into a single vector. The mask restricts memory access to certain lanes and facilitates vectorization of predicated basic blocks.
   11427 
   11428 
   11429 ::
   11430 
   11431        %res = call <4 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v4f64 (<4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 8, <4 x i1>%mask, <4 x double> <true, true, true, true>)
   11432 
   11433        ;; The gather with all-true mask is equivalent to the following instruction sequence
   11434        %ptr0 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 0
   11435        %ptr1 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 1
   11436        %ptr2 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 2
   11437        %ptr3 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 3
   11438 
   11439        %val0 = load double, double* %ptr0, align 8
   11440        %val1 = load double, double* %ptr1, align 8
   11441        %val2 = load double, double* %ptr2, align 8
   11442        %val3 = load double, double* %ptr3, align 8
   11443 
   11444        %vec0    = insertelement <4 x double>undef, %val0, 0
   11445        %vec01   = insertelement <4 x double>%vec0, %val1, 1
   11446        %vec012  = insertelement <4 x double>%vec01, %val2, 2
   11447        %vec0123 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec012, %val3, 3
   11448 
   11449 .. _int_mscatter:
   11450 
   11451 '``llvm.masked.scatter.*``' Intrinsics
   11452 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11453 
   11454 Syntax:
   11455 """""""
   11456 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type. Each vector element is stored in an arbitrary memory address. Scatter with overlapping addresses is guaranteed to be ordered from least-significant to most-significant element.
   11457 
   11458 ::
   11459 
   11460        declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32   (<8 x i32>     <value>, <8 x i32*>     <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1>  <mask>)
   11461        declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v16f32  (<16 x float>  <value>, <16 x float*>  <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
   11462        declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v4p0f64 (<4 x double*> <value>, <4 x double**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1>  <mask>)
   11463 
   11464 Overview:
   11465 """""""""
   11466 
   11467 Writes each element from the value vector to the corresponding memory address. The memory addresses are represented as a vector of pointers. Writing is done according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
   11468 
   11469 Arguments:
   11470 """"""""""
   11471 
   11472 The first operand is a vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is a vector of pointers, pointing to where the value elements should be stored. It has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is an alignment of the destination addresses. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
   11473 
   11474 
   11475 Semantics:
   11476 """"""""""
   11477 
   11478 The '``llvm.masked.scatter``' intrinsics is designed for writing selected vector elements to arbitrary memory addresses in a single IR operation. The operation may be conditional, when not all bits in the mask are switched on. It is useful for targets that support vector masked scatter and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
   11479 
   11480 ::
   11481 
   11482        ;; This instruction unconditionaly stores data vector in multiple addresses
   11483        call @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32 (<8 x i32> %value, <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 4,  <8 x i1>  <true, true, .. true>)
   11484 
   11485        ;; It is equivalent to a list of scalar stores
   11486        %val0 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 0
   11487        %val1 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 1
   11488        ..
   11489        %val7 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 7
   11490        %ptr0 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 0
   11491        %ptr1 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 1
   11492        ..
   11493        %ptr7 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 7
   11494        ;; Note: the order of the following stores is important when they overlap:
   11495        store i32 %val0, i32* %ptr0, align 4
   11496        store i32 %val1, i32* %ptr1, align 4
   11497        ..
   11498        store i32 %val7, i32* %ptr7, align 4
   11499 
   11500 
   11501 Memory Use Markers
   11502 ------------------
   11503 
   11504 This class of intrinsics provides information about the lifetime of
   11505 memory objects and ranges where variables are immutable.
   11506 
   11507 .. _int_lifestart:
   11508 
   11509 '``llvm.lifetime.start``' Intrinsic
   11510 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11511 
   11512 Syntax:
   11513 """""""
   11514 
   11515 ::
   11516 
   11517       declare void @llvm.lifetime.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
   11518 
   11519 Overview:
   11520 """""""""
   11521 
   11522 The '``llvm.lifetime.start``' intrinsic specifies the start of a memory
   11523 object's lifetime.
   11524 
   11525 Arguments:
   11526 """"""""""
   11527 
   11528 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
   11529 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
   11530 to the object.
   11531 
   11532 Semantics:
   11533 """"""""""
   11534 
   11535 This intrinsic indicates that before this point in the code, the value
   11536 of the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known
   11537 to never be used and has an undefined value. A load from the pointer
   11538 that precedes this intrinsic can be replaced with ``'undef'``.
   11539 
   11540 .. _int_lifeend:
   11541 
   11542 '``llvm.lifetime.end``' Intrinsic
   11543 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11544 
   11545 Syntax:
   11546 """""""
   11547 
   11548 ::
   11549 
   11550       declare void @llvm.lifetime.end(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
   11551 
   11552 Overview:
   11553 """""""""
   11554 
   11555 The '``llvm.lifetime.end``' intrinsic specifies the end of a memory
   11556 object's lifetime.
   11557 
   11558 Arguments:
   11559 """"""""""
   11560 
   11561 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
   11562 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
   11563 to the object.
   11564 
   11565 Semantics:
   11566 """"""""""
   11567 
   11568 This intrinsic indicates that after this point in the code, the value of
   11569 the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known to
   11570 never be used and has an undefined value. Any stores into the memory
   11571 object following this intrinsic may be removed as dead.
   11572 
   11573 '``llvm.invariant.start``' Intrinsic
   11574 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11575 
   11576 Syntax:
   11577 """""""
   11578 
   11579 ::
   11580 
   11581       declare {}* @llvm.invariant.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
   11582 
   11583 Overview:
   11584 """""""""
   11585 
   11586 The '``llvm.invariant.start``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of
   11587 a memory object will not change.
   11588 
   11589 Arguments:
   11590 """"""""""
   11591 
   11592 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
   11593 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
   11594 to the object.
   11595 
   11596 Semantics:
   11597 """"""""""
   11598 
   11599 This intrinsic indicates that until an ``llvm.invariant.end`` that uses
   11600 the return value, the referenced memory location is constant and
   11601 unchanging.
   11602 
   11603 '``llvm.invariant.end``' Intrinsic
   11604 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11605 
   11606 Syntax:
   11607 """""""
   11608 
   11609 ::
   11610 
   11611       declare void @llvm.invariant.end({}* <start>, i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
   11612 
   11613 Overview:
   11614 """""""""
   11615 
   11616 The '``llvm.invariant.end``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of a
   11617 memory object are mutable.
   11618 
   11619 Arguments:
   11620 """"""""""
   11621 
   11622 The first argument is the matching ``llvm.invariant.start`` intrinsic.
   11623 The second argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
   11624 object, or -1 if it is variable sized and the third argument is a
   11625 pointer to the object.
   11626 
   11627 Semantics:
   11628 """"""""""
   11629 
   11630 This intrinsic indicates that the memory is mutable again.
   11631 
   11632 '``llvm.invariant.group.barrier``' Intrinsic
   11633 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11634 
   11635 Syntax:
   11636 """""""
   11637 
   11638 ::
   11639 
   11640       declare i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8* <ptr>)
   11641 
   11642 Overview:
   11643 """""""""
   11644 
   11645 The '``llvm.invariant.group.barrier``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant 
   11646 established by invariant.group metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new pointer
   11647 value that does not carry the invariant information.
   11648 
   11649 
   11650 Arguments:
   11651 """"""""""
   11652 
   11653 The ``llvm.invariant.group.barrier`` takes only one argument, which is
   11654 the pointer to the memory for which the ``invariant.group`` no longer holds.
   11655 
   11656 Semantics:
   11657 """"""""""
   11658 
   11659 Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which is considered different 
   11660 for the purposes of ``load``/``store`` ``invariant.group`` metadata.
   11661 
   11662 General Intrinsics
   11663 ------------------
   11664 
   11665 This class of intrinsics is designed to be generic and has no specific
   11666 purpose.
   11667 
   11668 '``llvm.var.annotation``' Intrinsic
   11669 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11670 
   11671 Syntax:
   11672 """""""
   11673 
   11674 ::
   11675 
   11676       declare void @llvm.var.annotation(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32  <int>)
   11677 
   11678 Overview:
   11679 """""""""
   11680 
   11681 The '``llvm.var.annotation``' intrinsic.
   11682 
   11683 Arguments:
   11684 """"""""""
   11685 
   11686 The first argument is a pointer to a value, the second is a pointer to a
   11687 global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the
   11688 source file name, and the last argument is the line number.
   11689 
   11690 Semantics:
   11691 """"""""""
   11692 
   11693 This intrinsic allows annotation of local variables with arbitrary
   11694 strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want
   11695 to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are
   11696 ignored by code generation and optimization.
   11697 
   11698 '``llvm.ptr.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
   11699 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11700 
   11701 Syntax:
   11702 """""""
   11703 
   11704 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' on a
   11705 pointer to an integer of any width. *NOTE* you must specify an address space for
   11706 the pointer. The identifier for the default address space is the integer
   11707 '``0``'.
   11708 
   11709 ::
   11710 
   11711       declare i8*   @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i8(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32  <int>)
   11712       declare i16*  @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i16(i16* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32  <int>)
   11713       declare i32*  @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i32(i32* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32  <int>)
   11714       declare i64*  @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i64(i64* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32  <int>)
   11715       declare i256* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i256(i256* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32  <int>)
   11716 
   11717 Overview:
   11718 """""""""
   11719 
   11720 The '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' intrinsic.
   11721 
   11722 Arguments:
   11723 """"""""""
   11724 
   11725 The first argument is a pointer to an integer value of arbitrary bitwidth
   11726 (result of some expression), the second is a pointer to a global string, the
   11727 third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the
   11728 last argument is the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
   11729 
   11730 Semantics:
   11731 """"""""""
   11732 
   11733 This intrinsic allows annotation of a pointer to an integer with arbitrary
   11734 strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look
   11735 for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code
   11736 generation and optimization.
   11737 
   11738 '``llvm.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
   11739 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11740 
   11741 Syntax:
   11742 """""""
   11743 
   11744 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.annotation``' on
   11745 any integer bit width.
   11746 
   11747 ::
   11748 
   11749       declare i8 @llvm.annotation.i8(i8 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32  <int>)
   11750       declare i16 @llvm.annotation.i16(i16 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32  <int>)
   11751       declare i32 @llvm.annotation.i32(i32 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32  <int>)
   11752       declare i64 @llvm.annotation.i64(i64 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32  <int>)
   11753       declare i256 @llvm.annotation.i256(i256 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32  <int>)
   11754 
   11755 Overview:
   11756 """""""""
   11757 
   11758 The '``llvm.annotation``' intrinsic.
   11759 
   11760 Arguments:
   11761 """"""""""
   11762 
   11763 The first argument is an integer value (result of some expression), the
   11764 second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a
   11765 global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is
   11766 the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
   11767 
   11768 Semantics:
   11769 """"""""""
   11770 
   11771 This intrinsic allows annotations to be put on arbitrary expressions
   11772 with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose
   11773 optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no
   11774 other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization.
   11775 
   11776 '``llvm.trap``' Intrinsic
   11777 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11778 
   11779 Syntax:
   11780 """""""
   11781 
   11782 ::
   11783 
   11784       declare void @llvm.trap() noreturn nounwind
   11785 
   11786 Overview:
   11787 """""""""
   11788 
   11789 The '``llvm.trap``' intrinsic.
   11790 
   11791 Arguments:
   11792 """"""""""
   11793 
   11794 None.
   11795 
   11796 Semantics:
   11797 """"""""""
   11798 
   11799 This intrinsic is lowered to the target dependent trap instruction. If
   11800 the target does not have a trap instruction, this intrinsic will be
   11801 lowered to a call of the ``abort()`` function.
   11802 
   11803 '``llvm.debugtrap``' Intrinsic
   11804 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11805 
   11806 Syntax:
   11807 """""""
   11808 
   11809 ::
   11810 
   11811       declare void @llvm.debugtrap() nounwind
   11812 
   11813 Overview:
   11814 """""""""
   11815 
   11816 The '``llvm.debugtrap``' intrinsic.
   11817 
   11818 Arguments:
   11819 """"""""""
   11820 
   11821 None.
   11822 
   11823 Semantics:
   11824 """"""""""
   11825 
   11826 This intrinsic is lowered to code which is intended to cause an
   11827 execution trap with the intention of requesting the attention of a
   11828 debugger.
   11829 
   11830 '``llvm.stackprotector``' Intrinsic
   11831 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11832 
   11833 Syntax:
   11834 """""""
   11835 
   11836 ::
   11837 
   11838       declare void @llvm.stackprotector(i8* <guard>, i8** <slot>)
   11839 
   11840 Overview:
   11841 """""""""
   11842 
   11843 The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic takes the ``guard`` and stores it
   11844 onto the stack at ``slot``. The stack slot is adjusted to ensure that it
   11845 is placed on the stack before local variables.
   11846 
   11847 Arguments:
   11848 """"""""""
   11849 
   11850 The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic requires two pointer arguments.
   11851 The first argument is the value loaded from the stack guard
   11852 ``@__stack_chk_guard``. The second variable is an ``alloca`` that has
   11853 enough space to hold the value of the guard.
   11854 
   11855 Semantics:
   11856 """"""""""
   11857 
   11858 This intrinsic causes the prologue/epilogue inserter to force the position of
   11859 the ``AllocaInst`` stack slot to be before local variables on the stack. This is
   11860 to ensure that if a local variable on the stack is overwritten, it will destroy
   11861 the value of the guard. When the function exits, the guard on the stack is
   11862 checked against the original guard by ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``. If they are
   11863 different, then ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` causes the program to abort by
   11864 calling the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
   11865 
   11866 '``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``' Intrinsic
   11867 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11868 
   11869 Syntax:
   11870 """""""
   11871 
   11872 ::
   11873 
   11874       declare void @llvm.stackprotectorcheck(i8** <guard>)
   11875 
   11876 Overview:
   11877 """""""""
   11878 
   11879 The ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` intrinsic compares ``guard`` against an already
   11880 created stack protector and if they are not equal calls the
   11881 ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
   11882 
   11883 Arguments:
   11884 """"""""""
   11885 
   11886 The ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` intrinsic requires one pointer argument, the
   11887 the variable ``@__stack_chk_guard``.
   11888 
   11889 Semantics:
   11890 """"""""""
   11891 
   11892 This intrinsic is provided to perform the stack protector check by comparing
   11893 ``guard`` with the stack slot created by ``llvm.stackprotector`` and if the
   11894 values do not match call the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
   11895 
   11896 The reason to provide this as an IR level intrinsic instead of implementing it
   11897 via other IR operations is that in order to perform this operation at the IR
   11898 level without an intrinsic, one would need to create additional basic blocks to
   11899 handle the success/failure cases. This makes it difficult to stop the stack
   11900 protector check from disrupting sibling tail calls in Codegen. With this
   11901 intrinsic, we are able to generate the stack protector basic blocks late in
   11902 codegen after the tail call decision has occurred.
   11903 
   11904 '``llvm.objectsize``' Intrinsic
   11905 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11906 
   11907 Syntax:
   11908 """""""
   11909 
   11910 ::
   11911 
   11912       declare i32 @llvm.objectsize.i32(i8* <object>, i1 <min>)
   11913       declare i64 @llvm.objectsize.i64(i8* <object>, i1 <min>)
   11914 
   11915 Overview:
   11916 """""""""
   11917 
   11918 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is designed to provide information to
   11919 the optimizers to determine at compile time whether a) an operation
   11920 (like memcpy) will overflow a buffer that corresponds to an object, or
   11921 b) that a runtime check for overflow isn't necessary. An object in this
   11922 context means an allocation of a specific class, structure, array, or
   11923 other object.
   11924 
   11925 Arguments:
   11926 """"""""""
   11927 
   11928 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first
   11929 argument is a pointer to or into the ``object``. The second argument is
   11930 a boolean and determines whether ``llvm.objectsize`` returns 0 (if true)
   11931 or -1 (if false) when the object size is unknown. The second argument
   11932 only accepts constants.
   11933 
   11934 Semantics:
   11935 """"""""""
   11936 
   11937 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is lowered to a constant representing
   11938 the size of the object concerned. If the size cannot be determined at
   11939 compile time, ``llvm.objectsize`` returns ``i32/i64 -1 or 0`` (depending
   11940 on the ``min`` argument).
   11941 
   11942 '``llvm.expect``' Intrinsic
   11943 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11944 
   11945 Syntax:
   11946 """""""
   11947 
   11948 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.expect`` on any
   11949 integer bit width.
   11950 
   11951 ::
   11952 
   11953       declare i1 @llvm.expect.i1(i1 <val>, i1 <expected_val>)
   11954       declare i32 @llvm.expect.i32(i32 <val>, i32 <expected_val>)
   11955       declare i64 @llvm.expect.i64(i64 <val>, i64 <expected_val>)
   11956 
   11957 Overview:
   11958 """""""""
   11959 
   11960 The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic provides information about expected (the
   11961 most probable) value of ``val``, which can be used by optimizers.
   11962 
   11963 Arguments:
   11964 """"""""""
   11965 
   11966 The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first argument is
   11967 a value. The second argument is an expected value, this needs to be a
   11968 constant value, variables are not allowed.
   11969 
   11970 Semantics:
   11971 """"""""""
   11972 
   11973 This intrinsic is lowered to the ``val``.
   11974 
   11975 .. _int_assume:
   11976 
   11977 '``llvm.assume``' Intrinsic
   11978 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   11979 
   11980 Syntax:
   11981 """""""
   11982 
   11983 ::
   11984 
   11985       declare void @llvm.assume(i1 %cond)
   11986 
   11987 Overview:
   11988 """""""""
   11989 
   11990 The ``llvm.assume`` allows the optimizer to assume that the provided
   11991 condition is true. This information can then be used in simplifying other parts
   11992 of the code.
   11993 
   11994 Arguments:
   11995 """"""""""
   11996 
   11997 The condition which the optimizer may assume is always true.
   11998 
   11999 Semantics:
   12000 """"""""""
   12001 
   12002 The intrinsic allows the optimizer to assume that the provided condition is
   12003 always true whenever the control flow reaches the intrinsic call. No code is
   12004 generated for this intrinsic, and instructions that contribute only to the
   12005 provided condition are not used for code generation. If the condition is
   12006 violated during execution, the behavior is undefined.
   12007 
   12008 Note that the optimizer might limit the transformations performed on values
   12009 used by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic in order to preserve the instructions
   12010 only used to form the intrinsic's input argument. This might prove undesirable
   12011 if the extra information provided by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic does not cause
   12012 sufficient overall improvement in code quality. For this reason,
   12013 ``llvm.assume`` should not be used to document basic mathematical invariants
   12014 that the optimizer can otherwise deduce or facts that are of little use to the
   12015 optimizer.
   12016 
   12017 .. _bitset.test:
   12018 
   12019 '``llvm.bitset.test``' Intrinsic
   12020 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   12021 
   12022 Syntax:
   12023 """""""
   12024 
   12025 ::
   12026 
   12027       declare i1 @llvm.bitset.test(i8* %ptr, metadata %bitset) nounwind readnone
   12028 
   12029 
   12030 Arguments:
   12031 """"""""""
   12032 
   12033 The first argument is a pointer to be tested. The second argument is a
   12034 metadata object representing an identifier for a :doc:`bitset <BitSets>`.
   12035 
   12036 Overview:
   12037 """""""""
   12038 
   12039 The ``llvm.bitset.test`` intrinsic tests whether the given pointer is a
   12040 member of the given bitset.
   12041 
   12042 '``llvm.donothing``' Intrinsic
   12043 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
   12044 
   12045 Syntax:
   12046 """""""
   12047 
   12048 ::
   12049 
   12050       declare void @llvm.donothing() nounwind readnone
   12051 
   12052 Overview:
   12053 """""""""
   12054 
   12055 The ``llvm.donothing`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. It's one of only
   12056 two intrinsics (besides ``llvm.experimental.patchpoint``) that can be called
   12057 with an invoke instruction.
   12058 
   12059 Arguments:
   12060 """"""""""
   12061 
   12062 None.
   12063 
   12064 Semantics:
   12065 """"""""""
   12066 
   12067 This intrinsic does nothing, and it's removed by optimizers and ignored
   12068 by codegen.
   12069 
   12070 Stack Map Intrinsics
   12071 --------------------
   12072 
   12073 LLVM provides experimental intrinsics to support runtime patching
   12074 mechanisms commonly desired in dynamic language JITs. These intrinsics
   12075 are described in :doc:`StackMaps`.
   12076